3 @setfilename ../../info/org
4 @settitle The Org Manual
5 @set VERSION 7.9.2 (GNU Emacs 24.3)
7 @c Use proper quote and backtick for code sections in PDF output
8 @c Cf. Texinfo manual 14.2
9 @set txicodequoteundirected
10 @set txicodequotebacktick
12 @c Version and Contact Info
13 @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
14 @set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
15 @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
16 @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
17 @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
22 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
24 @c Macro definitions for commands and keys
25 @c =======================================
27 @c The behavior of the key/command macros will depend on the flag cmdnames
28 @c When set, commands names are shown. When clear, they are not shown.
32 @c Below we define the following macros for Org key tables:
34 @c orgkey{key} A key item
35 @c orgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name
36 @c xorgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name as @itemx
37 @c orgcmdnki{key,cmd} Like orgcmd, but do not index the key
38 @c orgcmdtkc{text,key,cmd} Like orgcmd,special text instead of key
39 @c orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, use "or"
40 @c orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, but
41 @c different functions, so format as @itemx
42 @c orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as orgcmdkkc, but use "or short"
43 @c xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as previous, but use @itemx
44 @c orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,cmd1,cmd2} Two keys and two commands
46 @c a key but no command
58 @c one key with a command
59 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
60 @macro orgcmd{key,command}
65 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
68 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
77 @c One key with one command, formatted using @itemx
78 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY COMMAND
79 @macro xorgcmd{key,command}
84 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
87 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
96 @c one key with a command, bit do not index the key
97 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
98 @macro orgcmdnki{key,command}
102 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
105 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
113 @c one key with a command, and special text to replace key in item
114 @c Inserts: @item TEXT COMMAND
115 @macro orgcmdtkc{text,key,command}
120 @item @kbd{\text\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
123 @item @kbd{\text\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
132 @c two keys with one command
133 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or KEY2 COMMAND
134 @macro orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,command}
140 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
143 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
149 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\}
153 @c Two keys with one command name, but different functions, so format as
155 @c Inserts: @item KEY1
156 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND
157 @macro orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,command}
164 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
168 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
179 @c Same as previous, but use "or short"
180 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
181 @macro orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
187 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
190 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
196 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
200 @c Same as previous, but use @itemx
201 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
202 @macro xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
208 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
211 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
217 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
221 @c two keys with two commands
222 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 COMMAND1
223 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND2
224 @macro orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,command1,command2}
231 @item @kbd{\key1\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command1\}
232 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command2\}
235 @item @kbd{\key1\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command1\})
236 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command2\})
246 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
249 @c @hyphenation{time-stamp time-stamps time-stamp-ing time-stamp-ed}
252 @c Subheadings inside a table.
253 @macro tsubheading{text}
255 @subsubheading \text\
263 This manual is for Org version @value{VERSION}.
265 Copyright @copyright{} 2004-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
268 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
269 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
270 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
271 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
272 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
273 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
275 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
276 modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
277 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
279 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
280 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
281 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
282 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
286 @dircategory Emacs editing modes
288 * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
292 @title The Org Manual
294 @subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
295 @author by Carsten Dominik
296 with contributions by David O'Toole, Bastien Guerry, Philip Rooke, Dan Davison, Eric Schulte, Thomas Dye and Jambunathan K.
298 @c The following two commands start the copyright page.
300 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
304 @c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
308 @node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
315 * Introduction:: Getting started
316 * Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
317 * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
318 * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
319 * TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
320 * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
321 * Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
322 * Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
323 * Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects
324 * Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
325 * Markup:: Prepare text for rich export
326 * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
327 * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
328 * Working With Source Code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks
329 * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
330 * Hacking:: How to hack your way around
331 * MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device
332 * History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
333 * Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
334 * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
335 * Command and Function Index:: Command names and some internal functions
336 * Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual
339 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
343 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
344 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
345 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
346 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
347 * Conventions:: Typesetting conventions in the manual
351 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
352 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
353 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
354 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
355 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
356 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
357 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
358 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
359 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
360 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
361 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
365 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
366 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
367 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
368 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
369 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
370 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
374 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
375 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
376 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
377 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
378 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
379 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
380 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
381 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
382 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
386 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
387 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
388 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
389 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
390 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
391 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
392 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
393 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
397 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
401 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
402 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
403 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
404 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
405 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
406 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
408 Extended use of TODO keywords
410 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
411 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
412 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
413 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
414 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
415 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
416 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
420 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
421 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
422 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
426 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
427 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
428 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
430 Properties and columns
432 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
433 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
434 * Property searches:: Matching property values
435 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
436 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
437 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
441 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
442 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
443 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
447 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
448 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
452 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
453 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
454 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
455 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
456 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
457 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
458 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
462 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
463 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
465 Deadlines and scheduling
467 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
468 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
472 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
473 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
474 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
476 Capture - Refile - Archive
478 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
479 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
480 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
481 * Protocols:: External (e.g.@: Browser) access to Emacs and Org
482 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
483 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
487 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
488 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
489 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
493 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
494 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
495 * Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context
499 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
500 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
504 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
505 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
506 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
507 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
508 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
509 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
510 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
511 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
513 The built-in agenda views
515 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
516 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
517 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
518 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
519 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
520 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
522 Presentation and sorting
524 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
525 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
526 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
530 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
531 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
532 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
534 Markup for rich export
536 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
537 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
538 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
539 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
540 * Index entries:: Making an index
541 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
542 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
544 Structural markup elements
546 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
547 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
548 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
549 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
551 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
552 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
553 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
554 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
555 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
559 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
560 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
561 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
562 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
563 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
567 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
568 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
569 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
570 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
571 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
572 * @LaTeX{} and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
573 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
574 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
575 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
576 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
577 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
578 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
582 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
583 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
584 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
585 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
586 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
587 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
588 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
589 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
590 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
591 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
593 @LaTeX{} and PDF export
595 * @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands::
596 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
597 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
598 * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
599 * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
600 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
604 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
605 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
606 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
607 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
608 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
609 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
611 OpenDocument Text export
613 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: What packages ODT exporter relies on
614 * ODT export commands:: How to invoke ODT export
615 * Extending ODT export:: How to produce @samp{doc}, @samp{pdf} files
616 * Applying custom styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
617 * Links in ODT export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
618 * Tables in ODT export:: How Tables are exported
619 * Images in ODT export:: How to insert images
620 * Math formatting in ODT export:: How @LaTeX{} fragments are formatted
621 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: How captions are rendered
622 * Literal examples in ODT export:: How source and example blocks are formatted
623 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: Read this if you are a power user
625 Math formatting in ODT export
627 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: How to embed @LaTeX{} math fragments
628 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: How to embed equations in native format
630 Advanced topics in ODT export
632 * Configuring a document converter:: How to register a document converter
633 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Explore the internals
634 * Creating one-off styles:: How to produce custom highlighting etc
635 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: How to define and use Table templates
636 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: How to debug corrupt OpenDocument files
640 * Configuration:: Defining projects
641 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
642 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
643 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
647 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
648 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
649 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
650 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
651 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
652 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
653 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
654 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
658 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
659 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
661 Working with source code
663 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
664 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
665 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
666 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
667 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
668 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
669 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
670 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
671 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
672 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
673 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
674 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
678 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
679 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
681 Using header arguments
683 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
684 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
685 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
686 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
687 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
688 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
690 Specific header arguments
692 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
693 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
694 be collected and handled
695 * file:: Specify a path for file output
696 * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results
697 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
698 directory for code block execution
699 * exports:: Export code and/or results
700 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
701 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
702 files during tangling
703 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
705 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
707 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
708 expansion during tangling
709 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
710 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
711 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
712 * noweb-sep:: String used to separate noweb references
713 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
714 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
715 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
716 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
717 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
718 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
719 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
720 * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results
724 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
725 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
726 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
727 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
728 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
729 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
730 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
731 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
732 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
733 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
734 * org-crypt.el:: Encrypting Org files
736 Interaction with other packages
738 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
739 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
743 * Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals
744 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
745 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
746 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
747 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
748 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
749 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
750 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
751 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
752 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
754 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
756 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
757 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
758 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
759 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
763 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
764 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
765 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
770 @node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
771 @chapter Introduction
775 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
776 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
777 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
778 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
779 * Conventions:: Typesetting conventions in the manual
782 @node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
786 Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
787 project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
789 Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
790 lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
791 implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
792 content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
793 structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
794 with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
795 timestamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
796 agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
797 and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
798 Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
799 For printing and sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a
800 structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
801 iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
804 As a project planning environment, Org works by adding metadata to outline
805 nodes. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted in queries and
806 create dynamic @i{agenda views}.
808 Org mode contains the Org Babel environment which allows you to work with
809 embedded source code blocks in a file, to facilitate code evaluation,
810 documentation, and literate programming techniques.
812 Org's automatic, context-sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
813 capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
814 minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
815 tables in arbitrary file types, for example in @LaTeX{}. The structure
816 editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
817 the minor Orgstruct mode.
819 Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
820 feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
821 imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
822 it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways and for different
826 @r{@bullet{} an outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
827 @r{@bullet{} an ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
828 @r{@bullet{} a TODO list editor}
829 @r{@bullet{} a full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
830 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
831 @r{@bullet{} an environment in which to implement David Allen's GTD system}
832 @r{@bullet{} a simple hypertext system, with HTML and @LaTeX{} export}
833 @r{@bullet{} a publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages}
834 @r{@bullet{} an environment for literate programming}
839 There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
840 version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
841 questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc@. This page is located at
842 @uref{http://orgmode.org}.
844 @cindex print edition
845 The version 7.3 of this manual is available as a
846 @uref{http://www.network-theory.co.uk/org/manual/, paperback book from Network
852 @node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
853 @section Installation
857 @b{Important:} @i{If you the version of Org that comes with Emacs or as a
858 XEmacs package, please skip this section and go directly to @ref{Activation}.
859 If you downloaded Org as an ELPA package, please read the instructions on the
860 @uref{http://orgmode.org/elpa/, Org ELPA page}. To see what version of Org
861 (if any) is part of your Emacs distribution, type @kbd{M-x org-version} (if
862 your Emacs distribution does not come with Org, this function will not be
865 Installation of Org mode uses a build system, which is described in more
866 detail on @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-build-system.html, Worg}.
868 If you have downloaded Org from the Web as a distribution @file{.zip} or
869 @file{.tar.gz} archive, take the following steps to install it:
872 @item Unpack the distribution archive.
873 @item Change into (@code{cd}) the Org directory.
874 @item Run @code{make help config}
875 and then check and edit the file @file{local.mk} if the default configuration
876 does not match your system. Set the name of the Emacs binary (likely either
877 @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths to the directories where local
878 Lisp and Info files will be installed. If the Emacs binary is not in your
879 path, give the full path to the executable. Avoid spaces in any path names.
880 @item Run @code{make config}
881 again to check the configuration.
882 @item Optionally run @code{make test}
883 to build Org mode and then run the full testsuite.
884 @item Run @code{make install} or @code{sudo make install}
885 to build and install Org mode on your system.
888 If you use a cloned Git repository, then the procedure is slightly different.
889 The following description assumes that you are using the @code{master} branch
890 (where the development is done). You could also use the @code{maint} branch
891 instead, where the release versions are published, just replace @code{master}
892 with @code{maint} in the description below.
895 @item Change into (@code{cd}) the Org repository.
896 @item Run @code{git checkout master}
897 to switch to the @code{master} branch of the Org repository.
898 @item Run @code{make help}
899 and then check and edit the file @file{local.mk}. You must set the name of
900 the Emacs binary (likely either @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths
901 to the directories where local Lisp and Info files will be installed. If the
902 Emacs binary is not in your path, you must give the full path to the
903 executable. Avoid spaces in any path names.
904 @item Run @code{make config}
905 to check the configuration.
906 @item Run @code{make update2} or @code{make up2}
907 to update the Git repository and build and install Org mode. The latter
908 invocation runs the complete test suite before installation and installs only
909 if the build passes all tests.
912 If you don't have access to the system-wide directories and you don't want to
913 install somewhere into your home directory, you can run Org directly from the
914 distribution directory or Org repository by compiling Org mode in place:
917 @item Change into (@code{cd}) the Org repository.
918 @item Run @code{git checkout master}
919 to switch to the @code{master} branch of the Org repository.
920 @item Run @code{make compile}
923 Last but not least you can also run Org mode directly from an Org repository
924 without any compilation. Simply replace the last step in the recipe above
925 with @code{make uncompiled}.
927 Then add the following line to @file{.emacs}:
930 (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp")
934 If you plan to use code from the @file{contrib} subdirectory without
935 compiling them, do a similar step for this directory:
938 (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" t)
941 If you want to include those files with the build and install, please
942 customize the variable @code{ORG_ADD_CONTRIB} instead in your @code{local.mk}
943 file, for more details please see this
944 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-build-system.html#sec-4-1-2,
945 description on Worg}.
947 Installing Info files is system dependent, because of differences in the
948 @file{install-info} program. The Info documentation is installed together
949 with the rest of Org mode. If you don't install Org mode, it is possible to
950 install the Info documentation seperately (you need to have
951 install-info@footnote{The output from install-info (if any) is system
952 dependent. In particular Debian and its derivatives use two different
953 versions of install-info and you may see the message:
956 This is not dpkg install-info anymore, but GNU install-info
957 See the man page for ginstall-info for command line arguments
960 @noindent which can be safely ignored.}
967 Then add the following line to @file{.emacs}. It is needed so that
968 Emacs can autoload functions that are located in files not immediately loaded
969 when Org mode starts.
971 (require 'org-install)
974 Do not forget to activate Org as described in the following section.
977 @node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
982 @cindex global key bindings
983 @cindex key bindings, global
986 @findex org-store-link
989 Since Emacs 22.2, files with the @file{.org} extension use Org mode by
990 default. If you are using an earlier version of Emacs, add this line to your
994 (add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
997 Org mode buffers need font-lock to be turned on - this is the default in
998 Emacs@footnote{If you don't use font-lock globally, turn it on in Org buffer
999 with @code{(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock)}}.
1001 There are compatibility issues between Org mode and some other Elisp
1002 packages, please take the time to check the list (@pxref{Conflicts}).
1004 The four Org commands @command{org-store-link}, @command{org-capture},
1005 @command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb} should be accessible through
1006 global keys (i.e.@: anywhere in Emacs, not just in Org buffers). Here are
1007 suggested bindings for these keys, please modify the keys to your own
1010 (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
1011 (global-set-key "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
1012 (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
1013 (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
1016 @cindex Org mode, turning on
1017 With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
1018 into Org mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
1022 MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
1025 @vindex org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file
1026 @noindent which will select Org mode for this buffer no matter what
1027 the file's name is. See also the variable
1028 @code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
1030 Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is @i{active}. To make
1031 use of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode}
1032 (@code{zmacs-regions} in XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default,
1033 in Emacs 22 you need to do this yourself with
1035 (transient-mark-mode 1)
1037 @noindent If you do not like @code{transient-mark-mode}, you can create an
1038 active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing
1039 @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} twice before moving the cursor.
1041 @node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
1048 If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
1049 about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
1050 If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the
1051 list after a moderator has approved it@footnote{Please consider subscribing
1052 to the mailing list, in order to minimize the work the mailing list
1053 moderators have to do.}.
1055 For bug reports, please first try to reproduce the bug with the latest
1056 version of Org available---if you are running an outdated version, it is
1057 quite possible that the bug has been fixed already. If the bug persists,
1058 prepare a report and provide as much information as possible, including the
1059 version information of Emacs (@kbd{M-x emacs-version @key{RET}}) and Org
1060 (@kbd{M-x org-version @key{RET}}), as well as the Org related setup in
1061 @file{.emacs}. The easiest way to do this is to use the command
1063 @kbd{M-x org-submit-bug-report}
1065 @noindent which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so
1066 that you only need to add your description. If you re not sending the Email
1067 from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program.
1069 Sometimes you might face a problem due to an error in your Emacs or Org mode
1070 setup. Before reporting a bug, it is very helpful to start Emacs with minimal
1071 customizations and reproduce the problem. Doing so often helps you determine
1072 if the problem is with your customization or with Org mode itself. You can
1073 start a typical minimal session with a command like the example below.
1076 $ emacs -Q -l /path/to/minimal-org.el
1079 However if you are using Org mode as distributed with Emacs, a minimal setup
1080 is not necessary. In that case it is sufficient to start Emacs as
1081 @code{emacs -Q}. The @code{minimal-org.el} setup file can have contents as
1085 ;;; Minimal setup to load latest `org-mode'
1087 ;; activate debugging
1088 (setq debug-on-error t
1092 ;; add latest org-mode to load path
1093 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/lisp"))
1094 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/contrib/lisp" t))
1097 (require 'org-install)
1100 If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to
1101 create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear information
1105 @item What exactly did you do?
1106 @item What did you expect to happen?
1107 @item What happened instead?
1109 @noindent Thank you for helping to improve this program.
1111 @subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
1113 @cindex backtrace of an error
1114 If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
1115 understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
1116 providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{backtrace}.
1117 This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
1118 error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
1122 Reload uncompiled versions of all Org mode Lisp files. The backtrace
1123 contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code.
1126 C-u M-x org-reload RET
1129 or select @code{Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled} from the
1132 Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
1133 (XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
1135 Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
1136 document the steps you take.
1138 When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
1139 screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
1140 attach it to your bug report.
1143 @node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
1144 @section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
1146 @subsubheading TODO keywords, tags, properties, etc.
1148 Org mainly uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags and property
1149 names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
1154 TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
1158 User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
1159 meaning are written with all capitals.
1162 User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
1163 special meaning are written with all capitals.
1166 Moreover, Org uses @i{option keywords} (like @code{#+TITLE} to set the title)
1167 and @i{environment keywords} (like @code{#+BEGIN_HTML} to start a @code{HTML}
1168 environment). They are written in uppercase in the manual to enhance its
1169 readability, but you can use lowercase in your Org files@footnote{Easy
1170 templates insert lowercase keywords and Babel dynamically inserts
1173 @subsubheading Keybindings and commands
1179 The manual suggests two global keybindings: @kbd{C-c a} for @code{org-agenda}
1180 and @kbd{C-c c} for @code{org-capture}. These are only suggestions, but the
1181 rest of the manual assumes that you are using these keybindings.
1183 Also, the manual lists both the keys and the corresponding commands for
1184 accessing a functionality. Org mode often uses the same key for different
1185 functions, depending on context. The command that is bound to such keys has
1186 a generic name, like @code{org-metaright}. In the manual we will, wherever
1187 possible, give the function that is internally called by the generic command.
1188 For example, in the chapter on document structure, @kbd{M-@key{right}} will
1189 be listed to call @code{org-do-demote}, while in the chapter on tables, it
1190 will be listed to call @code{org-table-move-column-right}. If you prefer,
1191 you can compile the manual without the command names by unsetting the flag
1192 @code{cmdnames} in @file{org.texi}.
1194 @node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
1195 @chapter Document structure
1196 @cindex document structure
1197 @cindex structure of document
1199 Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to
1200 edit the structure of the document.
1203 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
1204 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
1205 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
1206 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
1207 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
1208 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
1209 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
1210 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
1211 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
1212 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
1213 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
1216 @node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
1219 @cindex Outline mode
1221 Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
1222 document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
1223 for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
1224 of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
1225 document to show only the general document structure and the parts
1226 currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
1227 outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
1228 command, @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
1230 @node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
1233 @cindex outline tree
1234 @vindex org-special-ctrl-a/e
1235 @vindex org-special-ctrl-k
1236 @vindex org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree
1238 Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in Org
1239 start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See the variables
1240 @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e}, @code{org-special-ctrl-k}, and
1241 @code{org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree} to configure special behavior of @kbd{C-a},
1242 @kbd{C-e}, and @kbd{C-k} in headlines.} @footnote{Clocking only works with
1243 headings indented less then 30 stars.}. For example:
1246 * Top level headline
1253 * Another top level headline
1256 @noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
1257 outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
1258 starters. @ref{Clean view}, describes a setup to realize this.
1260 @vindex org-cycle-separator-lines
1261 An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
1262 will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
1263 least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
1264 the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
1265 variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
1267 @node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
1268 @section Visibility cycling
1269 @cindex cycling, visibility
1270 @cindex visibility cycling
1271 @cindex trees, visibility
1272 @cindex show hidden text
1275 Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
1276 Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
1277 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
1279 @cindex subtree visibility states
1280 @cindex subtree cycling
1281 @cindex folded, subtree visibility state
1282 @cindex children, subtree visibility state
1283 @cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
1285 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1286 @emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
1289 ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
1290 '-----------------------------------'
1293 @vindex org-cycle-emulate-tab
1294 @vindex org-cycle-global-at-bob
1295 The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
1296 the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
1297 beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
1298 @key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
1299 option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
1300 argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
1302 @cindex global visibility states
1303 @cindex global cycling
1304 @cindex overview, global visibility state
1305 @cindex contents, global visibility state
1306 @cindex show all, global visibility state
1307 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-global-cycle}
1308 @itemx C-u @key{TAB}
1309 @emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
1312 ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
1313 '--------------------------------------'
1316 When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
1317 CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
1318 tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
1320 @cindex show all, command
1321 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB},show-all}
1322 Show all, including drawers.
1323 @cindex revealing context
1324 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-reveal}
1325 Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
1326 and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
1327 exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
1328 (@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
1329 level, all sibling headings. With a double prefix argument, also show the
1330 entire subtree of the parent.
1331 @cindex show branches, command
1332 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,show-branches}
1333 Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENT view for just one subtree.
1334 @cindex show children, command
1335 @orgcmd{C-c @key{TAB},show-children}
1336 Expose all direct children of the subtree. With a numeric prefix argument N,
1337 expose all children down to level N.
1338 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
1339 Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
1342 (@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
1345 (see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
1347 will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
1348 tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
1349 but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
1350 prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
1351 negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
1352 the previously used indirect buffer.
1353 @orgcmd{C-c C-x v,org-copy-visible}
1354 Copy the @i{visible} text in the region into the kill ring.
1357 @vindex org-startup-folded
1358 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
1359 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
1360 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
1361 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
1363 When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
1364 OVERVIEW, i.e.@: only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
1365 configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a
1366 per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
1373 #+STARTUP: showeverything
1376 @cindex property, VISIBILITY
1378 Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
1379 and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
1380 for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
1383 @orgcmd{C-u C-u @key{TAB},org-set-startup-visibility}
1384 Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e.@: whatever is
1385 requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
1389 @node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
1391 @cindex motion, between headlines
1392 @cindex jumping, to headlines
1393 @cindex headline navigation
1394 The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
1397 @orgcmd{C-c C-n,outline-next-visible-heading}
1399 @orgcmd{C-c C-p,outline-previous-visible-heading}
1401 @orgcmd{C-c C-f,org-forward-same-level}
1402 Next heading same level.
1403 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-backward-same-level}
1404 Previous heading same level.
1405 @orgcmd{C-c C-u,outline-up-heading}
1406 Backward to higher level heading.
1407 @orgcmd{C-c C-j,org-goto}
1408 Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
1409 visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
1410 you can use the following keys to find your destination:
1411 @vindex org-goto-auto-isearch
1413 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
1414 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1415 @key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
1416 @kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
1417 @r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
1418 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1419 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
1421 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
1424 @vindex org-goto-interface
1426 See also the variable @code{org-goto-interface}.
1429 @node Structure editing, Sparse trees, Motion, Document Structure
1430 @section Structure editing
1431 @cindex structure editing
1432 @cindex headline, promotion and demotion
1433 @cindex promotion, of subtrees
1434 @cindex demotion, of subtrees
1435 @cindex subtree, cut and paste
1436 @cindex pasting, of subtrees
1437 @cindex cutting, of subtrees
1438 @cindex copying, of subtrees
1439 @cindex sorting, of subtrees
1440 @cindex subtrees, cut and paste
1443 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1444 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1445 Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a plain
1446 list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force creation of
1447 a new headline, use a prefix argument. When this command is used in the
1448 middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes the new
1449 headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split, customize the
1450 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If the command is used at the
1451 beginning of a headline, the new headline is created before the current line.
1452 If at the beginning of any other line, the content of that line is made the
1453 new heading. If the command is used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e.@:
1454 behind the ellipses at the end of a headline), then a headline like the
1455 current one will be inserted after the end of the subtree.
1456 @orgcmd{C-@key{RET},org-insert-heading-respect-content}
1457 Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
1458 current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
1459 it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
1460 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
1461 @vindex org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change
1462 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the
1463 variable @code{org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change}.
1464 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content}
1465 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
1466 @kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
1468 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1469 In a new entry with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the entry to
1470 become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1471 and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you are back
1472 to the initial level.
1473 @orgcmd{M-@key{left},org-do-promote}
1474 Promote current heading by one level.
1475 @orgcmd{M-@key{right},org-do-demote}
1476 Demote current heading by one level.
1477 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-promote-subtree}
1478 Promote the current subtree by one level.
1479 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-demote-subtree}
1480 Demote the current subtree by one level.
1481 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-move-subtree-up}
1482 Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
1484 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-move-subtree-down}
1485 Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
1486 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-cut-subtree}
1487 Kill subtree, i.e.@: remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
1488 With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
1489 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-copy-subtree}
1490 Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
1491 sequential subtrees.
1492 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-paste-subtree}
1493 Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
1494 make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
1495 also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
1496 headline marker like @samp{****}.
1497 @orgcmd{C-y,org-yank}
1498 @vindex org-yank-adjusted-subtrees
1499 @vindex org-yank-folded-subtrees
1500 Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
1501 @code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
1502 paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
1503 C-x C-y}. With the default settings, no level adjustment will take place,
1504 but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing so would swallow text
1505 previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal
1506 @code{yank} to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to
1507 force a normal yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a
1508 yank, it will yank previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and
1510 @orgcmd{C-c C-x c,org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}
1511 Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You will be
1512 prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any
1513 timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example,
1514 to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For
1515 more details, see the docstring of the command
1516 @code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}.
1517 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
1518 Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refiling notes}.
1519 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-sort}
1520 Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
1521 region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
1522 sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
1523 alphabetically, numerically, by time (first timestamp with active preferred,
1524 creation time, scheduled time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword
1525 (in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the value
1526 of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply
1527 your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
1528 sorting will be case-sensitive.
1529 @orgcmd{C-x n s,org-narrow-to-subtree}
1530 Narrow buffer to current subtree.
1531 @orgcmd{C-x n b,org-narrow-to-block}
1532 Narrow buffer to current block.
1533 @orgcmd{C-x n w,widen}
1534 Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
1535 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-toggle-heading}
1536 Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
1537 subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by
1538 removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the
1539 region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn
1540 only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a
1541 headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
1544 @cindex region, active
1545 @cindex active region
1546 @cindex transient mark mode
1547 When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and
1548 demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
1549 headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
1550 line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
1551 just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
1552 inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
1556 @node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Structure editing, Document Structure
1557 @section Sparse trees
1558 @cindex sparse trees
1559 @cindex trees, sparse
1560 @cindex folding, sparse trees
1561 @cindex occur, command
1563 @vindex org-show-hierarchy-above
1564 @vindex org-show-following-heading
1565 @vindex org-show-siblings
1566 @vindex org-show-entry-below
1567 An important feature of Org mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
1568 trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
1569 document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
1570 visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
1571 variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
1572 @code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
1573 control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
1574 and you will see immediately how it works.
1576 Org mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
1577 commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
1580 @orgcmd{C-c /,org-sparse-tree}
1581 This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
1582 @orgcmd{C-c / r,org-occur}
1583 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
1584 Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
1585 the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
1586 the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
1587 provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
1588 is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
1589 highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
1590 editing command@footnote{This depends on the option
1591 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
1592 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
1593 so several calls to this command can be stacked.
1594 @orgcmdkkc{M-g n,M-g M-n,next-error}
1595 Jump to the next sparse tree match in this buffer.
1596 @orgcmdkkc{M-g p,M-g M-p,previous-error}
1597 Jump to the previous sparse tree match in this buffer.
1602 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
1603 For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
1604 use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
1605 keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
1606 accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
1610 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
1611 '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
1614 @noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
1615 a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
1617 The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
1618 tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
1621 @cindex printing sparse trees
1622 @cindex visible text, printing
1623 To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
1624 @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
1625 of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
1626 XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
1627 Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible
1628 part of the document and print the resulting file.
1630 @node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
1631 @section Plain lists
1633 @cindex lists, plain
1634 @cindex lists, ordered
1635 @cindex ordered lists
1637 Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
1638 additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of checkboxes
1639 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists, and every exporter
1640 (@pxref{Exporting}) can parse and format them.
1642 Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
1645 @emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
1646 @samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
1647 they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
1648 stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star may
1649 be hard to distinguish from true headlines. In short: even though @samp{*}
1650 is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.} as
1653 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1654 @vindex org-alphabetical-lists
1655 @emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
1656 a right parenthesis@footnote{You can filter out any of them by configuring
1657 @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}.}, such as @samp{1.} or
1658 @samp{1)}@footnote{You can also get @samp{a.}, @samp{A.}, @samp{a)} and
1659 @samp{A)} by configuring @code{org-alphabetical-lists}. To minimize
1660 confusion with normal text, those are limited to one character only. Beyond
1661 that limit, bullets will automatically fallback to numbers.}. If you want a
1662 list to start with a different value (e.g.@: 20), start the text of the item
1663 with @code{[@@20]}@footnote{If there's a checkbox in the item, the cookie
1664 must be put @emph{before} the checkbox. If you have activated alphabetical
1665 lists, you can also use counters like @code{[@@b]}.}. Those constructs can
1666 be used in any item of the list in order to enforce a particular numbering.
1668 @emph{Description} list items are unordered list items, and contain the
1669 separator @samp{ :: } to distinguish the description @emph{term} from the
1673 Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
1674 line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
1675 2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
1676 list. An item ends before the next line that is less or equally indented
1677 than its bullet/number.
1679 @vindex org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists
1680 A list ends whenever every item has ended, which means before any line less
1681 or equally indented than items at top level. It also ends before two blank
1682 lines@footnote{See also @code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.}. In
1683 that case, all items are closed. Here is an example:
1687 ** Lord of the Rings
1688 My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1689 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
1690 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
1691 + this was already my favorite scene in the book
1692 + I really like Miranda Otto.
1693 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
1695 He makes a really funny face when it happens.
1696 But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
1697 Important actors in this film are:
1698 - @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays Frodo
1699 - @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
1700 him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in @i{The Goonies}.
1704 Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with
1705 them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling settings for Emacs. For
1706 XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones' @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on,
1707 put into @file{.emacs}: @code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them
1708 properly (@pxref{Exporting}). Since indentation is what governs the
1709 structure of these lists, many structural constructs like @code{#+BEGIN_...}
1710 blocks can be indented to signal that they belong to a particular item.
1712 @vindex org-list-demote-modify-bullet
1713 @vindex org-list-indent-offset
1714 If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list (than that used for
1715 the current list-level) improves readability, customize the variable
1716 @code{org-list-demote-modify-bullet}. To get a greater difference of
1717 indentation between items and theirs sub-items, customize
1718 @code{org-list-indent-offset}.
1720 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1721 The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line of
1722 an item (the line with the bullet or number). Some of them imply the
1723 application of automatic rules to keep list structure intact. If some of
1724 these actions get in your way, configure @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
1725 to disable them individually.
1728 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1729 @cindex cycling, in plain lists
1730 @vindex org-cycle-include-plain-lists
1731 Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if
1732 the cursor is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable
1733 @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. If this variable is set to
1734 @code{integrate}, plain list items will be treated like low-level
1735 headlines. The level of an item is then given by the indentation of the
1736 bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real headlines, however; the
1737 hierarchies remain completely separated. In a new item with no text yet, the
1738 first @key{TAB} demotes the item to become a child of the previous
1739 one. Subsequent @key{TAB}s move the item to meaningful levels in the list
1740 and eventually get it back to its initial position.
1741 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1742 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1743 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1744 Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
1745 heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
1746 of an item, that item is @emph{split} in two, and the second part becomes the
1747 new item@footnote{If you do not want the item to be split, customize the
1748 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed
1749 @emph{before item's body}, the new item is created @emph{before} the current
1754 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1756 Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
1757 @kindex S-@key{down}
1760 @cindex shift-selection-mode
1761 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1762 @vindex org-list-use-circular-motion
1763 Jump to the previous/next item in the current list@footnote{If you want to
1764 cycle around items that way, you may customize
1765 @code{org-list-use-circular-motion}.}, but only if
1766 @code{org-support-shift-select} is off. If not, you can still use paragraph
1767 jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{up}} and @kbd{C-@key{down}} to quite
1770 @kindex M-@key{down}
1773 Move the item including subitems up/down@footnote{See
1774 @code{org-liste-use-circular-motion} for a cyclic behavior.} (swap with
1775 previous/next item of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering
1777 @kindex M-@key{left}
1778 @kindex M-@key{right}
1781 Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children alone.
1782 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1783 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1786 Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
1787 Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation. When
1788 these commands are executed several times in direct succession, the initially
1789 selected region is used, even if the new indentation would imply a different
1790 hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break the command chain with a cursor
1793 As a special case, using this command on the very first item of a list will
1794 move the whole list. This behavior can be disabled by configuring
1795 @code{org-list-automatic-rules}. The global indentation of a list has no
1796 influence on the text @emph{after} the list.
1799 If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
1800 state of the checkbox. In any case, verify bullets and indentation
1801 consistency in the whole list.
1803 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1805 Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
1806 (@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}) or a subset of them,
1807 depending on @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}, the type of list,
1808 and its indentation. With a numeric prefix argument N, select the Nth bullet
1809 from this list. If there is an active region when calling this, selected
1810 text will be changed into an item. With a prefix argument, all lines will be
1811 converted to list items. If the first line already was a list item, any item
1812 marker will be removed from the list. Finally, even without an active
1813 region, a normal line will be converted into a list item.
1816 Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at
1817 its location). @xref{Structure editing}, for a detailed explanation.
1820 Turn the whole plain list into a subtree of the current heading. Checkboxes
1821 (@pxref{Checkboxes}) will become TODO (resp. DONE) keywords when unchecked
1823 @kindex S-@key{left}
1824 @kindex S-@key{right}
1826 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1827 This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or
1828 anywhere in an item line, details depending on
1829 @code{org-support-shift-select}.
1832 Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method:
1833 numerically, alphabetically, by time, or by custom function.
1836 @node Drawers, Blocks, Plain lists, Document Structure
1840 @cindex visibility cycling, drawers
1843 @cindex org-insert-drawer
1845 Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
1846 normally don't want to see it. For this, Org mode has @emph{drawers}.
1847 Drawers need to be configured with the variable
1848 @code{org-drawers}@footnote{You can define additional drawers on a
1849 per-file basis with a line like @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN STATE}}. Drawers
1853 ** This is a headline
1854 Still outside the drawer
1856 This is inside the drawer.
1861 You can interactively insert drawers at point by calling
1862 @code{org-insert-drawer}, which is bound to @key{C-c C-x d}. With an active
1863 region, this command will put the region inside the drawer. With a prefix
1864 argument, this command calls @code{org-insert-property-drawer} and add a
1865 property drawer right below the current headline. Completion over drawer
1866 keywords is also possible using @key{M-TAB}.
1868 Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will hide and
1869 show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to
1870 look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the drawer line and
1871 press @key{TAB} there. Org mode uses the @code{PROPERTIES} drawer for
1872 storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and you can also arrange
1873 for state change notes (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}) and clock times
1874 (@pxref{Clocking work time}) to be stored in a drawer @code{LOGBOOK}. If you
1875 want to store a quick note in the LOGBOOK drawer, in a similar way to state changes, use
1880 Add a time-stamped note to the LOGBOOK drawer.
1883 @node Blocks, Footnotes, Drawers, Document Structure
1886 @vindex org-hide-block-startup
1887 @cindex blocks, folding
1888 Org mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including source
1889 code examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) to capturing time logging
1890 information (@pxref{Clocking work time}). These blocks can be folded and
1891 unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also get all blocks
1892 folded at startup by configuring the variable @code{org-hide-block-startup}
1893 or on a per-file basis by using
1895 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1896 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1898 #+STARTUP: hideblocks
1899 #+STARTUP: nohideblocks
1902 @node Footnotes, Orgstruct mode, Blocks, Document Structure
1906 Org mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
1907 @file{footnote.el} package, Org mode's footnotes are designed for work on a
1908 larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails. The basic
1909 syntax is similar to the one used by @file{footnote.el}, i.e.@: a footnote is
1910 defined in a paragraph that is started by a footnote marker in square
1911 brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. If you need a paragraph break
1912 inside a footnote, use the @LaTeX{} idiom @samp{\par}. The footnote reference
1913 is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. For example:
1916 The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
1918 [fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
1921 Org mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
1922 optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
1923 @file{footnote.el} does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
1924 encouraged because of possible conflicts with @LaTeX{} snippets (@pxref{Embedded
1925 @LaTeX{}}). Here are the valid references:
1929 A plain numeric footnote marker. Compatible with @file{footnote.el}, but not
1930 recommended because something like @samp{[1]} could easily be part of a code
1933 A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
1934 simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
1935 @item [fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]
1936 A @LaTeX{}-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
1938 @item [fn:name: a definition]
1939 An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
1940 Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use
1941 @code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
1944 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
1945 Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself.
1946 This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
1947 corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords. See the docstring of that variable
1950 @noindent The following command handles footnotes:
1955 The footnote action command.
1957 When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
1958 is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
1960 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
1961 @vindex org-footnote-section
1962 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
1963 Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
1964 @code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
1965 setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
1966 definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
1967 separately into the location determined by the variable
1968 @code{org-footnote-section}.
1970 When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
1973 s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
1974 @r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
1975 @r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
1976 @r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}. Automatic}
1977 @r{sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the}
1978 @r{variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1979 r @r{Renumber the simple @code{fn:N} footnotes. Automatic renumbering}
1980 @r{after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the variable}
1981 @r{@code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1982 S @r{Short for first @code{r}, then @code{s} action.}
1983 n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
1984 @r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
1985 @r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is}
1986 @r{meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g.@: sending}
1987 @r{off an email). The exporters do this automatically, and so could}
1988 @r{something like @code{message-send-hook}.}
1989 d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
1992 Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}@footnote{the
1993 corresponding in-buffer options are @code{fnadjust} and @code{nofnadjust}.},
1994 renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or
1999 If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
2000 the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
2001 location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
2005 @item C-c C-o @r{or} mouse-1/2
2006 Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
2007 you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
2010 @node Orgstruct mode, , Footnotes, Document Structure
2011 @section The Orgstruct minor mode
2012 @cindex Orgstruct mode
2013 @cindex minor mode for structure editing
2015 If you like the intuitive way the Org mode structure editing and list
2016 formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes like
2017 Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode @code{orgstruct-mode} makes
2018 this possible. Toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x orgstruct-mode}, or
2019 turn it on by default, for example in Message mode, with one of:
2022 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
2023 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++)
2026 When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to Org like a
2027 headline or the first line of a list item, most structure editing commands
2028 will work, even if the same keys normally have different functionality in the
2029 major mode you are using. If the cursor is not in one of those special
2030 lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in the shadows. When you use
2031 @code{orgstruct++-mode}, Org will also export indentation and autofill
2032 settings into that mode, and detect item context after the first line of an
2035 @node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
2038 @cindex editing tables
2040 Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
2041 calculations are supported using the Emacs @file{calc} package
2042 (@pxref{Top, Calc, , calc, Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
2045 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
2046 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
2047 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
2048 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
2049 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
2050 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
2053 @node Built-in table editor, Column width and alignment, Tables, Tables
2054 @section The built-in table editor
2055 @cindex table editor, built-in
2057 Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII. Any line with @samp{|} as
2058 the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a table. @samp{|}
2059 is also the column separator@footnote{To insert a vertical bar into a table
2060 field, use @code{\vert} or, inside a word @code{abc\vert@{@}def}.}. A table
2061 might look like this:
2064 | Name | Phone | Age |
2065 |-------+-------+-----|
2066 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
2067 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
2070 A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
2071 @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
2072 the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
2073 at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
2074 of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
2075 @samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
2076 expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
2077 create the above table, you would only type
2084 @noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
2085 fields. Even faster would be to type @code{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by
2086 @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.
2088 @vindex org-enable-table-editor
2089 @vindex org-table-auto-blank-field
2090 When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
2091 @key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
2092 inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
2093 typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
2094 with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
2095 field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
2096 unpredictable for you, configure the variables
2097 @code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
2100 @tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
2101 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2102 Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
2103 TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
2104 If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
2105 If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
2106 argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
2107 C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
2108 consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
2110 If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
2111 table. But it is easier just to start typing, like
2112 @kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
2114 @tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
2115 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-table-align}
2116 Re-align the table without moving the cursor.
2118 @orgcmd{<TAB>,org-table-next-field}
2119 Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
2122 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-table-previous-field}
2123 Re-align, move to previous field.
2125 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-table-next-row}
2126 Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
2127 necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
2128 NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
2130 @orgcmd{M-a,org-table-beginning-of-field}
2131 Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field.
2132 @orgcmd{M-e,org-table-end-of-field}
2133 Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
2135 @tsubheading{Column and row editing}
2136 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{left},M-@key{right},org-table-move-column-left,org-table-move-column-right}
2137 Move the current column left/right.
2139 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-table-delete-column}
2140 Kill the current column.
2142 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-table-insert-column}
2143 Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
2145 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-move-row-up,org-table-move-row-down}
2146 Move the current row up/down.
2148 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-table-kill-row}
2149 Kill the current row or horizontal line.
2151 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-table-insert-row}
2152 Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
2153 created below the current one.
2155 @orgcmd{C-c -,org-table-insert-hline}
2156 Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
2157 is created above the current line.
2159 @orgcmd{C-c @key{RET},org-table-hline-and-move}
2160 Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row
2163 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-table-sort-lines}
2164 Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
2165 column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
2166 between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
2167 point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
2168 column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
2169 and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
2170 included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
2171 (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
2172 argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
2174 @tsubheading{Regions}
2175 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-table-copy-region}
2176 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and
2177 mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region,
2178 copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines.
2180 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-table-cut-region}
2181 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
2182 blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
2184 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-table-paste-rectangle}
2185 Paste a rectangular region into a table.
2186 The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
2187 will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
2188 the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
2191 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-table-wrap-region}
2192 Split the current field at the cursor position and move the rest to the line
2193 below. If there is an active region, and both point and mark are in the same
2194 column, the text in the column is wrapped to minimum width for the given
2195 number of lines. A numeric prefix argument may be used to change the number
2196 of desired lines. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument,
2197 the current field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field
2200 @tsubheading{Calculations}
2201 @cindex formula, in tables
2202 @cindex calculations, in tables
2203 @cindex region, active
2204 @cindex active region
2205 @cindex transient mark mode
2206 @orgcmd{C-c +,org-table-sum}
2207 Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
2208 the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
2209 be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
2211 @orgcmd{S-@key{RET},org-table-copy-down}
2212 @vindex org-table-copy-increment
2213 When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
2214 empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
2215 Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
2216 values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
2217 be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the
2218 increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes
2219 (@pxref{Conflicts}).
2221 @tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
2222 @orgcmd{C-c `,org-table-edit-field}
2223 Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that
2224 are not fully visible (@pxref{Column width and alignment}). When called with
2225 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
2226 edited in place. When called with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes, make the editor
2227 window follow the cursor through the table and always show the current
2228 field. The follow mode exits automatically when the cursor leaves the table,
2229 or when you repeat this command with @kbd{C-u C-u C-c `}.
2231 @item M-x org-table-import
2232 Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
2233 separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
2234 from a database, because these programs generally can write
2235 TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
2236 the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
2237 argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
2239 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2240 Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
2241 buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
2242 @kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
2244 @item M-x org-table-export
2245 @findex org-table-export
2246 @vindex org-table-export-default-format
2247 Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data
2248 exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
2249 used to export the file can be configured in the variable
2250 @code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
2251 @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
2252 name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
2253 general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
2254 format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions}, for a
2255 detailed description.
2258 If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
2259 way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
2263 (setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
2266 @noindent Then the only table command that still works is
2267 @kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
2269 @node Column width and alignment, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
2270 @section Column width and alignment
2271 @cindex narrow columns in tables
2272 @cindex alignment in tables
2274 The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. And
2275 also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction
2276 of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
2278 Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, leading to
2279 inconveniently wide columns. Or maybe you want to make a table with several
2280 columns having a fixed width, regardless of content. To set@footnote{This
2281 feature does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere
2282 in the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
2283 integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next re-align
2284 will then set the width of this column to this value.
2288 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2290 | 1 | one | | 1 | one |
2291 | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
2292 | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
2293 | 4 | four | | 4 | four |
2294 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2299 Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
2300 Note that the full text is still in the buffer but is hidden.
2301 To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field---a tool-tip window
2302 will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
2303 @kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
2304 open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
2307 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
2308 When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
2309 necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
2310 be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
2311 @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
2312 upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
2313 on a per-file basis with:
2320 If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns
2321 to the right and of string-rich column to the left, you can use @samp{<r>},
2322 @samp{<c>}@footnote{Centering does not work inside Emacs, but it does have an
2323 effect when exporting to HTML.} or @samp{<l>} in a similar fashion. You may
2324 also combine alignment and field width like this: @samp{<l10>}.
2326 Lines which only contain these formatting cookies will be removed
2327 automatically when exporting the document.
2329 @node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Column width and alignment, Tables
2330 @section Column groups
2331 @cindex grouping columns in tables
2333 When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
2334 lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
2335 however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
2336 of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
2337 order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
2338 first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
2339 contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
2340 @samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} (no space between @samp{<}
2341 and @samp{>}) to make a column
2342 a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
2343 marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
2346 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2347 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2348 | / | < | | > | < | > |
2349 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
2350 | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
2351 | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
2352 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2353 #+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1)))
2356 It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
2357 every vertical line you would like to have:
2360 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2361 |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2365 @node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
2366 @section The Orgtbl minor mode
2368 @cindex minor mode for tables
2370 If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
2371 might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
2372 The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
2373 the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for
2374 example in Message mode, use
2377 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
2380 Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
2381 in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
2382 construct @LaTeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
2383 Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
2384 @ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
2386 @node The spreadsheet, Org-Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
2387 @section The spreadsheet
2388 @cindex calculations, in tables
2389 @cindex spreadsheet capabilities
2390 @cindex @file{calc} package
2392 The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
2393 spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
2394 derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's implementation
2395 is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, Org knows the concept
2396 of a @emph{column formula} that will be applied to all non-header fields in a
2397 column without having to copy the formula to each relevant field. There is
2398 also a formula debugger, and a formula editor with features for highlighting
2399 fields in the table corresponding to the references at the point in the
2400 formula, moving these references by arrow keys
2403 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
2404 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
2405 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
2406 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
2407 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
2408 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
2409 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
2410 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
2411 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
2414 @node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
2415 @subsection References
2418 To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
2419 reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
2420 by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
2421 out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
2422 field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
2424 @subsubheading Field references
2425 @cindex field references
2426 @cindex references, to fields
2428 Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
2429 any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
2430 combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
2431 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2432 However, Org prefers@footnote{Org will understand references typed by the
2433 user as @samp{B4}, but it will not use this syntax when offering a formula
2434 for editing. You can customize this behavior using the variable
2435 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.} to use another, more general
2436 representation that looks like this:
2438 @@@var{row}$@var{column}
2441 Column specifications can be absolute like @code{$1},
2442 @code{$2},...@code{$@var{N}}, or relative to the current column (i.e.@: the
2443 column of the field which is being computed) like @code{$+1} or @code{$-2}.
2444 @code{$<} and @code{$>} are immutable references to the first and last
2445 column, respectively, and you can use @code{$>>>} to indicate the third
2446 column from the right.
2448 The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal separator
2449 lines (hlines). Like with columns, you can use absolute row numbers
2450 @code{@@1}, @code{@@2},...@code{@@@var{N}}, and row numbers relative to the
2451 current row like @code{@@+3} or @code{@@-1}. @code{@@<} and @code{@@>} are
2452 immutable references the first and last@footnote{For backward compatibility
2453 you can also use special names like @code{$LR5} and @code{$LR12} to refer in
2454 a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the table.
2455 However, this syntax is deprecated, it should not be used for new documents.
2456 Use @code{@@>$} instead.} row in the table, respectively. You may also
2457 specify the row relative to one of the hlines: @code{@@I} refers to the first
2458 hline, @code{@@II} to the second, etc@. @code{@@-I} refers to the first such
2459 line above the current line, @code{@@+I} to the first such line below the
2460 current line. You can also write @code{@@III+2} which is the second data line
2461 after the third hline in the table.
2463 @code{@@0} and @code{$0} refer to the current row and column, respectively,
2464 i.e. to the row/column for the field being computed. Also, if you omit
2465 either the column or the row part of the reference, the current row/column is
2468 Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
2469 in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
2470 different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
2471 Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
2472 references because the same reference operator can reference different
2473 fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
2475 Here are a few examples:
2478 @@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column (same as @code{C2})}
2479 $5 @r{column 5 in the current row (same as @code{E&})}
2480 @@2 @r{current column, row 2}
2481 @@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
2482 @@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
2483 @@>$5 @r{field in the last row, in column 5}
2486 @subsubheading Range references
2487 @cindex range references
2488 @cindex references, to ranges
2490 You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
2491 references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
2492 current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
2493 is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
2494 format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
2495 @samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
2498 $1..$3 @r{first three fields in the current row}
2499 $P..$Q @r{range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
2500 $<<<..$>> @r{start in third column, continue to the one but last}
2501 @@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields (same as @code{A2..C4})}
2502 @@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{3 numbers from the column to the left, 2 up to current row}
2503 @@I..II @r{between first and second hline, short for @code{@@I..@@II}}
2506 @noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
2507 into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally
2508 suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but
2509 see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields,
2510 @samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
2512 @subsubheading Field coordinates in formulas
2513 @cindex field coordinates
2514 @cindex coordinates, of field
2515 @cindex row, of field coordinates
2516 @cindex column, of field coordinates
2518 For Calc formulas and Lisp formulas @code{@@#} and @code{$#} can be used to
2519 get the row or column number of the field where the formula result goes.
2520 The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are @code{org-table-current-dline}
2521 and @code{org-table-current-column}. Examples:
2524 if(@@# % 2, $#, string("")) @r{column number on odd lines only}
2525 $3 = remote(FOO, @@@@#$2) @r{copy column 2 from table FOO into}
2526 @r{column 3 of the current table}
2529 @noindent For the second example, table FOO must have at least as many rows
2530 as the current table. Note that this is inefficient@footnote{The computation time scales as
2531 O(N^2) because table FOO is parsed for each field to be copied.} for large
2534 @subsubheading Named references
2535 @cindex named references
2536 @cindex references, named
2537 @cindex name, of column or field
2538 @cindex constants, in calculations
2541 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
2542 @samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
2543 constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable
2544 @code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
2548 #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
2552 @vindex constants-unit-system
2553 @pindex constants.el
2554 Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
2555 constants in table formulas: for a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
2556 @samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
2557 outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
2558 @file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
2559 including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
2560 units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{constants.el} can
2561 supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
2562 and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
2563 @code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
2564 @code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
2565 buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
2566 lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
2567 names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
2570 @subsubheading Remote references
2571 @cindex remote references
2572 @cindex references, remote
2573 @cindex references, to a different table
2574 @cindex name, of column or field
2575 @cindex constants, in calculations
2578 You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table,
2579 either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is
2582 remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
2586 where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
2587 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
2588 entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first
2589 table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as
2590 described above for example @code{@@3$3} or @code{$somename}, valid in the
2593 @node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
2594 @subsection Formula syntax for Calc
2595 @cindex formula syntax, Calc
2596 @cindex syntax, of formulas
2598 A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
2599 @file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the
2600 non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
2601 @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before
2602 evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from
2603 Your Programs, calc-eval, Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs, calc, GNU
2604 Emacs Calc Manual}),
2605 variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above.
2606 @cindex vectors, in table calculations
2607 The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
2608 like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
2610 @cindex format specifier
2611 @cindex mode, for @file{calc}
2612 @vindex org-calc-default-modes
2613 A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
2614 string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
2615 execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
2616 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
2617 format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 8)} to keep tables
2618 compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
2619 @code{org-calc-default-modes}.
2622 p20 @r{set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits}
2623 n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{Normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed}
2624 @r{format of the result of Calc passed back to Org.}
2625 @r{Calc formatting is unlimited in precision as}
2626 @r{long as the Calc calculation precision is greater.}
2627 D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians}
2628 F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes}
2629 N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers}
2630 E @r{keep empty fields in ranges}
2635 Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision-calculation
2636 and -display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a
2637 @code{printf} format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been
2638 passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the
2639 formatting@footnote{The @code{printf} reformatting is limited in precision
2640 because the value passed to it is converted into an @code{integer} or
2641 @code{double}. The @code{integer} is limited in size by truncating the
2642 signed value to 32 bits. The @code{double} is limited in precision to 64
2643 bits overall which leaves approximately 16 significant decimal digits.}.
2647 $1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
2648 $1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
2649 exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
2650 $0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
2651 ($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
2652 $c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
2653 tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
2654 sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
2655 vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, using vector function}
2656 vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0}
2657 taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{Taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
2660 Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
2663 if($1<20,teen,string("")) @r{"teen" if age $1 less than 20, else empty}
2666 Note that you can also use two org-specific flags @code{T} and @code{t} for
2667 durations computations @ref{Durations and time values}.
2669 @node Formula syntax for Lisp, Durations and time values, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
2670 @subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
2671 @cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
2673 It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp. This can be useful
2674 for string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's functionality is
2677 If a formula starts with a single-quote followed by an opening parenthesis,
2678 then it is evaluated as a Lisp form. The evaluation should return either a
2679 string or a number. Just as with @file{calc} formulas, you can specify modes
2680 and a printf format after a semicolon.
2682 With Emacs Lisp forms, you need to be conscious about the way field
2683 references are interpolated into the form. By default, a reference will be
2684 interpolated as a Lisp string (in double-quotes) containing the field. If
2685 you provide the @samp{N} mode switch, all referenced elements will be numbers
2686 (non-number fields will be zero) and interpolated as Lisp numbers, without
2687 quotes. If you provide the @samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated
2688 literally, without quotes. I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted
2689 as a string by the Lisp form, enclose the reference operator itself in
2690 double-quotes, like @code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated
2691 fields, so you can embed them in list or vector syntax.
2693 Here are a few examples---note how the @samp{N} mode is used when we do
2694 computations in Lisp:
2697 @r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1}
2698 '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
2699 @r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @code{$1+$2}}
2701 @r{Compute the sum of columns 1-4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}}
2702 '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
2705 @node Durations and time values, Field and range formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
2706 @subsection Durations and time values
2707 @cindex Duration, computing
2708 @cindex Time, computing
2709 @vindex org-table-duration-custom-format
2711 If you want to compute time values use the @code{T} flag, either in Calc
2712 formulas or Elisp formulas:
2716 | Task 1 | Task 2 | Total |
2717 |---------+----------+----------|
2718 | 2:12 | 1:47 | 03:59:00 |
2719 | 3:02:20 | -2:07:00 | 0.92 |
2720 #+TBLFM: @@2$3=$1+$2;T::@@3$3=$1+$2;t
2724 Input duration values must be of the form @code{[HH:MM[:SS]}, where seconds
2725 are optional. With the @code{T} flag, computed durations will be displayed
2726 as @code{HH:MM:SS} (see the first formula above). With the @code{t} flag,
2727 computed durations will be displayed according to the value of the variable
2728 @code{org-table-duration-custom-format}, which defaults to @code{'hours} and
2729 will display the result as a fraction of hours (see the second formula in the
2732 Negative duration values can be manipulated as well, and integers will be
2733 considered as seconds in addition and subtraction.
2735 @node Field and range formulas, Column formulas, Durations and time values, The spreadsheet
2736 @subsection Field and range formulas
2737 @cindex field formula
2738 @cindex range formula
2739 @cindex formula, for individual table field
2740 @cindex formula, for range of fields
2742 To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the field,
2743 preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=vsum(@@II..III)}. When you press
2744 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2745 the formula will be stored as the formula for this field, evaluated, and the
2746 current field will be replaced with the result.
2749 Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:} directly
2750 below the table. If you type the equation in the 4th field of the 3rd data
2751 line in the table, the formula will look like @samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When
2752 inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows with the appropriate commands,
2753 @i{absolute references} (but not relative ones) in stored formulas are
2754 modified in order to still reference the same field. To avoid this from
2755 happening, in particular in range references, anchor ranges at the table
2756 borders (using @code{@@<}, @code{@@>}, @code{$<}, @code{$>}), or at hlines
2757 using the @code{@@I} notation. Automatic adaptation of field references does
2758 of course not happen if you edit the table structure with normal editing
2759 commands---then you must fix the equations yourself.
2761 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the following
2765 @orgcmd{C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2766 Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
2767 formula with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
2768 it to the current field, and stores it.
2771 The left-hand side of a formula can also be a special expression in order to
2772 assign the formula to a number of different fields. There is no keyboard
2773 shortcut to enter such range formulas. To add them, use the formula editor
2774 (@pxref{Editing and debugging formulas}) or edit the @code{#+TBLFM:} line
2779 Column formula, valid for the entire column. This is so common that Org
2780 treats these formulas in a special way, see @ref{Column formulas}.
2782 Row formula, applies to all fields in the specified row. @code{@@>=} means
2785 Range formula, applies to all fields in the given rectangular range. This
2786 can also be used to assign a formula to some but not all fields in a row.
2788 Named field, see @ref{Advanced features}.
2791 @node Column formulas, Editing and debugging formulas, Field and range formulas, The spreadsheet
2792 @subsection Column formulas
2793 @cindex column formula
2794 @cindex formula, for table column
2796 When you assign a formula to a simple column reference like @code{$3=}, the
2797 same formula will be used in all fields of that column, with the following
2798 very convenient exceptions: (i) If the table contains horizontal separator
2799 hlines, everything before the first such line is considered part of the table
2800 @emph{header} and will not be modified by column formulas. (ii) Fields that
2801 already get a value from a field/range formula will be left alone by column
2802 formulas. These conditions make column formulas very easy to use.
2804 To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
2805 column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
2806 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2807 the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated
2808 and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only
2809 @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each
2810 column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In the
2811 @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like @samp{$4=$1+$2}. The
2812 left-hand side of a column formula can not be the name of column, it must be
2813 the numeric column reference or @code{$>}.
2815 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2819 @orgcmd{C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2820 Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
2821 the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
2822 taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
2823 stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g.@: @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
2824 will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
2827 @node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
2828 @subsection Editing and debugging formulas
2829 @cindex formula editing
2830 @cindex editing, of table formulas
2832 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2833 You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
2834 field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active
2835 formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org
2836 converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&})
2837 if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like
2838 @code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable
2839 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
2842 @orgcmdkkc{C-c =,C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2843 Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
2844 minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas}, and @ref{Field and range formulas}.
2845 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2846 Re-insert the active formula (either a
2847 field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
2848 can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
2849 minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
2850 @orgcmd{C-c ?,org-table-field-info}
2851 While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
2852 referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
2854 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2856 Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using overlays
2857 (@command{org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays}). These are updated each
2858 time the table is aligned; you can force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2860 @findex org-table-toggle-formula-debugger
2862 Toggle the formula debugger on and off
2863 (@command{org-table-toggle-formula-debugger}). See below.
2864 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-table-edit-formulas}
2865 Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
2866 formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
2867 active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
2868 While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
2869 any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
2870 remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
2872 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-x C-s,org-table-fedit-finish}
2873 Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
2874 prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
2875 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-table-fedit-abort}
2876 Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
2877 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type}
2878 Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
2879 @code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
2880 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-table-fedit-lisp-indent}
2881 Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
2882 a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
2883 Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
2884 formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2885 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},lisp-complete-symbol}
2886 Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2888 @kindex S-@key{down}
2889 @kindex S-@key{left}
2890 @kindex S-@key{right}
2891 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-up
2892 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-down
2893 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-left
2894 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-right
2895 @item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
2896 Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
2897 @code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
2898 This also works for relative references and for hline references.
2899 @orgcmdkkcc{M-S-@key{up},M-S-@key{down},org-table-fedit-line-up,org-table-fedit-line-down}
2900 Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
2902 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-fedit-scroll-down,org-table-fedit-scroll-up}
2903 Scroll the window displaying the table.
2905 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2907 Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
2911 Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
2912 the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{#+TBLFM}
2913 line)---during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
2914 To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
2915 prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
2918 You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
2919 equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line or with the normal
2920 recalculation commands in the table.
2922 @subsubheading Debugging formulas
2923 @cindex formula debugging
2924 @cindex debugging, of table formulas
2925 When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
2926 becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
2927 on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
2928 turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
2929 calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
2930 field. Detailed information will be displayed.
2932 @node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
2933 @subsection Updating the table
2934 @cindex recomputing table fields
2935 @cindex updating, table
2937 Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
2938 triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features}, for a way to make
2939 recalculation at least semi-automatic.
2941 In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
2945 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-table-recalculate}
2946 Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
2947 from left to right, and all field/range formulas in the current row.
2953 Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
2954 hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
2956 @orgcmdkkc{C-u C-u C-c *,C-u C-u C-c C-c,org-table-iterate}
2957 Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
2958 This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
2959 fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
2960 @item M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2961 @findex org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2962 Recompute all tables in the current buffer.
2963 @item M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2964 @findex org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2965 Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge table-to-table
2969 @node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
2970 @subsection Advanced features
2972 If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if you
2973 want to be able to assign @i{names}@footnote{Such names must start by an
2974 alphabetic character and use only alphanumeric/underscore characters.} to
2975 fields and columns, you need to reserve the first column of the table for
2976 special marking characters.
2979 @orgcmd{C-#,org-table-rotate-recalc-marks}
2980 Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{ },
2981 @samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
2982 change all marks in the region.
2985 Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
2986 makes use of these features:
2990 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2991 | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
2992 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2993 | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
2994 | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
2995 | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
2996 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2997 | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
2998 | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
2999 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
3000 | | Average | | | | 25.0 | |
3001 | ^ | | | | | at | |
3002 | $ | max=50 | | | | | |
3003 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
3004 #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
3008 @noindent @b{Important}: please note that for these special tables,
3009 recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
3010 are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
3011 to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
3014 @cindex marking characters, tables
3015 The marking characters have the following meaning:
3018 The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
3019 refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
3021 This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
3022 a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
3023 the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
3024 will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
3026 Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
3029 Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
3030 example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
3031 formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
3032 Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
3035 Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
3036 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
3037 is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
3038 lines will be left alone by this command.
3040 Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
3041 not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
3042 recalculation slows down editing too much.
3044 Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
3045 All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
3048 Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
3049 @samp{<N>} markers or column group markers.
3052 Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
3053 fantastic @file{calc.el} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
3054 series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
3059 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3060 | | Func | n | x | Result |
3061 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3062 | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
3063 | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
3064 | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
3065 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
3066 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
3067 | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
3068 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3069 #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
3073 @node Org-Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
3075 @cindex graph, in tables
3076 @cindex plot tables using Gnuplot
3079 Org-Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
3080 using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
3081 @uref{http://cars9.uchicago.edu/~ravel/software/gnuplot-mode.html}. To see
3082 this in action, ensure that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed
3083 on your system, then call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
3087 #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
3088 | Sede | Max cites | H-index |
3089 |-----------+-----------+---------|
3090 | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
3091 | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
3092 | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
3093 | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
3094 | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
3098 Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels.
3099 Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
3100 be exercised through the @code{#+PLOT:} lines preceding a table. See below
3101 for a complete list of Org-plot options. For more information and examples
3102 see the Org-plot tutorial at
3103 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.html}.
3105 @subsubheading Plot Options
3109 Specify any @command{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
3112 Specify the title of the plot.
3115 Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
3118 Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses
3119 and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
3120 fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the @code{ind}
3124 Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
3127 Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
3128 (e.g.@: @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
3129 Defaults to @code{lines}.
3132 If you want to plot to a file, specify @code{"@var{path/to/desired/output-file}"}.
3135 List of labels to be used for the @code{deps} (defaults to the column headers
3139 Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
3142 When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
3143 flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
3146 Specify format of Org mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot.
3147 Defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S}.
3150 If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place the file name
3151 between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
3152 instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
3153 the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you
3154 may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
3158 @node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
3162 Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
3163 other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
3166 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
3167 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
3168 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
3169 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
3170 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
3171 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
3172 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
3173 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
3176 @node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
3177 @section Link format
3179 @cindex format, of links
3181 Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
3182 clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
3185 [[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
3189 Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
3190 will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
3191 of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
3192 @samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
3193 which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
3194 visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
3195 part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
3196 edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
3199 If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
3200 displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
3201 (invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
3202 and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
3203 missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
3204 internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
3205 @code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
3207 @node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
3208 @section Internal links
3209 @cindex internal links
3210 @cindex links, internal
3211 @cindex targets, for links
3213 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3214 If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in the
3215 current file. The most important case is a link like
3216 @samp{[[#my-custom-id]]} which will link to the entry with the
3217 @code{CUSTOM_ID} property @samp{my-custom-id}. Such custom IDs are very good
3218 for HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}) where they produce pretty section
3219 links. You are responsible yourself to make sure these custom IDs are unique
3222 Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My Target][Find my target]]}
3223 lead to a text search in the current file.
3225 The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the link,
3226 or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). Links to custom IDs will
3227 point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for a text link is
3228 a @i{dedicated target}: the same string in double angular brackets. Targets
3229 may be located anywhere; sometimes it is convenient to put them into a
3230 comment line. For example
3236 @noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become
3237 named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note that
3238 text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the first such
3239 target should be after the first headline, or in the line directly before the
3242 If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for a headline that is exactly
3243 the link text but may also include a TODO keyword and tags@footnote{To insert
3244 a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can be used. Just type a
3245 star followed by a few optional letters into the buffer and press
3246 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current buffer will be offered as
3247 completions.}. In non-Org files, the search will look for the words in the
3248 link text. In the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}.
3250 Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
3251 return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
3252 several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
3256 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
3259 @node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
3260 @subsection Radio targets
3261 @cindex radio targets
3262 @cindex targets, radio
3263 @cindex links, radio targets
3265 Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
3266 in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
3267 text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
3268 enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
3269 Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
3270 become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
3271 for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
3272 update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3273 cursor on or at a target.
3275 @node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
3276 @section External links
3277 @cindex links, external
3278 @cindex external links
3279 @cindex links, external
3287 @cindex WANDERLUST links
3289 @cindex USENET links
3294 Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages,
3295 BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their
3296 logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
3297 identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
3298 the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
3301 http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
3302 doi:10.1000/182 @r{DOI for an electronic resource}
3303 file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
3304 /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
3305 file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
3306 ./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3307 file:/myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{file, path on remote machine}
3308 /myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3309 file:sometextfile::NNN @r{file, jump to line number}
3310 file:projects.org @r{another Org file}
3311 file:projects.org::some words @r{text search in Org file}@footnote{
3312 The actual behavior of the search will depend on the value of
3313 the variable @code{org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline}. If its value
3314 is nil, then a fuzzy text search will be done. If it is t, then only the
3315 exact headline will be matched. If the value is @code{'query-to-create},
3316 then an exact headline will be searched; if it is not found, then the user
3317 will be queried to create it.}
3318 file:projects.org::*task title @r{heading search in Org file}
3319 file+sys:/path/to/file @r{open via OS, like double-click}
3320 file+emacs:/path/to/file @r{force opening by Emacs}
3321 docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN @r{open in doc-view mode at page}
3322 id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 @r{Link to heading by ID}
3323 news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
3324 mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
3325 vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
3326 vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
3327 vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
3328 vm-imap:account:folder @r{VM IMAP folder link}
3329 vm-imap:account:folder#id @r{VM IMAP message link}
3330 wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
3331 wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
3332 mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
3333 mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
3334 rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
3335 rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
3336 gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
3337 gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
3338 bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
3339 irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
3340 info:org#External links @r{Info node link}
3341 shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
3342 elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive Elisp command}
3343 elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
3346 For customizing Org to add new link types @ref{Adding hyperlink types}.
3348 A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
3349 descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link
3350 format}), for example:
3353 [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
3357 If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
3358 export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
3359 button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
3361 that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
3363 @cindex square brackets, around links
3364 @cindex plain text external links
3365 Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
3366 as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
3367 @samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
3368 about the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets.
3370 @node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
3371 @section Handling links
3372 @cindex links, handling
3374 Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
3375 insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
3378 @orgcmd{C-c l,org-store-link}
3379 @cindex storing links
3380 Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command (you
3381 must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to
3382 create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org
3383 buffer (see below). What kind of link will be created depends on the current
3386 @b{Org mode buffers}@*
3387 For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
3388 to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which will also
3389 be the description@footnote{If the headline contains a timestamp, it will be
3390 removed from the link and result in a wrong link -- you should avoid putting
3391 timestamp in the headline.}.
3393 @vindex org-link-to-org-use-id
3394 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3395 @cindex property, ID
3396 If the headline has a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property, a link to this custom ID
3397 will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the value of
3398 @code{org-link-to-org-use-id}), a globally unique @code{ID} property will be
3399 created and/or used to construct a link. So using this command in Org
3400 buffers will potentially create two links: a human-readable from the custom
3401 ID, and one that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from
3402 file to file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one
3405 @b{Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus}@*
3406 Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will point to the
3407 current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the group. The description is
3408 constructed from the author and the subject.
3410 @b{Web browsers: W3 and W3M}@*
3411 Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as description.
3413 @b{Contacts: BBDB}@*
3414 Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry.
3417 @vindex org-irc-link-to-logs
3418 For IRC links, if you set the variable @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to
3419 @code{t}, a @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for
3420 the current conversation is created. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to
3421 the user/channel/server under the point will be stored.
3424 For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
3425 (@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
3426 there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
3427 search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
3428 accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
3429 and to do the search for particular file types---see @ref{Custom searches}.
3430 The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion---see @ref{Installation}.
3433 When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to the
3434 entry referenced by the current line.
3437 @orgcmd{C-c C-l,org-insert-link}
3438 @cindex link completion
3439 @cindex completion, of links
3440 @cindex inserting links
3441 @vindex org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion
3442 Insert a link@footnote{ Note that you don't have to use this command to
3443 insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them
3444 straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically
3445 enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional
3446 descriptive text.}. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer.
3447 You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
3448 type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link will be inserted
3449 into the buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be
3450 removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use
3451 a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
3452 @code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
3453 If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
3454 becomes the default description.
3456 @b{Inserting stored links}@*
3457 All links stored during the
3458 current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
3459 them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}).
3461 @b{Completion support}@* Completion with @key{TAB} will help you to insert
3462 valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes
3463 defined through link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). If you
3464 press @key{RET} after inserting only the @var{prefix}, Org will offer
3465 specific completion support for some link types@footnote{This works by
3466 calling a special function @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link}.} For
3467 example, if you type @kbd{file @key{RET}}, file name completion (alternative
3468 access: @kbd{C-u C-c C-l}, see below) will be offered, and after @kbd{bbdb
3469 @key{RET}} you can complete contact names.
3471 @cindex file name completion
3472 @cindex completion, of file names
3473 When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
3474 a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
3475 the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
3476 directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current
3477 directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
3478 to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
3479 is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
3480 force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
3482 @item C-c C-l @ @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
3483 When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
3484 link and description parts of the link.
3486 @cindex following links
3487 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
3488 @vindex org-file-apps
3489 @vindex org-link-frame-setup
3490 Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
3491 @command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
3492 the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
3493 cursor is on an internal link, this command runs the corresponding search.
3494 When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
3495 TAGS view. If the cursor is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that
3496 date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
3497 with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
3498 Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
3499 @code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
3500 visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
3501 opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.@*
3502 If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the
3503 headline and entry text. If you want to setup the frame configuration for
3504 following links, customize @code{org-link-frame-setup}.
3507 @vindex org-return-follows-link
3508 When @code{org-return-follows-link} is set, @kbd{@key{RET}} will also follow
3515 On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
3516 would. Under Emacs 22 and later, @kbd{mouse-1} will also follow a link.
3520 @vindex org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer
3521 Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
3522 internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
3523 variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
3525 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-v,org-toggle-inline-images}
3526 @cindex inlining images
3527 @cindex images, inlining
3528 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
3529 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3530 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3531 Toggle the inline display of linked images. Normally this will only inline
3532 images that have no description part in the link, i.e.@: images that will also
3533 be inlined during export. When called with a prefix argument, also display
3534 images that do have a link description. You can ask for inline images to be
3535 displayed at startup by configuring the variable
3536 @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}@footnote{with corresponding
3537 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{inlineimages} and @code{inlineimages}}.
3538 @orgcmd{C-c %,org-mark-ring-push}
3540 Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
3541 easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
3543 @orgcmd{C-c &,org-mark-ring-goto}
3544 @cindex links, returning to
3545 Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
3546 commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
3547 command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
3548 previously recorded positions.
3550 @orgcmdkkcc{C-c C-x C-n,C-c C-x C-p,org-next-link,org-previous-link}
3551 @cindex links, finding next/previous
3552 Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
3553 the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
3554 bindings for this are really too long; you might want to bind this also
3555 to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
3557 (add-hook 'org-load-hook
3559 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
3560 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
3564 @node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
3565 @section Using links outside Org
3567 You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
3568 Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
3569 global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
3573 (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
3574 (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
3577 @node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
3578 @section Link abbreviations
3579 @cindex link abbreviations
3580 @cindex abbreviation, links
3582 Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
3583 needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
3584 abbreviated link looks like this
3587 [[linkword:tag][description]]
3591 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
3592 where the tag is optional.
3593 The @i{linkword} must be a word, starting with a letter, followed by
3594 letters, numbers, @samp{-}, and @samp{_}. Abbreviations are resolved
3595 according to the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}
3596 that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
3600 (setq org-link-abbrev-alist
3601 '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
3602 ("url-to-ja" . "http://translate.google.fr/translate?sl=en&tl=ja&u=%h")
3603 ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
3604 ("gmap" . "http://maps.google.com/maps?q=%s")
3605 ("omap" . "http://nominatim.openstreetmap.org/search?q=%s&polygon=1")
3606 ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
3610 If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
3611 replaced with the tag. Using @samp{%h} instead of @samp{%s} will
3612 url-encode the tag (see the example above, where we need to encode
3613 the URL parameter.) Using @samp{%(my-function)} will pass the tag
3614 to a custom function, and replace it by the resulting string.
3616 If the replacement text don't contain any specifier, it will simply
3617 be appended to the string in order to create the link.
3619 Instead of a string, you may also specify a function that will be
3620 called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
3622 With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
3623 @code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
3624 @code{[[google:OrgMode]]}, show the map location of the Free Software
3625 Foundation @code{[[gmap:51 Franklin Street, Boston]]} or of Carsten office
3626 @code{[[omap:Science Park 904, Amsterdam, The Netherlands]]} and find out
3627 what the Org author is doing besides Emacs hacking with
3628 @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
3630 If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
3631 can define them in the file with
3635 #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
3636 #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
3640 In-buffer completion (@pxref{Completion}) can be used after @samp{[} to
3641 complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function
3642 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g.@: completion)
3643 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
3644 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
3646 @node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
3647 @section Search options in file links
3648 @cindex search option in file links
3649 @cindex file links, searching
3651 File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
3652 particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
3653 line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
3654 compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
3655 example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
3656 links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
3657 string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
3658 link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
3660 Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
3661 link, together with an explanation:
3664 [[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
3665 [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
3666 [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
3667 [[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]]
3668 [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
3675 Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
3676 @samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
3677 @ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
3678 link will become a HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
3681 In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
3683 Link to a heading with a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property
3685 Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
3686 command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
3687 target file is in Org mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
3688 sparse tree with the matches.
3689 @c If the target file is a directory,
3690 @c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
3693 As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
3694 to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
3695 a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
3696 @samp{[[find me]]} would.
3698 @node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
3699 @section Custom Searches
3700 @cindex custom search strings
3701 @cindex search strings, custom
3703 The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
3704 actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
3705 cases. For example, Bib@TeX{} database files have many entries like
3706 @samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
3707 because the only unique identification for a Bib@TeX{} entry is the
3710 @vindex org-create-file-search-functions
3711 @vindex org-execute-file-search-functions
3712 If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
3713 the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
3714 for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
3715 to be added to the hook variables
3716 @code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
3717 @code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
3718 variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
3719 for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
3720 an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
3722 @node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
3726 Org mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
3727 course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items,
3728 but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
3729 notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
3730 mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
3731 information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
3732 item emerged is always present.
3734 Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
3735 throughout your notes file. Org mode compensates for this by providing
3736 methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
3739 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
3740 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
3741 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
3742 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
3743 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
3744 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
3747 @node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
3748 @section Basic TODO functionality
3750 Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
3751 @samp{TODO}, for example:
3754 *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
3758 The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
3761 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
3762 @cindex cycling, of TODO states
3763 Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
3766 ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
3767 '--------------------------------'
3770 The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and
3771 agenda buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3773 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-t}
3774 Select a specific keyword using completion or (if it has been set up)
3775 the fast selection interface. For the latter, you need to assign keys
3776 to TODO states, see @ref{Per-file keywords}, and @ref{Setting tags}, for
3779 @kindex S-@key{right}
3780 @kindex S-@key{left}
3781 @item S-@key{right} @ @r{/} @ S-@key{left}
3782 @vindex org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change
3783 Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
3784 mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
3785 extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction
3786 with @code{shift-selection-mode}. See also the variable
3787 @code{org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change}.
3788 @orgcmd{C-c / t,org-show-todo-key}
3789 @cindex sparse tree, for TODO
3790 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3791 View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds the
3792 entire buffer, but shows all TODO items (with not-DONE state) and the
3793 headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument (or by using @kbd{C-c
3794 / T}), search for a specific TODO. You will be prompted for the keyword, and
3795 you can also give a list of keywords like @code{KWD1|KWD2|...} to list
3796 entries that match any one of these keywords. With a numeric prefix argument
3797 N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the variable
3798 @code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix arguments, find all TODO states,
3799 both un-done and done.
3800 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
3801 Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE states)
3802 from all agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new
3803 buffer will be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
3804 manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3805 @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
3806 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
3807 Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
3811 @vindex org-todo-state-tags-triggers
3812 Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
3813 option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
3815 @node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
3816 @section Extended use of TODO keywords
3817 @cindex extended TODO keywords
3819 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3820 By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
3821 DONE. Org mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
3822 with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
3823 special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
3826 Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
3827 TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
3830 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
3831 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
3832 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
3833 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
3834 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
3835 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
3836 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
3839 @node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
3840 @subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
3841 @cindex TODO workflow
3842 @cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
3844 You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
3845 in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
3846 this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org mode in a
3850 (setq org-todo-keywords
3851 '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
3854 The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
3855 action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
3856 you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
3858 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
3859 With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
3860 to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED. You may
3861 also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
3862 example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY.
3863 Or you can use @kbd{S-@key{left}} to go backward through the sequence. If you
3864 define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
3865 (@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
3866 (@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
3867 buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
3868 @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}, for more information.
3870 @node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
3871 @subsection TODO keywords as types
3873 @cindex names as TODO keywords
3874 @cindex types as TODO keywords
3876 The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
3877 @emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
3878 that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
3879 people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
3880 directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
3881 be set up like this:
3884 (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
3887 In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
3888 different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
3889 person, and later to mark it DONE. Org mode supports this style by adapting
3890 the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
3891 @kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
3892 times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
3893 select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
3894 time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
3895 to DONE. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
3896 name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
3897 by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c / t}. For example, to see all things
3898 Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c / t}. To collect Lucy's items
3899 from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
3900 argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c a t}.
3902 @node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
3903 @subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
3904 @cindex TODO keyword sets
3906 Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
3907 parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
3908 @code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
3909 separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
3910 DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
3914 (setq org-todo-keywords
3915 '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
3916 (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
3917 (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
3920 The keywords should all be different, this helps Org mode to keep track
3921 of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
3922 @kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
3923 @code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
3924 (nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
3925 select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
3926 keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
3929 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
3930 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
3931 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t
3932 @item C-u C-u C-c C-t
3933 @itemx C-S-@key{right}
3934 @itemx C-S-@key{left}
3935 These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
3936 @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or
3937 @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to
3938 @code{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with
3939 @code{shift-selection-mode} (@pxref{Conflicts}).
3940 @kindex S-@key{right}
3941 @kindex S-@key{left}
3944 @kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through @emph{all}
3945 keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} would switch
3946 from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. See also
3947 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
3948 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3951 @node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
3952 @subsection Fast access to TODO states
3954 If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
3955 instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for single-letter
3956 access to the states. This is done by adding the selection character after
3957 each keyword, in parentheses@footnote{All characters are allowed except
3958 @code{@@^!}, which have a special meaning here.}. For example:
3961 (setq org-todo-keywords
3962 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
3963 (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
3964 (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
3967 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo
3968 If you then press @kbd{C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the entry
3969 will be switched to this state. @kbd{SPC} can be used to remove any TODO
3970 keyword from an entry.@footnote{Check also the variable
3971 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows you to change the TODO
3972 state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you like to
3973 mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with
3974 unique keys across both sets of keywords.}
3976 @node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
3977 @subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
3978 @cindex keyword options
3979 @cindex per-file keywords
3984 It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
3985 different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
3986 to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
3987 only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
3988 need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
3992 #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
3994 @noindent (you may also write @code{#+SEQ_TODO} to be explicit about the
3995 interpretation, but it means the same as @code{#+TODO}), or
3997 #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
4000 A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
4004 #+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
4008 @cindex completion, of option keywords
4010 @noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
4011 @samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
4013 @cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
4014 Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
4015 if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
4016 may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
4017 @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
4018 known to Org mode@footnote{Org mode parses these lines only when
4019 Org mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
4020 cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org mode
4021 for the current buffer.}.
4023 @node Faces for TODO keywords, TODO dependencies, Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
4024 @subsection Faces for TODO keywords
4025 @cindex faces, for TODO keywords
4027 @vindex org-todo @r{(face)}
4028 @vindex org-done @r{(face)}
4029 @vindex org-todo-keyword-faces
4030 Org mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
4031 for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
4032 @code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
4033 you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
4034 special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
4035 @code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
4039 (setq org-todo-keyword-faces
4040 '(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow")
4041 ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
4045 While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED @emph{should}
4046 work, this does not always seem to be the case. If necessary, define a
4047 special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a color. The variable
4048 @code{org-faces-easy-properties} determines if that color is interpreted as a
4049 foreground or a background color.
4051 @node TODO dependencies, , Faces for TODO keywords, TODO extensions
4052 @subsection TODO dependencies
4053 @cindex TODO dependencies
4054 @cindex dependencies, of TODO states
4056 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
4057 @cindex property, ORDERED
4058 The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO
4059 dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until
4060 all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE. And sometimes
4061 there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task
4062 cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize
4063 the variable @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org will block entries
4064 from changing state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE.
4065 Furthermore, if an entry has a property @code{ORDERED}, each of its children
4066 will be blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE. Here is an
4070 * TODO Blocked until (two) is done
4079 ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
4080 ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
4084 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4085 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4086 @cindex property, ORDERED
4087 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the current entry. A property is used
4088 for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not
4089 inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of
4090 this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the variable
4091 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4092 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t}
4093 Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking.
4096 @vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
4097 If you set the variable @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries
4098 that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed
4099 font or even made invisible in agenda views (@pxref{Agenda Views}).
4101 @cindex checkboxes and TODO dependencies
4102 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
4103 You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes
4104 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). If you set the variable
4105 @code{org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies}, an entry that has unchecked
4106 checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE.
4108 If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies
4109 between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed
4110 module @file{org-depend.el}.
4113 @node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
4114 @section Progress logging
4115 @cindex progress logging
4116 @cindex logging, of progress
4118 Org mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when
4119 you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
4120 a TODO item. This system is highly configurable, settings can be on a
4121 per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
4122 information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
4126 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
4127 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
4128 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
4131 @node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
4132 @subsection Closing items
4134 The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
4135 item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
4136 in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}
4139 (setq org-log-done 'time)
4143 Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
4144 of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted
4145 just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
4146 through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
4147 want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The
4148 corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}}
4151 (setq org-log-done 'note)
4155 You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
4156 the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
4158 In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
4159 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
4160 display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
4161 giving you an overview of what has been done.
4163 @node Tracking TODO state changes, Tracking your habits, Closing items, Progress logging
4164 @subsection Tracking TODO state changes
4165 @cindex drawer, for state change recording
4167 @vindex org-log-states-order-reversed
4168 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
4169 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
4170 When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow states}), you
4171 might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a
4172 note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a
4173 time-stamped note for a change. These records will be inserted after the
4174 headline as an itemized list, newest first@footnote{See the variable
4175 @code{org-log-states-order-reversed}}. When taking a lot of notes, you might
4176 want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (@pxref{Drawers}).
4177 Customize the variable @code{org-log-into-drawer} to get this behavior---the
4178 recommended drawer for this is called @code{LOGBOOK}@footnote{Note that the
4179 @code{LOGBOOK} drawer is unfolded when pressing @key{SPC} in the agenda to
4180 show an entry---use @key{C-u SPC} to keep it folded here}. You can also
4181 overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
4182 @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
4184 Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org mode
4185 expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by
4186 adding special markers @samp{!} (for a timestamp) or @samp{@@} (for a note
4187 with timestamp) in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the
4191 (setq org-todo-keywords
4192 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
4195 To record a timestamp without a note for TODO keywords configured with
4196 @samp{@@}, just type @kbd{C-c C-c} to enter a blank note when prompted.
4199 @vindex org-log-done
4200 you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
4201 request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to
4202 DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org mode will record two timestamps
4203 when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
4204 However, it will never prompt for two notes---if you have configured
4205 both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
4206 the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
4207 WAIT or CANCELED. The setting for WAIT is even more special: the
4208 @samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
4209 entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
4210 WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
4211 logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
4212 to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
4213 when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
4214 setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
4217 You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
4220 #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
4223 @cindex property, LOGGING
4224 In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
4225 single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
4226 LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
4227 on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
4228 @code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
4229 settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
4232 * TODO Log each state with only a time
4234 :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
4236 * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
4238 :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
4240 * TODO No logging at all
4246 @node Tracking your habits, , Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging
4247 @subsection Tracking your habits
4250 Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODOs,
4251 called ``habits''. A habit has the following properties:
4255 You have enabled the @code{habits} module by customizing the variable
4258 The habit is a TODO item, with a TODO keyword representing an open state.
4260 The property @code{STYLE} is set to the value @code{habit}.
4262 The TODO has a scheduled date, usually with a @code{.+} style repeat
4263 interval. A @code{++} style may be appropriate for habits with time
4264 constraints, e.g., must be done on weekends, or a @code{+} style for an
4265 unusual habit that can have a backlog, e.g., weekly reports.
4267 The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the
4268 syntax @samp{.+2d/3d}, which says that you want to do the task at least every
4269 three days, but at most every two days.
4271 You must also have state logging for the @code{DONE} state enabled
4272 (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}), in order for historical data to be
4273 represented in the consistency graph. If it is not enabled it is not an
4274 error, but the consistency graphs will be largely meaningless.
4277 To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an
4278 actual habit with some history:
4282 SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
4283 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
4284 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
4285 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
4286 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
4287 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
4288 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
4289 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
4290 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
4291 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
4292 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
4295 :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
4299 What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given by the
4300 @code{SCHEDULED} date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. If
4301 today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct 17,
4302 after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19,
4303 after four days have elapsed.
4305 What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a
4306 consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task
4307 done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the
4308 past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are:
4312 If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day.
4314 If the task could have been done on that day.
4316 If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
4318 If the task was overdue on that day.
4321 In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterisk if
4322 the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where
4323 the current day falls in the graph.
4325 There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way
4326 habits are displayed in the agenda.
4329 @item org-habit-graph-column
4330 The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This will
4331 overwrite any text in that column, so it is a good idea to keep your habits'
4332 titles brief and to the point.
4333 @item org-habit-preceding-days
4334 The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs.
4335 @item org-habit-following-days
4336 The number of days after today that will appear in consistency graphs.
4337 @item org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today
4338 If non-nil, only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set to true by
4342 Lastly, pressing @kbd{K} in the agenda buffer will cause habits to
4343 temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press @kbd{K} again to
4344 bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits
4345 which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.
4347 @node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
4351 If you use Org mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items that
4352 it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
4353 placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like this
4356 *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
4360 @vindex org-priority-faces
4361 By default, Org mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
4362 @samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is
4363 treated just like priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only for
4364 sorting in the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they
4365 have no inherent meaning to Org mode. The cookies can be highlighted with
4366 special faces by customizing the variable @code{org-priority-faces}.
4368 Priorities can be attached to any outline node; they do not need to be TODO
4374 @findex org-priority
4375 Set the priority of the current headline (@command{org-priority}). The
4376 command prompts for a priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}.
4377 When you press @key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the
4378 headline. The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline
4379 and agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
4381 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-priority-up,org-priority-down}
4382 @vindex org-priority-start-cycle-with-default
4383 Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the option
4384 @code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default}.}. Note that these keys are
4385 also used to modify timestamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). See also
4386 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
4387 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
4390 @vindex org-highest-priority
4391 @vindex org-lowest-priority
4392 @vindex org-default-priority
4393 You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables
4394 @code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
4395 @code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
4396 these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
4397 the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
4400 @cindex #+PRIORITIES
4405 @node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
4406 @section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
4407 @cindex tasks, breaking down
4408 @cindex statistics, for TODO items
4410 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
4411 It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
4412 subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
4413 with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
4414 global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
4415 the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
4416 either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
4417 be updated each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing
4418 @kbd{C-c C-c} on the cookie. For example:
4421 * Organize Party [33%]
4422 ** TODO Call people [1/2]
4426 ** DONE Talk to neighbor
4429 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4430 If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of
4431 the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
4432 @code{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve
4435 @vindex org-hierarchical-todo-statistics
4436 If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the
4437 subtree (not just direct children), configure the variable
4438 @code{org-hierarchical-todo-statistics}. To do this for a single subtree,
4439 include the word @samp{recursive} into the value of the @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4443 * Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
4445 :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
4449 If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE
4450 when all children are done, you can use the following setup:
4453 (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
4454 "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
4455 (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
4456 (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
4458 (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
4462 Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
4463 large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
4466 @node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
4470 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
4471 Every item in a plain list@footnote{With the exception of description
4472 lists. But you can allow it by modifying @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
4473 accordingly.} (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a checkbox by starting
4474 it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is similar to TODO items
4475 (@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight. Checkboxes are not included
4476 into the global TODO list, so they are often great to split a task into a
4477 number of simple steps. Or you can use them in a shopping list. To toggle a
4478 checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's
4479 @file{org-mouse.el}).
4481 Here is an example of a checkbox list.
4484 * TODO Organize party [2/4]
4485 - [-] call people [1/3]
4490 - [ ] think about what music to play
4491 - [X] talk to the neighbors
4494 Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
4495 are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
4496 parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
4499 @cindex statistics, for checkboxes
4500 @cindex checkbox statistics
4501 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4502 @vindex org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics
4503 The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are cookies
4504 indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off,
4505 and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how
4506 many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can
4507 be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item.
4508 Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the
4509 headline/item on which the cookie appears@footnote{Set the variable
4510 @code{org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics} if you want such cookies to
4511 count all checkboxes below the cookie, not just those belonging to direct
4512 children.}. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either
4513 @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m}
4514 result, as in the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about
4515 the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
4516 @samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can
4517 count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it
4518 will display whatever was changed last. Set the property @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4519 to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue.
4521 @cindex blocking, of checkboxes
4522 @cindex checkbox blocking
4523 @cindex property, ORDERED
4524 If the current outline node has an @code{ORDERED} property, checkboxes must
4525 be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try to check
4526 off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
4528 @noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
4531 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-toggle-checkbox}
4532 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point.
4533 With a single prefix argument, add an empty checkbox or remove the current
4534 one@footnote{`C-u C-c C-c' on the @emph{first} item of a list with no checkbox
4535 will add checkboxes to the rest of the list.}. With a double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is
4536 considered to be an intermediate state.
4537 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-b,org-toggle-checkbox}
4538 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4539 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4543 If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
4544 and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix
4545 arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region.
4547 If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
4548 this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
4550 If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
4552 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
4553 Insert a new item with a checkbox. This works only if the cursor is already
4554 in a plain list item (@pxref{Plain lists}).
4555 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4556 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4557 @cindex property, ORDERED
4558 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must
4559 be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because
4560 this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag.
4561 However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of this property with a tag
4562 for better visibility, customize the variable
4563 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4564 @orgcmd{C-c #,org-update-statistics-cookies}
4565 Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with
4566 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are
4567 updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make
4568 new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. TODO statistics cookies update when
4569 changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by
4570 hand, use this command to get things back into sync.
4573 @node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
4576 @cindex headline tagging
4577 @cindex matching, tags
4578 @cindex sparse tree, tag based
4580 An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
4581 information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org mode has extensive
4584 @vindex org-tag-faces
4585 Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
4586 headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
4587 @samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
4588 @samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
4589 Tags will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline.
4590 You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
4591 @code{org-tag-faces}, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
4592 (@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
4595 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
4596 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
4597 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
4600 @node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
4601 @section Tag inheritance
4602 @cindex tag inheritance
4603 @cindex inheritance, of tags
4604 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
4606 @i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
4607 heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
4608 well. For example, in the list
4611 * Meeting with the French group :work:
4612 ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
4613 *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
4617 the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
4618 @samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
4619 explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
4620 a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical
4621 level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this@footnote{As
4622 with all these in-buffer settings, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any
4623 changes in the line.}:
4627 #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
4631 @vindex org-use-tag-inheritance
4632 @vindex org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance
4633 To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, or to turn it off entirely, use
4634 the variables @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} and
4635 @code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
4637 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4638 When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
4639 on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
4640 as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more
4641 complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
4642 of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
4643 match in a subtree, configure the variable
4644 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended).
4646 @node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags
4647 @section Setting tags
4648 @cindex setting tags
4649 @cindex tags, setting
4652 Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
4653 After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
4654 also a special command for inserting tags:
4657 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-set-tags-command}
4658 @cindex completion, of tags
4659 @vindex org-tags-column
4660 Enter new tags for the current headline. Org mode will either offer
4661 completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
4662 below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
4663 to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
4664 tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
4665 things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
4666 demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
4667 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-set-tags-command}
4668 When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
4671 @vindex org-tag-alist
4672 Org supports tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
4673 default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
4674 currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
4675 of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
4676 the default tags for a given file with lines like
4680 #+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
4681 #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
4684 If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
4685 variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
4686 in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
4692 @vindex org-tag-persistent-alist
4693 If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file,
4694 in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS option lines, then
4695 you may specify a list of tags with the variable
4696 @code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
4697 by adding a STARTUP option line to that file:
4703 By default Org mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
4704 entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
4705 method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
4706 deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
4707 assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
4708 globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
4709 @file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
4710 different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
4714 (setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
4717 @noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
4718 can instead set the TAGS option line as:
4721 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
4724 @noindent The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash
4725 window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert
4726 @samp{\n} into the tag list
4729 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
4732 @noindent or write them in two lines:
4735 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t)
4736 #+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
4740 You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
4744 #+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
4747 @noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
4748 and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
4750 @noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
4751 these lines to activate any changes.
4754 To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-tags-alist},
4755 you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
4756 of the braces. Similarly, you can use @code{:newline} to indicate a line
4757 break. The previous example would be set globally by the following
4761 (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
4762 ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
4763 ("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
4765 ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
4768 If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
4769 automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
4770 the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
4771 corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
4772 have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
4777 Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
4778 tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
4779 exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
4782 Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
4783 list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
4784 You can also add several tags: just separate them with a comma.
4788 Clear all tags for this line.
4791 Accept the modified set.
4793 Abort without installing changes.
4795 If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
4797 Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
4798 exception) assign several tags from such a group.
4800 Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
4801 If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
4806 This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
4807 the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
4808 @samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
4809 C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
4810 @samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
4811 alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
4812 @samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
4813 @key{RET} @key{RET}}.
4815 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-single-key
4816 If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
4817 modify your list of tags, set the variable
4818 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to
4819 press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection---it will immediately exit
4820 after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press
4821 @kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process
4822 (in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c
4823 C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special
4824 window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only
4825 when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
4827 @node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags
4828 @section Tag searches
4829 @cindex tag searches
4830 @cindex searching for tags
4832 Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
4833 information into special lists.
4836 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \\,org-match-sparse-tree}
4837 Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a
4838 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4839 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
4840 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files.
4841 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4842 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
4843 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4844 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4845 only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
4846 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4849 These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic
4850 like @samp{+boss+urgent-project1}, to find entries with tags @samp{boss} and
4851 @samp{urgent}, but not @samp{project1}, or @samp{Kathy|Sally} to find entries
4852 which are tagged, like @samp{Kathy} or @samp{Sally}. The full syntax of the search
4853 string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels
4854 and properties. For a complete description with many examples, see
4855 @ref{Matching tags and properties}.
4858 @node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
4859 @chapter Properties and columns
4862 A property is a key-value pair associated with an entry. Properties can be
4863 set so they are associated with a single entry, with every entry in a tree,
4864 or with every entry in an Org mode file.
4866 There are two main applications for properties in Org mode. First,
4867 properties are like tags, but with a value. Imagine maintaining a file where
4868 you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of
4869 using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, you can use a
4870 property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
4871 values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. Second, you can use properties to
4872 implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. Imagine
4873 keeping track of your music CDs, where properties could be things such as the
4874 album, artist, date of release, number of tracks, and so on.
4876 Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
4877 (@pxref{Column view}).
4880 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
4881 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
4882 * Property searches:: Matching property values
4883 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
4884 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
4885 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
4888 @node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
4889 @section Property syntax
4890 @cindex property syntax
4891 @cindex drawer, for properties
4893 Properties are key-value pairs. When they are associated with a single entry
4894 or with a tree they need to be inserted into a special
4895 drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
4896 is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
4897 first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
4902 *** Goldberg Variations
4904 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4905 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4907 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4912 Depending on the value of @code{org-use-property-inheritance}, a property set
4913 this way will either be associated with a single entry, or the sub-tree
4914 defined by the entry, see @ref{Property inheritance}.
4916 You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
4917 by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
4918 @emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
4919 the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
4920 corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
4921 errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
4922 publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
4927 :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
4928 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
4932 If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
4933 file, use a line like
4934 @cindex property, _ALL
4937 #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
4940 If you want to add to the value of an existing property, append a @code{+} to
4941 the property name. The following results in the property @code{var} having
4942 the value ``foo=1 bar=2''.
4945 #+PROPERTY: var foo=1
4946 #+PROPERTY: var+ bar=2
4949 It is also possible to add to the values of inherited properties. The
4950 following results in the @code{genres} property having the value ``Classic
4951 Baroque'' under the @code{Goldberg Variations} subtree.
4959 *** Goldberg Variations
4961 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4962 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4964 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4969 Note that a property can only have one entry per Drawer.
4971 @vindex org-global-properties
4972 Property values set with the global variable
4973 @code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
4977 The following commands help to work with properties:
4980 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},pcomplete}
4981 After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
4982 in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
4983 @orgcmd{C-c C-x p,org-set-property}
4984 Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
4985 necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
4986 @item C-u M-x org-insert-drawer
4987 @cindex org-insert-drawer
4988 Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
4989 inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
4990 information like deadlines.
4991 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-property-action}
4992 With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
4993 @orgcmd{C-c C-c s,org-set-property}
4994 Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
4995 can be inserted using completion.
4996 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{right},S-@key{left},org-property-next-allowed-value,org-property-previous-allowed-value}
4997 Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
4998 @orgcmd{C-c C-c d,org-delete-property}
4999 Remove a property from the current entry.
5000 @orgcmd{C-c C-c D,org-delete-property-globally}
5001 Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
5002 @orgcmd{C-c C-c c,org-compute-property-at-point}
5003 Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
5004 nearest column format definition.
5007 @node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
5008 @section Special properties
5009 @cindex properties, special
5011 Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org mode features,
5012 like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the previous
5013 chapters. This interface exists so that you can include these states in a
5014 column view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in queries. The following
5015 property names are special and (except for @code{:CATEGORY:}) should not be
5016 used as keys in the properties drawer:
5018 @cindex property, special, ID
5019 @cindex property, special, TODO
5020 @cindex property, special, TAGS
5021 @cindex property, special, ALLTAGS
5022 @cindex property, special, CATEGORY
5023 @cindex property, special, PRIORITY
5024 @cindex property, special, DEADLINE
5025 @cindex property, special, SCHEDULED
5026 @cindex property, special, CLOSED
5027 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP
5028 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA
5029 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
5030 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM_T
5031 @cindex property, special, BLOCKED
5032 @c guessing that ITEM is needed in this area; also, should this list be sorted?
5033 @cindex property, special, ITEM
5034 @cindex property, special, FILE
5036 ID @r{A globally unique ID used for synchronization during}
5037 @r{iCalendar or MobileOrg export.}
5038 TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
5039 TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
5040 ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
5041 CATEGORY @r{The category of an entry.}
5042 PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
5043 DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
5044 SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets.}
5045 CLOSED @r{When was this entry closed?}
5046 TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry.}
5047 TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive timestamp in the entry.}
5048 CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
5049 @r{must be run first to compute the values in the current buffer.}
5050 CLOCKSUM_T @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree for today.}
5051 @r{@code{org-clock-sum-today} must be run first to compute the}
5052 @r{values in the current buffer.}
5053 BLOCKED @r{"t" if task is currently blocked by children or siblings}
5054 ITEM @r{The headline of the entry.}
5055 FILE @r{The filename the entry is located in.}
5058 @node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
5059 @section Property searches
5060 @cindex properties, searching
5061 @cindex searching, of properties
5063 To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
5064 the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}).
5066 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \,org-match-sparse-tree}
5067 Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a
5068 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
5069 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
5070 Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files.
5071 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
5072 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
5073 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
5074 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
5075 only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see variable
5076 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
5079 The syntax for the search string is described in @ref{Matching tags and
5082 There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
5087 Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
5088 prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
5089 is created with all entries that define this property with the given
5090 value. If you enclose the value in curly braces, it is interpreted as
5091 a regular expression and matched against the property values.
5094 @node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
5095 @section Property Inheritance
5096 @cindex properties, inheritance
5097 @cindex inheritance, of properties
5099 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
5100 The outline structure of Org mode documents lends itself to an
5101 inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain
5102 property, the children can inherit this property. Org mode does not
5103 turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
5104 significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
5105 useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
5106 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t} to make
5107 all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
5108 that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
5109 inherited properties. If a property has the value @samp{nil}, this is
5110 interpreted as an explicit undefine of the property, so that inheritance
5111 search will stop at this value and return @code{nil}.
5113 Org mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
5114 least for the special applications for which they are used:
5116 @cindex property, COLUMNS
5119 The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
5120 (@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
5121 where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
5122 point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
5123 subtree from where columns view is turned on.
5125 @cindex property, CATEGORY
5126 For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
5127 applies to the entire subtree.
5129 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
5130 For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
5131 location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
5133 @cindex property, LOGGING
5134 The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
5135 subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
5138 @node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
5139 @section Column view
5141 A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
5142 @emph{column view}. In column view, each outline node is turned into a
5143 table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
5144 entries. Org mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
5145 over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
5146 into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
5147 tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
5148 view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
5149 is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
5150 headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
5151 tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
5152 Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
5153 queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
5156 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
5157 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
5158 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
5161 @node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
5162 @subsection Defining columns
5163 @cindex column view, for properties
5164 @cindex properties, column view
5166 Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
5167 done by defining a column format line.
5170 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
5171 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
5174 @node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
5175 @subsubsection Scope of column definitions
5177 To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
5181 #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5184 To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
5185 @code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
5188 ** Top node for columns view
5190 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5194 If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
5195 for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
5196 column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
5197 you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
5198 sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
5199 deeper part of the tree.
5201 @node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
5202 @subsubsection Column attributes
5203 A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
5204 definition looks like this:
5207 %[@var{width}]@var{property}[(@var{title})][@{@var{summary-type}@}]
5211 Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
5212 optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
5215 @var{width} @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
5216 @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
5217 @var{property} @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
5218 @r{Special properties representing meta data are allowed here}
5219 @r{as well (@pxref{Special properties})}
5220 @var{title} @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the property}
5222 @{@var{summary-type}@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
5223 @r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
5224 @r{Supported summary types are:}
5225 @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
5226 @{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
5227 @{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
5228 @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are hours.}
5229 @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[X]} if all children are @samp{[X]}.}
5230 @{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n/m]}.}
5231 @{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n%]}.}
5232 @{min@} @r{Smallest number in column.}
5233 @{max@} @r{Largest number.}
5234 @{mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of numbers.}
5235 @{:min@} @r{Smallest time value in column.}
5236 @{:max@} @r{Largest time value.}
5237 @{:mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of time values.}
5238 @{@@min@} @r{Minimum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5239 @{@@max@} @r{Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5240 @{@@mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5241 @{est+@} @r{Add low-high estimates.}
5245 Be aware that you can only have one summary type for any property you
5246 include. Subsequent columns referencing the same property will all display the
5247 same summary information.
5249 The @code{est+} summary type requires further explanation. It is used for
5250 combining estimates, expressed as low-high ranges. For example, instead
5251 of estimating a particular task will take 5 days, you might estimate it as
5252 5-6 days if you're fairly confident you know how much work is required, or
5253 1-10 days if you don't really know what needs to be done. Both ranges
5254 average at 5.5 days, but the first represents a more predictable delivery.
5256 When combining a set of such estimates, simply adding the lows and highs
5257 produces an unrealistically wide result. Instead, @code{est+} adds the
5258 statistical mean and variance of the sub-tasks, generating a final estimate
5259 from the sum. For example, suppose you had ten tasks, each of which was
5260 estimated at 0.5 to 2 days of work. Straight addition produces an estimate
5261 of 5 to 20 days, representing what to expect if everything goes either
5262 extremely well or extremely poorly. In contrast, @code{est+} estimates the
5263 full job more realistically, at 10-15 days.
5265 Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
5269 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line---it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
5270 %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM %CLOCKSUM_T
5271 :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
5272 :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
5273 :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
5277 The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
5278 item itself, i.e.@: of the headline. You probably always should start the
5279 column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
5280 create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
5281 @samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
5282 field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
5283 character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
5284 to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
5285 modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
5286 be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
5287 expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
5288 an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
5289 @samp{CLOCKSUM} and @samp{CLOCKSUM_T} columns are special, they lists the
5290 sums of CLOCK intervals in the subtree, either for all clocks or just for
5293 @node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
5294 @subsection Using column view
5297 @tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
5298 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-columns}
5299 @vindex org-columns-default-format
5300 Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline in the file,
5301 column view is turned on for the entire file, using the @code{#+COLUMNS}
5302 definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the outline, this command
5303 searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that
5304 defines a format. When one is found, the column view table is established
5305 for the tree starting at the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
5306 property. If no such property is found, the format is taken from the
5307 @code{#+COLUMNS} line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format},
5308 and column view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
5309 @orgcmd{r,org-columns-redo}
5310 Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
5311 @orgcmd{g,org-columns-redo}
5313 @orgcmd{q,org-columns-quit}
5315 @tsubheading{Editing values}
5316 @item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
5317 Move through the column view from field to field.
5318 @kindex S-@key{left}
5319 @kindex S-@key{right}
5320 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
5321 Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
5322 have to have specified allowed values for a property.
5324 Directly select the Nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
5325 @orgcmdkkcc{n,p,org-columns-next-allowed-value,org-columns-previous-allowed-value}
5326 Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
5327 @orgcmd{e,org-columns-edit-value}
5328 Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
5329 invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
5330 property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
5331 or fast selection interface will pop up.
5332 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle}
5333 When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
5334 @orgcmd{v,org-columns-show-value}
5335 View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
5336 the column is smaller than that of the value.
5337 @orgcmd{a,org-columns-edit-allowed}
5338 Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
5339 in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
5340 found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
5341 current column view.
5342 @tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
5343 @orgcmdkkcc{<,>,org-columns-narrow,org-columns-widen}
5344 Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
5345 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{right},org-columns-new}
5346 Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
5347 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{left},org-columns-delete}
5348 Delete the current column.
5351 @node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
5352 @subsection Capturing column view
5354 Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
5355 exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
5356 a @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
5357 of this block looks like this:
5359 @cindex #+BEGIN, columnview
5362 #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
5367 @noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
5371 This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
5372 often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
5373 at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
5374 capture, you can use 4 values:
5375 @cindex property, ID
5377 local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
5378 global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
5379 "file:@var{path-to-file}"
5380 @r{run column view at the top of this file}
5381 "@var{ID}" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
5382 @r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
5383 @r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for}
5384 @r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
5387 When @code{t}, insert an hline after every line. When a number @var{N}, insert
5388 an hline before each headline with level @code{<= @var{N}}.
5390 When set to @code{t}, force column groups to get vertical lines.
5392 When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
5393 @item :skip-empty-rows
5394 When set to @code{t}, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the
5395 column view is @code{ITEM}.
5400 The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
5403 @orgcmd{C-c C-x i,org-insert-columns-dblock}
5404 Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
5405 for the scope or ID of the view.
5406 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
5407 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5408 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5409 @orgcmd{C-u C-c C-x C-u,org-update-all-dblocks}
5410 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5411 you have several clock table blocks, column-capturing blocks or other dynamic
5415 You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
5416 instructions in front of the table---these will survive an update of the
5417 block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
5418 actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
5420 An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is
5421 provided by Eric Schulte's @file{org-collector.el} which is a contributed
5422 package@footnote{Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are
5423 distributed with the main distribution of Org (visit
5424 @uref{http://orgmode.org}).}. It provides a general API to collect
5425 properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to
5426 process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block.
5428 @node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
5429 @section The Property API
5430 @cindex properties, API
5431 @cindex API, for properties
5433 There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
5434 be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
5435 features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
5438 @node Dates and Times, Capture - Refile - Archive, Properties and Columns, Top
5439 @chapter Dates and times
5445 To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
5446 a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
5447 information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org mode. This may be a
5448 little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
5449 something was created or last changed. However, in Org mode this term
5450 is used in a much wider sense.
5453 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
5454 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
5455 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
5456 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
5457 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
5458 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
5459 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
5463 @node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
5464 @section Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling
5466 @cindex ranges, time
5471 A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of
5472 times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>}@footnote{In this
5473 simplest form, the day name is optional when you type the date yourself.
5474 However, any dates inserted or modified by Org will add that day name, for
5475 reading convenience.} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16
5476 Tue 12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is inspired by the standard ISO 8601
5477 date/time format. To use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time
5478 format}.}. A timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org
5479 tree entry. Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the
5480 agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
5483 @item Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment
5486 A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
5487 like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
5488 timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
5489 plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that date.
5492 * Meet Peter at the movies
5493 <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
5494 * Discussion on climate change
5495 <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
5498 @item Timestamp with repeater interval
5499 @cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
5500 A timestamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
5501 applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
5502 interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The
5503 following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
5506 * Pick up Sam at school
5507 <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
5510 @item Diary-style sexp entries
5511 For more complex date specifications, Org mode supports using the special
5512 sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
5513 package@footnote{When working with the standard diary sexp functions, you
5514 need to be very careful with the order of the arguments. That order depend
5515 evilly on the variable @code{calendar-date-style} (or, for older Emacs
5516 versions, @code{european-calendar-style}). For example, to specify a date
5517 December 12, 2005, the call might look like @code{(diary-date 12 1 2005)} or
5518 @code{(diary-date 1 12 2005)} or @code{(diary-date 2005 12 1)}, depending on
5519 the settings. This has been the source of much confusion. Org mode users
5520 can resort to special versions of these functions like @code{org-date} or
5521 @code{org-anniversary}. These work just like the corresponding @code{diary-}
5522 functions, but with stable ISO order of arguments (year, month, day) wherever
5523 applicable, independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.}. For
5524 example with optional time
5527 * 22:00-23:00 The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
5528 <%%(org-float t 4 2)>
5531 @item Time/Date range
5534 Two timestamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
5535 will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
5536 that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
5539 ** Meeting in Amsterdam
5540 <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
5543 @item Inactive timestamp
5544 @cindex timestamp, inactive
5545 @cindex inactive timestamp
5546 Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
5547 angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do
5548 @emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
5551 * Gillian comes late for the fifth time
5557 @node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
5558 @section Creating timestamps
5559 @cindex creating timestamps
5560 @cindex timestamps, creating
5562 For Org mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
5563 format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
5567 @orgcmd{C-c .,org-time-stamp}
5568 Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the cursor is
5569 at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
5570 timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
5571 succession, a time range is inserted.
5573 @orgcmd{C-c !,org-time-stamp-inactive}
5574 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause
5581 @vindex org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes
5582 Like @kbd{C-c .} and @kbd{C-c !}, but use the alternative format which
5583 contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5
5584 minutes, see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
5587 Normalize timestamp, insert/fix day name if missing or wrong.
5589 @orgcmd{C-c <,org-date-from-calendar}
5590 Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
5592 @orgcmd{C-c >,org-goto-calendar}
5593 Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
5594 timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
5597 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
5598 Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at
5599 point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
5601 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-timestamp-down-day,org-timestamp-up-day}
5602 Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
5603 shift-selection and related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5605 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-timestamp-up,org-timestamp-down-down}
5606 Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
5607 year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range
5608 like @samp{15:30-16:30}, modifying the first time will also shift the second,
5609 shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify
5610 the second time. Note that if the cursor is in a headline and not at a
5611 timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item.
5612 (@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and
5613 related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5615 @orgcmd{C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
5616 @cindex evaluate time range
5617 Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
5618 With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
5619 the following column).
5624 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
5625 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
5628 @node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
5629 @subsection The date/time prompt
5630 @cindex date, reading in minibuffer
5631 @cindex time, reading in minibuffer
5633 @vindex org-read-date-prefer-future
5634 When Org mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
5635 date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
5636 format. But it will in fact accept any string containing some date and/or
5637 time information, and it is really smart about interpreting your input. You
5638 can, for example, use @kbd{C-y} to paste a (possibly multi-line) string
5639 copied from an email message. Org mode will find whatever information is in
5640 there and derive anything you have not specified from the @emph{default date
5641 and time}. The default is usually the current date and time, but when
5642 modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a
5643 range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in
5644 information, Org mode assumes that most of the time you will want to enter a
5645 date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is
5646 @i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a future date@footnote{See the
5647 variable @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}. You may set that variable to
5648 the symbol @code{time} to even make a time before now shift the date to
5649 tomorrow.}. If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the
5650 time prompt will show this with @samp{(=>F).}
5652 For example, let's assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
5653 various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org mode are
5657 3-2-5 @result{} 2003-02-05
5658 2/5/3 @result{} 2003-02-05
5659 14 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
5660 12 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
5661 2/5 @result{} @b{2007}-02-05
5662 Fri @result{} nearest Friday (default date or later)
5663 sep 15 @result{} @b{2006}-09-15
5664 feb 15 @result{} @b{2007}-02-15
5665 sep 12 9 @result{} 2009-09-12
5666 12:45 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
5667 22 sept 0:34 @result{} @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
5668 w4 @result{} ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
5669 2012 w4 fri @result{} Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
5670 2012-w04-5 @result{} Same as above
5673 Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
5674 @emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a
5675 letter ([dwmy]) to indicate change in days, weeks, months, or years. With a
5676 single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
5677 double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
5678 a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
5679 the Nth such day, e.g.@:
5684 +4d @result{} four days from today
5685 +4 @result{} same as above
5686 +2w @result{} two weeks from today
5687 ++5 @result{} five days from default date
5688 +2tue @result{} second Tuesday from now.
5691 @vindex parse-time-months
5692 @vindex parse-time-weekdays
5693 The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
5694 you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
5695 the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
5697 @vindex org-read-date-force-compatible-dates
5698 Not all dates can be represented in a given Emacs implementation. By default
5699 Org mode forces dates into the compatibility range 1970--2037 which works on
5700 all Emacs implementations. If you want to use dates outside of this range,
5701 read the docstring of the variable
5702 @code{org-read-date-force-compatible-dates}.
5704 You can specify a time range by giving start and end times or by giving a
5705 start time and a duration (in HH:MM format). Use one or two dash(es) as the
5706 separator in the former case and use '+' as the separator in the latter
5710 11am-1:15pm @result{} 11:00-13:15
5711 11am--1:15pm @result{} same as above
5712 11am+2:15 @result{} same as above
5715 @cindex calendar, for selecting date
5716 @vindex org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt
5717 Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
5718 you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
5719 @code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
5720 prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
5721 @key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
5722 information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
5723 from the minibuffer:
5730 @kindex S-@key{right}
5731 @kindex S-@key{left}
5732 @kindex S-@key{down}
5734 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
5735 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
5738 @key{RET} @r{Choose date at cursor in calendar.}
5739 mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
5740 S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
5741 S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
5742 M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
5743 > / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
5744 M-v / C-v @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by 3 months.}
5747 @vindex org-read-date-display-live
5748 The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
5749 will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
5750 way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
5751 on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
5752 minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
5753 @code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
5755 @node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
5756 @subsection Custom time format
5757 @cindex custom date/time format
5758 @cindex time format, custom
5759 @cindex date format, custom
5761 @vindex org-display-custom-times
5762 @vindex org-time-stamp-custom-formats
5763 Org mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
5764 defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
5765 representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
5766 customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and
5767 @code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
5770 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-t,org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays}
5771 Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
5775 Org mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
5776 format does not @emph{replace} the default format---instead it is put
5777 @emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
5778 following consequences:
5781 You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before or
5784 The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
5785 each component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
5786 the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
5787 just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
5788 time will be changed by one minute.
5790 If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
5791 will not be overlaid, but remain in the buffer as they were.
5793 When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only
5794 disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
5795 belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
5797 If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are
5798 using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
5799 format is shorter, things do work as expected.
5803 @node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
5804 @section Deadlines and scheduling
5806 A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
5810 @cindex DEADLINE keyword
5812 Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
5813 to be finished on that date.
5815 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5816 On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
5817 addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
5818 approaching or missed deadline, starting
5819 @code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
5820 until the entry is marked DONE. An example:
5823 *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
5824 DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
5825 The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
5828 You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
5829 deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
5830 period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}.
5833 @cindex SCHEDULED keyword
5835 Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
5838 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done
5839 The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
5840 be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE. If you don't like
5841 this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
5842 addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
5843 in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE, i.e.@:
5844 the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
5847 *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
5848 SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
5852 @b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org mode should @i{not} be
5853 understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
5854 Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
5855 mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown
5856 on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by
5857 Org users. In Org mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
5858 want to start working on an action item.
5861 You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
5862 entries. Org mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
5863 assumption that the timestamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
5864 the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
5866 @code{<%%(org-float t 42)>}
5868 in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org mode does not
5869 know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
5870 late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
5874 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
5875 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
5878 @node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
5879 @subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
5881 The following commands allow you to quickly insert@footnote{The @samp{SCHEDULED} and
5882 @samp{DEADLINE} dates are inserted on the line right below the headline. Don't put
5883 any text between this line and the headline.} a deadline or to schedule
5888 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-deadline}
5889 Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will happen
5890 in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp will be
5891 removed. When called with a prefix arg, an existing deadline will be removed
5892 from the entry. Depending on the variable @code{org-log-redeadline}@footnote{with corresponding
5893 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline},
5894 and @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5897 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-schedule}
5898 Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
5899 happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp
5900 will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove the scheduling
5901 date from the entry. Depending on the variable
5902 @code{org-log-reschedule}@footnote{with corresponding @code{#+STARTUP}
5903 keywords @code{logreschedule}, @code{lognotereschedule}, and
5904 @code{nologreschedule}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5907 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-k,org-mark-entry-for-agenda-action}
5910 Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
5911 like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
5912 date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
5913 schedule the marked item.
5915 @orgcmd{C-c / d,org-check-deadlines}
5916 @cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
5917 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5918 Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
5919 which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
5920 With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
5921 prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
5922 all deadlines due tomorrow.
5924 @orgcmd{C-c / b,org-check-before-date}
5925 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date.
5927 @orgcmd{C-c / a,org-check-after-date}
5928 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
5931 Note that @code{org-schedule} and @code{org-deadline} supports
5932 setting the date by indicating a relative time: e.g. +1d will set
5933 the date to the next day after today, and --1w will set the date
5934 to the previous week before any current timestamp.
5936 @node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
5937 @subsection Repeated tasks
5938 @cindex tasks, repeated
5939 @cindex repeated tasks
5941 Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org mode helps to
5942 organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
5943 or plain timestamp. In the following example
5945 ** TODO Pay the rent
5946 DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
5949 the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
5950 has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month starting
5951 from that time. You can use yearly, monthly, weekly, daily and hourly repeat
5952 cookies by using the @code{y/w/m/d/h} letters. If you need both a repeater
5953 and a special warning period in a deadline entry, the repeater should come
5954 first and the warning period last: @code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
5956 @vindex org-todo-repeat-to-state
5957 Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they are
5958 over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as completed
5959 once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE with the TODO
5960 keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the agenda. The problem
5961 with this is, however, that then also the @emph{next} instance of the
5962 repeated entry will not be active. Org mode deals with this in the following
5963 way: When you try to mark such an entry DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will
5964 shift the base date of the repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and
5965 immediately set the entry state back to TODO@footnote{In fact, the target
5966 state is taken from, in this sequence, the @code{REPEAT_TO_STATE} property or
5967 the variable @code{org-todo-repeat-to-state}. If neither of these is
5968 specified, the target state defaults to the first state of the TODO state
5969 sequence.}. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would actually
5970 switch the date like this:
5973 ** TODO Pay the rent
5974 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
5977 @vindex org-log-repeat
5978 A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
5979 @code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
5980 @code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
5981 will also be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
5982 a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
5984 As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
5985 visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
5988 With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
5989 month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this
5990 entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
5991 task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
5992 forgot to call your father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
5993 him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
5994 like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
5995 @i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org mode has
5996 special repeaters @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
6000 DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
6001 Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
6002 but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
6003 the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
6004 and marked it done on Saturday.
6005 ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
6006 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
6007 Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
6011 You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
6012 task---just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
6014 An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task
6015 subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command @kbd{C-c C-x c} was
6016 created for this purpose, it is described in @ref{Structure editing}.
6019 @node Clocking work time, Effort estimates, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
6020 @section Clocking work time
6021 @cindex clocking time
6022 @cindex time clocking
6024 Org mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a
6025 project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock. When
6026 you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the clock is
6027 stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It also computes
6028 the total time spent on each subtree@footnote{Clocking only works if all
6029 headings are indented with less than 30 stars. This is a hardcoded
6030 limitation of `lmax' in `org-clock-sum'.} of a project. And it remembers a
6031 history or tasks recently clocked, to that you can jump quickly between a
6032 number of tasks absorbing your time.
6034 To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use
6036 (setq org-clock-persist 'history)
6037 (org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
6039 When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
6040 clock@footnote{To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked
6041 on this task while outside Emacs, use @code{(setq org-clock-persist t)}.}
6042 will be found (@pxref{Resolving idle time}) and you will be prompted about
6046 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
6047 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
6048 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
6051 @node Clocking commands, The clock table, Clocking work time, Clocking work time
6052 @subsection Clocking commands
6055 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-i,org-clock-in}
6056 @vindex org-clock-into-drawer
6057 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6058 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
6059 Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
6060 keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
6061 this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
6062 @code{:LOGBOOK:} drawer (see also the variable
6063 @code{org-clock-into-drawer}). You can also overrule
6064 the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
6065 @code{CLOCK_INTO_DRAWER} or @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
6066 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
6067 select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
6068 C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task;
6069 the default task will then always be available with letter @kbd{d} when
6070 selecting a clocking task. With three @kbd{C-u C-u C-u} prefixes, force
6071 continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last clock stopped.@*
6072 @cindex property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL
6073 @cindex property: LAST_REPEAT
6074 @vindex org-clock-modeline-total
6075 While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in the mode
6076 line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown will be all
6077 time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort
6078 estimate (@pxref{Effort estimates}), the mode line displays the current
6079 clocking time against it@footnote{To add an effort estimate ``on the fly'',
6080 hook a function doing this to @code{org-clock-in-prepare-hook}.} If the task
6081 is a repeating one (@pxref{Repeated tasks}), only the time since the last
6082 reset of the task @footnote{as recorded by the @code{LAST_REPEAT} property}
6083 will be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised with
6084 the @code{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL} property. It may have the values
6085 @code{current} to show only the current clocking instance, @code{today} to
6086 show all time clocked on this tasks today (see also the variable
6087 @code{org-extend-today-until}), @code{all} to include all time, or
6088 @code{auto} which is the default@footnote{See also the variable
6089 @code{org-clock-modeline-total}.}.@* Clicking with @kbd{mouse-1} onto the
6090 mode line entry will pop up a menu with clocking options.
6092 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-o,org-clock-out}
6093 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
6094 Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same
6095 location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
6096 the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
6097 HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
6098 possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
6099 timestamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
6100 @code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
6101 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-x,org-clock-in-last}
6102 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6103 Reclock the last clocked task. With one @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
6104 select the task from the clock history. With two @kbd{C-u} prefixes,
6105 force continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last clock
6107 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6108 Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
6111 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
6112 Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This
6113 is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change
6114 them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
6115 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{up/down},org-clock-timestamps-up/down}
6116 On @code{CLOCK} log lines, increase/decrease both timestamps so that the
6117 clock duration keeps the same.
6118 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{up/down},org-timestamp-up/down}
6119 On @code{CLOCK} log lines, increase/decrease the timestamp at point and
6120 the one of the previous (or the next clock) timestamp by the same duration.
6121 For example, if you hit @kbd{S-M-@key{up}} to increase a clocked-out timestamp
6122 by five minutes, then the clocked-in timestamp of the next clock will be
6123 increased by five minutes.
6124 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
6125 Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
6126 if it is running in this same item.
6127 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-q,org-clock-cancel}
6128 Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
6129 mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
6130 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-j,org-clock-goto}
6131 Jump to the headline of the currently clocked in task. With a @kbd{C-u}
6132 prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked tasks.
6133 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-d,org-clock-display}
6134 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
6135 Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This puts
6136 overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time recorded under
6137 that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You can use visibility
6138 cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear when you change the
6139 buffer (see variable @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press
6143 The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
6144 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
6145 worked on or closed during a day.
6147 @strong{Important:} note that both @code{org-clock-out} and
6148 @code{org-clock-in-last} can have a global keybinding and will not
6149 modify the window disposition.
6151 @node The clock table, Resolving idle time, Clocking commands, Clocking work time
6152 @subsection The clock table
6153 @cindex clocktable, dynamic block
6154 @cindex report, of clocked time
6156 Org mode can produce quite complex reports based on the time clocking
6157 information. Such a report is called a @emph{clock table}, because it is
6158 formatted as one or several Org tables.
6161 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-r,org-clock-report}
6162 Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
6163 report as an Org mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
6164 at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
6165 argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
6166 update it. The clock table always includes also trees with
6167 @code{:ARCHIVE:} tag.
6168 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
6169 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
6170 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
6171 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
6172 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
6173 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
6174 @orgcmdkxkc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-clocktable-try-shift}
6175 Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
6176 needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
6177 @code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
6181 Here is an example of the frame for a clock table as it is inserted into the
6182 buffer with the @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} command:
6184 @cindex #+BEGIN, clocktable
6186 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
6190 @vindex org-clocktable-defaults
6191 The @samp{BEGIN} line and specify a number of options to define the scope,
6192 structure, and formatting of the report. Defaults for all these options can
6193 be configured in the variable @code{org-clocktable-defaults}.
6195 @noindent First there are options that determine which clock entries are to
6198 :maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
6199 @r{Clocks at deeper levels will be summed into the upper level.}
6200 :scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
6201 nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
6202 file @r{the full current buffer}
6203 subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
6204 tree@var{N} @r{the surrounding level @var{N} tree, for example @code{tree3}}
6205 tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
6206 agenda @r{all agenda files}
6207 ("file"..) @r{scan these files}
6208 file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
6209 agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
6210 :block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
6211 @r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
6213 2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
6214 2007-12 @r{December 2007}
6215 2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
6216 2007-Q2 @r{2nd quarter in 2007}
6217 2007 @r{the year 2007}
6218 today, yesterday, today-@var{N} @r{a relative day}
6219 thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-@var{N} @r{a relative week}
6220 thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-@var{N} @r{a relative month}
6221 thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-@var{N} @r{a relative year}
6222 @r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
6223 :tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times.}
6224 :tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times.}
6225 :step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
6226 @r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
6227 :stepskip0 @r{Do not show steps that have zero time.}
6228 :fileskip0 @r{Do not show table sections from files which did not contribute.}
6229 :tags @r{A tags match to select entries that should contribute. See}
6230 @r{@ref{Matching tags and properties} for the match syntax.}
6233 Then there are options which determine the formatting of the table. There
6234 options are interpreted by the function @code{org-clocktable-write-default},
6235 but you can specify your own function using the @code{:formatter} parameter.
6237 :emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items.}
6238 :lang @r{Language@footnote{Language terms can be set through the variable @code{org-clock-clocktable-language-setup}.} to use for descriptive cells like "Task".}
6239 :link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.}
6240 :narrow @r{An integer to limit the width of the headline column in}
6241 @r{the org table. If you write it like @samp{50!}, then the}
6242 @r{headline will also be shortened in export.}
6243 :indent @r{Indent each headline field according to its level.}
6244 :tcolumns @r{Number of columns to be used for times. If this is smaller}
6245 @r{than @code{:maxlevel}, lower levels will be lumped into one column.}
6246 :level @r{Should a level number column be included?}
6247 :compact @r{Abbreviation for @code{:level nil :indent t :narrow 40! :tcolumns 1}}
6248 @r{All are overwritten except if there is an explicit @code{:narrow}}
6249 :timestamp @r{A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED,}
6250 @r{DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order.}
6251 :properties @r{List of properties that should be shown in the table. Each}
6252 @r{property will get its own column.}
6253 :inherit-props @r{When this flag is @code{t}, the values for @code{:properties} will be inherited.}
6254 :formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
6255 @r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds a column with % time.}
6256 @r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula}
6257 @r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
6258 :formatter @r{A function to format clock data and insert it into the buffer.}
6260 To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
6261 day, you could write
6263 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
6267 and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
6268 parameters must be specified in a single line---the line is broken here
6269 only to fit it into the manual.}
6271 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
6272 :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
6275 A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
6277 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
6280 A horizontally compact representation of everything clocked during last week
6283 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope agenda :block lastweek :compact t
6287 @node Resolving idle time, , The clock table, Clocking work time
6288 @subsection Resolving idle time and continuous clocking
6290 @subsubheading Resolving idle time
6291 @cindex resolve idle time
6293 @cindex idle, resolve, dangling
6294 If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
6295 computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to ``resolve'' the
6296 time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or
6297 applying it to another one.
6299 @vindex org-clock-idle-time
6300 By customizing the variable @code{org-clock-idle-time} to some integer, such
6301 as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after
6302 being idle for that many minutes@footnote{On computers using Mac OS X,
6303 idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For
6304 X11, you can install a utility program @file{x11idle.c}, available in the
6305 @code{contrib/scripts} directory of the Org git distribution, to get the same
6306 general treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs
6307 idle time only.}, and ask what you want to do with the idle time. There will
6308 be a question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how much idle
6309 time has passed (constantly updated with the current amount), as well as a
6310 set of choices to correct the discrepancy:
6314 To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press @kbd{k}. Org
6315 will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press @key{RET} to keep them all,
6316 effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes.
6318 If you use the shift key and press @kbd{K}, it will keep however many minutes
6319 you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of
6320 the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task.
6322 To keep none of the minutes, use @kbd{s} to subtract all the away time from
6323 the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned.
6325 To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time,
6326 use the shift key and press @kbd{S}. Remember that using shift will always
6327 leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose.
6329 To cancel the clock altogether, use @kbd{C}. Note that if instead of
6330 canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less
6331 than a minute, the clock will still be canceled rather than clutter up the
6332 log with an empty entry.
6335 What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now
6336 want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately
6337 after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time ``on
6338 the books'', so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to
6339 the next task you clock in on.
6341 There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you
6342 were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who
6343 scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly
6344 lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org
6345 mode changes, including your last clock in.
6347 If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a
6348 dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using
6349 that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period,
6350 Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is
6351 identical to dealing with away time due to idleness; it is just happening due
6352 to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time.
6354 You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling
6355 clocks at any time using @kbd{M-x org-resolve-clocks RET} (or @kbd{C-c C-x C-z}).
6357 @subsubheading Continuous clocking
6358 @cindex continuous clocking
6359 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6361 You may want to start clocking from the time when you clocked out the
6362 previous task. To enable this systematically, set @code{org-clock-continuously}
6363 to @code{t}. Each time you clock in, Org retrieves the clock-out time of the
6364 last clocked entry for this session, and start the new clock from there.
6366 If you only want this from time to time, use three universal prefix arguments
6367 with @code{org-clock-in} and two @kbd{C-u C-u} with @code{org-clock-in-last}.
6369 @node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
6370 @section Effort estimates
6371 @cindex effort estimates
6373 @cindex property, Effort
6374 @vindex org-effort-property
6375 If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
6376 produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
6377 assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
6378 may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
6379 great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
6380 special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
6381 used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. You can set the effort
6382 for an entry with the following commands:
6385 @orgcmd{C-c C-x e,org-set-effort}
6386 Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric prefix
6387 argument, set it to the Nth allowed value (see below). This command is also
6388 accessible from the agenda with the @kbd{e} key.
6389 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6390 Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
6393 Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view
6394 (@pxref{Column view}). You should start by setting up discrete values for
6395 effort estimates, and a @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values
6396 together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For a specific
6400 #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00
6401 #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
6405 @vindex org-global-properties
6406 @vindex org-columns-default-format
6407 or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
6408 variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
6409 In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
6410 setup may be advised.
6412 The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
6413 mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
6414 value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
6415 In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
6417 @vindex org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum
6418 If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
6419 will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
6420 the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
6421 column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
6422 an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
6423 option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
6424 appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
6425 then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
6427 Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
6428 with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
6429 these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
6430 down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
6432 @node Relative timer, Countdown timer, Effort estimates, Dates and Times
6433 @section Taking notes with a relative timer
6434 @cindex relative timer
6436 When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
6437 be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
6438 such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
6441 @orgcmd{C-c C-x .,org-timer}
6442 Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
6443 timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
6445 @orgcmd{C-c C-x -,org-timer-item}
6446 Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
6447 argument, first reset the timer to 0.
6448 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
6449 Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
6451 @c for key sequences with a comma, command name macros fail :(
6454 Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused
6455 (@command{org-timer-pause-or-continue}).
6456 @c removed the sentence because it is redundant to the following item
6457 @kindex C-u C-c C-x ,
6459 Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
6460 old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
6461 @orgcmd{C-c C-x 0,org-timer-start}
6462 Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
6463 timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
6464 specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
6465 default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
6466 restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
6467 prefix argument @kbd{C-u C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
6468 by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
6469 not started at exactly the right moment.
6472 @node Countdown timer, , Relative timer, Dates and Times
6473 @section Countdown timer
6474 @cindex Countdown timer
6478 Calling @code{org-timer-set-timer} from an Org mode buffer runs a countdown
6479 timer. Use @kbd{;} from agenda buffers, @key{C-c C-x ;} everywhere else.
6481 @code{org-timer-set-timer} prompts the user for a duration and displays a
6482 countdown timer in the modeline. @code{org-timer-default-timer} sets the
6483 default countdown value. Giving a prefix numeric argument overrides this
6486 @node Capture - Refile - Archive, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
6487 @chapter Capture - Refile - Archive
6490 An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
6491 capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
6492 Org does this using a process called @i{capture}. It also can store files
6493 related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory. Once in the
6494 system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving completed project
6495 trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and fast.
6498 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
6499 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
6500 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
6501 * Protocols:: External (e.g.@: Browser) access to Emacs and Org
6502 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
6503 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
6506 @node Capture, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive, Capture - Refile - Archive
6510 Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by John Wiegley
6511 excellent remember package. Up to version 6.36 Org used a special setup
6512 for @file{remember.el}. @file{org-remember.el} is still part of Org mode for
6513 backward compatibility with existing setups. You can find the documentation
6514 for org-remember at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-remember.pdf}.
6516 The new capturing setup described here is preferred and should be used by new
6517 users. To convert your @code{org-remember-templates}, run the command
6519 @kbd{M-x org-capture-import-remember-templates @key{RET}}
6521 @noindent and then customize the new variable with @kbd{M-x
6522 customize-variable org-capture-templates}, check the result, and save the
6523 customization. You can then use both remember and capture until
6524 you are familiar with the new mechanism.
6526 Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your work
6527 flow. The basic process of capturing is very similar to remember, but Org
6528 does enhance it with templates and more.
6531 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
6532 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
6533 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
6536 @node Setting up capture, Using capture, Capture, Capture
6537 @subsection Setting up capture
6539 The following customization sets a default target file for notes, and defines
6540 a global key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c c} is only a
6541 suggestion.} for capturing new material.
6543 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6545 (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
6546 (define-key global-map "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
6549 @node Using capture, Capture templates, Setting up capture, Capture
6550 @subsection Using capture
6553 @orgcmd{C-c c,org-capture}
6554 Call the command @code{org-capture}. Note that this keybinding is global and
6555 not active by default - you need to install it. If you have templates
6557 defined @pxref{Capture templates}, it will offer these templates for
6558 selection or use a new Org outline node as the default template. It will
6559 insert the template into the target file and switch to an indirect buffer
6560 narrowed to this new node. You may then insert the information you want.
6562 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-capture-finalize}
6563 Once you have finished entering information into the capture buffer, @kbd{C-c
6564 C-c} will return you to the window configuration before the capture process,
6565 so that you can resume your work without further distraction. When called
6566 with a prefix arg, finalize and then jump to the captured item.
6568 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-capture-refile}
6569 Finalize the capture process by refiling (@pxref{Refiling notes}) the note to
6570 a different place. Please realize that this is a normal refiling command
6571 that will be executed---so the cursor position at the moment you run this
6572 command is important. If you have inserted a tree with a parent and
6573 children, first move the cursor back to the parent. Any prefix argument
6574 given to this command will be passed on to the @code{org-refile} command.
6576 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,org-capture-kill}
6577 Abort the capture process and return to the previous state.
6581 You can also call @code{org-capture} in a special way from the agenda, using
6582 the @kbd{k c} key combination. With this access, any timestamps inserted by
6583 the selected capture template will default to the cursor date in the agenda,
6584 rather than to the current date.
6586 To find the locations of the last stored capture, use @code{org-capture} with
6591 Visit the target location of a capture template. You get to select the
6592 template in the usual way.
6593 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-c c}
6594 Visit the last stored capture item in its buffer.
6597 @vindex org-capture-bookmark
6598 @cindex org-capture-last-stored
6599 You can also jump to the bookmark @code{org-capture-last-stored}, which will
6600 automatically be created unless you set @code{org-capture-bookmark} to
6603 To insert the capture at point in an Org buffer, call @code{org-capture} with
6604 a @code{C-0} prefix argument.
6606 @node Capture templates, , Using capture, Capture
6607 @subsection Capture templates
6608 @cindex templates, for Capture
6610 You can use templates for different types of capture items, and
6611 for different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is
6612 through the customize interface.
6616 Customize the variable @code{org-capture-templates}.
6619 Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's look at
6620 an example. Say you would like to use one template to create general TODO
6621 entries, and you want to put these entries under the heading @samp{Tasks} in
6622 your file @file{~/org/gtd.org}. Also, a date tree in the file
6623 @file{journal.org} should capture journal entries. A possible configuration
6627 (setq org-capture-templates
6628 '(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks")
6629 "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a")
6630 ("j" "Journal" entry (file+datetree "~/org/journal.org")
6631 "* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a")))
6634 @noindent If you then press @kbd{C-c c t}, Org will prepare the template
6638 [[file:@var{link to where you initiated capture}]]
6642 During expansion of the template, @code{%a} has been replaced by a link to
6643 the location from where you called the capture command. This can be
6644 extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill in
6645 the task definition, press @code{C-c C-c} and Org returns you to the same
6646 place where you started the capture process.
6648 To define special keys to capture to a particular template without going
6649 through the interactive template selection, you can create your key binding
6653 (define-key global-map "\C-cx"
6654 (lambda () (interactive) (org-capture nil "x")))
6658 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
6659 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
6660 * Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context
6663 @node Template elements, Template expansion, Capture templates, Capture templates
6664 @subsubsection Template elements
6666 Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in
6667 @code{org-capture-templates} is a list with the following items:
6671 The keys that will select the template, as a string, characters
6672 only, for example @code{"a"} for a template to be selected with a
6673 single key, or @code{"bt"} for selection with two keys. When using
6674 several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential
6675 in the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the
6676 prefix key, for example
6678 ("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy")
6680 @noindent If you do not define a template for the @kbd{C} key, this key will
6681 be used to open the customize buffer for this complex variable.
6684 A short string describing the template, which will be shown during
6688 The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are:
6691 An Org mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child of the target
6692 entry or as a top-level entry. The target file should be an Org mode file.
6694 A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the target
6695 location. Again the target file should be an Org file.
6697 A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item by the
6700 a new line in the first table at the target location. Where exactly the
6701 line will be inserted depends on the properties @code{:prepend} and
6702 @code{:table-line-pos} (see below).
6704 Text to be inserted as it is.
6708 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6709 Specification of where the captured item should be placed. In Org mode
6710 files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become children of this
6711 node. Other types will be added to the table or list in the body of this
6712 node. Most target specifications contain a file name. If that file name is
6713 the empty string, it defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}. A file can
6714 also be given as a variable, function, or Emacs Lisp form.
6718 @item (file "path/to/file")
6719 Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file.
6721 @item (id "id of existing org entry")
6722 Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry.
6724 @item (file+headline "path/to/file" "node headline")
6725 Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the file.
6727 @item (file+olp "path/to/file" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)
6728 For non-unique headings, the full path is safer.
6730 @item (file+regexp "path/to/file" "regexp to find location")
6731 Use a regular expression to position the cursor.
6733 @item (file+datetree "path/to/file")
6734 Will create a heading in a date tree for today's date.
6736 @item (file+datetree+prompt "path/to/file")
6737 Will create a heading in a date tree, but will prompt for the date.
6739 @item (file+function "path/to/file" function-finding-location)
6740 A function to find the right location in the file.
6743 File to the entry that is currently being clocked.
6745 @item (function function-finding-location)
6746 Most general way, write your own function to find both
6751 The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this empty, an
6752 appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise this is a string with
6753 escape codes, which will be replaced depending on time and context of the
6754 capture call. The string with escapes may be loaded from a template file,
6755 using the special syntax @code{(file "path/to/template")}. See below for
6759 The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options.
6760 Recognized properties are:
6763 Normally new captured information will be appended at
6764 the target location (last child, last table line, last list item...).
6765 Setting this property will change that.
6767 @item :immediate-finish
6768 When set, do not offer to edit the information, just
6769 file it away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs
6770 information that can be added automatically.
6773 Set this to the number of lines to insert
6774 before and after the new item. Default 0, only common other value is 1.
6777 Start the clock in this item.
6780 Keep the clock running when filing the captured entry.
6783 If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that clock when finished
6784 with the capture. Note that @code{:clock-keep} has precedence over
6785 @code{:clock-resume}. When setting both to @code{t}, the current clock will
6786 run and the previous one will not be resumed.
6789 Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. Default is to
6790 narrow it so that you only see the new material.
6792 @item :table-line-pos
6793 Specification of the location in the table where the new line should be
6794 inserted. It should be a string like @code{"II-3"} meaning that the new
6795 line should become the third line before the second horizontal separator
6799 If the target file was not yet visited when capture was invoked, kill the
6800 buffer again after capture is completed.
6804 @node Template expansion, Templates in contexts, Template elements, Capture templates
6805 @subsubsection Template expansion
6807 In the template itself, special @kbd{%}-escapes@footnote{If you need one of
6808 these sequences literally, escape the @kbd{%} with a backslash.} allow
6809 dynamic insertion of content. The templates are expanded in the order given here:
6812 %[@var{file}] @r{Insert the contents of the file given by @var{file}.}
6813 %(@var{sexp}) @r{Evaluate Elisp @var{sexp} and replace with the result.}
6814 @r{The sexp must return a string.}
6815 %<...> @r{The result of format-time-string on the ... format specification.}
6816 %t @r{Timestamp, date only.}
6817 %T @r{Timestamp, with date and time.}
6818 %u, %U @r{Like the above, but inactive timestamps.}
6819 %i @r{Initial content, the region when capture is called while the}
6820 @r{region is active.}
6821 @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
6822 %a @r{Annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}.}
6823 %A @r{Like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part.}
6824 %l @r{Like %a, but only insert the literal link.}
6825 %c @r{Current kill ring head.}
6826 %x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
6827 %k @r{Title of the currently clocked task.}
6828 %K @r{Link to the currently clocked task.}
6829 %n @r{User name (taken from @code{user-full-name}).}
6830 %f @r{File visited by current buffer when org-capture was called.}
6831 %F @r{Full path of the file or directory visited by current buffer.}
6832 %:keyword @r{Specific information for certain link types, see below.}
6833 %^g @r{Prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
6834 %^G @r{Prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
6835 %^t @r{Like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}.}
6836 @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}.}
6837 %^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
6838 %^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
6839 %^@{@var{prop}@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @var{prop}.}
6840 %^@{@var{prompt}@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
6841 @r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
6842 @r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}.}
6843 @r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
6844 %\n @r{Insert the text entered at the nth %^@{@var{prompt}@}, where @code{n} is}
6845 @r{a number, starting from 1.}
6846 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6850 For specific link types, the following keywords will be
6851 defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
6852 hyperlink types}), any property you store with
6853 @code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in capture templates in a
6856 @vindex org-from-is-user-regexp
6858 Link type | Available keywords
6859 ---------------------------------+----------------------------------------------
6860 bbdb | %:name %:company
6861 irc | %:server %:port %:nick
6862 vm, vm-imap, wl, mh, mew, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
6863 | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
6864 | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
6865 | %:date @r{(message date header field)}
6866 | %:date-timestamp @r{(date as active timestamp)}
6867 | %:date-timestamp-inactive @r{(date as inactive timestamp)}
6868 | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
6869 gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
6871 info | %:file %:node
6876 To place the cursor after template expansion use:
6879 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6882 @node Templates in contexts, , Template expansion, Capture templates
6883 @subsubsection Templates in contexts
6885 @vindex org-capture-templates-contexts
6886 To control whether a capture template should be accessible from a specific
6887 context, you can customize @var{org-capture-templates-contexts}. Let's say
6888 for example that you have a capture template @code{"p"} for storing Gnus
6889 emails containing patches. Then you would configure this option like this:
6892 (setq org-capture-templates-contexts
6893 '(("p" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
6896 You can also tell that the command key @code{"p"} should refer to another
6897 template. In that case, add this command key like this:
6900 (setq org-capture-templates-contexts
6901 '(("p" "q" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
6904 See the docstring of the variable for more information.
6906 @node Attachments, RSS Feeds, Capture, Capture - Refile - Archive
6907 @section Attachments
6910 @vindex org-attach-directory
6911 It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
6912 Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
6913 Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can establish associations with
6914 files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
6915 source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
6916 which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
6917 uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
6918 located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
6919 your Org file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org files from one
6920 directory to another, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
6921 to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
6922 @code{git init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
6923 The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
6925 In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a directory of your
6926 choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment
6927 directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached
6930 @noindent The following commands deal with attachments:
6934 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
6935 The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
6936 keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must press an additional key
6937 to select a command:
6940 @orgcmdtkc{a,C-c C-a a,org-attach-attach}
6941 @vindex org-attach-method
6942 Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
6943 will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
6944 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6950 Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
6951 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6953 @orgcmdtkc{n,C-c C-a n,org-attach-new}
6954 Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
6956 @orgcmdtkc{z,C-c C-a z,org-attach-sync}
6957 Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
6958 attachments yourself.
6960 @orgcmdtkc{o,C-c C-a o,org-attach-open}
6961 @vindex org-file-apps
6962 Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one, prompt for a
6963 file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
6964 For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks
6965 (@pxref{Handling links}).
6967 @orgcmdtkc{O,C-c C-a O,org-attach-open-in-emacs}
6968 Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
6970 @orgcmdtkc{f,C-c C-a f,org-attach-reveal}
6971 Open the current task's attachment directory.
6973 @orgcmdtkc{F,C-c C-a F,org-attach-reveal-in-emacs}
6974 Also open the directory, but force using @command{dired} in Emacs.
6976 @orgcmdtkc{d,C-c C-a d,org-attach-delete-one}
6977 Select and delete a single attachment.
6979 @orgcmdtkc{D,C-c C-a D,org-attach-delete-all}
6980 Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
6981 @command{dired} and delete from there.
6983 @orgcmdtkc{s,C-c C-a s,org-attach-set-directory}
6984 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR
6985 Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by
6986 putting the directory path into the @code{ATTACH_DIR} property.
6988 @orgcmdtkc{i,C-c C-a i,org-attach-set-inherit}
6989 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT
6990 Set the @code{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT} property, so that children will use the
6991 same directory for attachments as the parent does.
6995 @node RSS Feeds, Protocols, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive
7000 Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds and
7001 Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a
7002 podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the
7003 web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, configure the variable
7004 @code{org-feed-alist}. The docstring of this variable has detailed
7005 information. Here is just an example:
7008 (setq org-feed-alist
7010 "http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot"
7011 "~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries")))
7015 will configure that new items from the feed provided by
7016 @code{rss.slashdot.org} will result in new entries in the file
7017 @file{~/org/feeds.org} under the heading @samp{Slashdot Entries}, whenever
7018 the following command is used:
7021 @orgcmd{C-c C-x g,org-feed-update-all}
7023 Collect items from the feeds configured in @code{org-feed-alist} and act upon
7025 @orgcmd{C-c C-x G,org-feed-goto-inbox}
7026 Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed.
7029 Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer @samp{FEEDSTATUS} in which
7030 it will store information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid
7031 adding the same item several times. You should add @samp{FEEDSTATUS} to the
7032 list of drawers in that file:
7035 #+DRAWERS: LOGBOOK PROPERTIES FEEDSTATUS
7038 For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see
7039 @file{org-feed.el} and the docstring of @code{org-feed-alist}.
7041 @node Protocols, Refiling notes, RSS Feeds, Capture - Refile - Archive
7042 @section Protocols for external access
7043 @cindex protocols, for external access
7046 You can set up Org for handling protocol calls from outside applications that
7047 are passed to Emacs through the @file{emacsserver}. For example, you can
7048 configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to
7049 Org and create a note from it using capture (@pxref{Capture}). Or you
7050 could create a bookmark that will tell Emacs to open the local source file of
7051 a remote website you are looking at with the browser. See
7052 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.php} for detailed
7053 documentation and setup instructions.
7055 @node Refiling notes, Archiving, Protocols, Capture - Refile - Archive
7056 @section Refiling notes
7057 @cindex refiling notes
7059 When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile some of the entries
7060 into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting, finding the
7061 right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To simplify this
7062 process, you can use the following special command:
7065 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
7066 @vindex org-reverse-note-order
7067 @vindex org-refile-targets
7068 @vindex org-refile-use-outline-path
7069 @vindex org-outline-path-complete-in-steps
7070 @vindex org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes
7071 @vindex org-log-refile
7072 @vindex org-refile-use-cache
7073 Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
7074 for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
7075 all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
7076 Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
7078 By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
7079 targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
7080 See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
7081 select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
7082 the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
7083 @code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}. If you would like to be able to
7084 create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, check the
7085 variable @code{org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes}.
7086 When the variable @code{org-log-refile}@footnote{with corresponding
7087 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logrefile}, @code{lognoterefile},
7088 and @code{nologrefile}} is set, a timestamp or a note will be
7089 recorded when an entry has been refiled.
7090 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-w}
7091 Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
7092 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-w,org-refile-goto-last-stored}
7093 Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
7095 Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
7096 @orgcmdtkc{C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w,C-0 C-c C-w,org-refile-cache-clear}
7097 Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned on by
7098 setting @code{org-refile-use-cache}. To make the command see new possible
7099 targets, you have to clear the cache with this command.
7102 @node Archiving, , Refiling notes, Capture - Refile - Archive
7106 When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
7107 to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
7108 agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global
7109 searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
7112 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-a,org-archive-subtree-default}
7113 @vindex org-archive-default-command
7114 Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable
7115 @code{org-archive-default-command}.
7119 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
7120 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
7123 @node Moving subtrees, Internal archiving, Archiving, Archiving
7124 @subsection Moving a tree to the archive file
7125 @cindex external archiving
7127 The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file,
7131 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,C-c $,org-archive-subtree}
7132 @vindex org-archive-location
7133 Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
7134 given by @code{org-archive-location}.
7135 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-s}
7136 Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
7137 the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
7138 If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
7139 location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
7140 is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
7143 @cindex archive locations
7144 The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
7145 current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
7146 current file name. You can also choose what heading to file archived
7147 items under, with the possibility to add them to a datetree in a file.
7148 For information and examples on how to specify the file and the heading,
7149 see the documentation string of the variable
7150 @code{org-archive-location}.
7152 There is also an in-buffer option for setting this variable, for
7153 example@footnote{For backward compatibility, the following also works:
7154 If there are several such lines in a file, each specifies the archive
7155 location for the text below it. The first such line also applies to any
7156 text before its definition. However, using this method is
7157 @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible with the outline
7158 structure of the document. The correct method for setting multiple
7159 archive locations in a buffer is using properties.}:
7163 #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
7166 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
7168 If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
7169 or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
7170 location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
7172 @vindex org-archive-save-context-info
7173 When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
7174 record context information like the file from where the entry came, its
7175 outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
7176 @code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
7180 @node Internal archiving, , Moving subtrees, Archiving
7181 @subsection Internal archiving
7183 If you want to just switch off (for agenda views) certain subtrees without
7184 moving them to a different file, you can use the @code{ARCHIVE tag}.
7186 A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
7187 its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
7190 @vindex org-cycle-open-archived-trees
7191 It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
7192 command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
7193 subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
7194 @code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
7195 @code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
7197 @vindex org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees
7198 During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
7199 archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
7200 @code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
7202 @vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
7203 During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
7204 archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
7205 @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
7206 be included. In the agenda you can press @kbd{v a} to get archives
7207 temporarily included.
7209 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
7210 Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
7211 is. Configure the details using the variable
7212 @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
7214 @vindex org-columns-skip-archived-trees
7215 Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
7216 @code{org-columns-skip-archived-trees} is configured to @code{nil}.
7219 The following commands help manage the ARCHIVE tag:
7222 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-toggle-archive-tag}
7223 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
7224 the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
7226 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x a}
7227 Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
7228 To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
7229 found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
7230 cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
7231 level 1 trees will be checked.
7232 @orgcmd{C-@kbd{TAB},org-force-cycle-archived}
7233 Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
7234 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-archive-to-archive-sibling}
7235 Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
7236 the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}. The
7237 entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its
7238 original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the
7243 @node Agenda Views, Markup, Capture - Refile - Archive, Top
7244 @chapter Agenda views
7245 @cindex agenda views
7247 Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
7248 tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
7249 files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
7250 important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
7251 sorted and displayed in an organized way.
7253 Org can select items based on various criteria and display them
7254 in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
7258 an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
7261 a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
7264 a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and
7265 TODO state associated with them,
7267 a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
7268 in time-sorted view,
7270 a @emph{text search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
7271 that contain specified keywords,
7273 a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
7276 @emph{custom views} that are special searches and combinations of different
7281 The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
7282 buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
7283 corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
7284 edit these files remotely.
7286 @vindex org-agenda-window-setup
7287 @vindex org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit
7288 Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
7289 window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
7290 @code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
7291 @code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
7294 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
7295 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
7296 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
7297 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
7298 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
7299 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
7300 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
7301 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
7304 @node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
7305 @section Agenda files
7306 @cindex agenda files
7307 @cindex files for agenda
7309 @vindex org-agenda-files
7310 The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
7311 files}, the files listed in the variable
7312 @code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
7313 list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
7314 maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
7315 all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
7318 Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
7319 be put into the list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
7320 @kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
7321 the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
7322 dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
7323 the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
7325 @cindex files, adding to agenda list
7327 @orgcmd{C-c [,org-agenda-file-to-front}
7328 Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
7329 the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
7330 the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
7331 @orgcmd{C-c ],org-remove-file}
7332 Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
7334 @cindex cycling, of agenda files
7335 @orgcmd{C-',org-cycle-agenda-files}
7337 Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
7338 @kindex M-x org-iswitchb
7339 @item M-x org-iswitchb
7340 Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
7345 The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
7346 to visit any of them.
7348 If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
7349 this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a
7350 file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
7351 you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
7352 (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
7353 extended period, use the following commands:
7356 @orgcmd{C-c C-x <,org-agenda-set-restriction-lock}
7357 Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
7358 prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
7359 the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
7360 effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
7361 or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
7362 agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
7363 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7364 Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
7368 When working with @file{speedbar.el}, you can use the following commands in
7371 @orgcmdtkc{< @r{in the speedbar frame},<,org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction}
7372 Permanently restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree
7373 in such a file---at the cursor in the Speedbar frame.
7374 If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
7376 @orgcmdtkc{> @r{in the speedbar frame},>,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7377 Lift the restriction.
7380 @node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
7381 @section The agenda dispatcher
7382 @cindex agenda dispatcher
7383 @cindex dispatching agenda commands
7384 The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a
7385 global key---for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Activation}). In the
7386 following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
7387 is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
7388 pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
7389 command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
7392 Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
7394 Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
7396 Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
7397 tags and properties}).
7399 Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
7401 Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
7402 and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
7404 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7405 Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
7406 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. This
7407 uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
7408 used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
7411 Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
7413 Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
7414 compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
7415 buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
7416 selecting the command.
7418 If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
7419 the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
7420 backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
7421 current region/subtree.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
7422 character selecting the command.
7425 @vindex org-agenda-sticky
7426 Toggle sticky agenda views. By default, Org maintains only a single agenda
7427 buffer and rebuilds it each time you change the view, to make sure everything
7428 is always up to date. If you switch between views often and the build time
7429 bothers you, you can turn on sticky agenda buffers (make this the default by
7430 customizing the variable @code{org-agenda-sticky}). With sticky agendas, the
7431 dispatcher only switches to the selected view, you need to update it by hand
7432 with @kbd{r} or @kbd{g}. You can toggle sticky agenda view any time with
7433 @code{org-toggle-sticky-agenda}.
7436 You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
7437 dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
7438 possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
7439 blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
7440 a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
7442 @node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
7443 @section The built-in agenda views
7445 In this section we describe the built-in views.
7448 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
7449 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
7450 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
7451 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
7452 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
7453 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
7456 @node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
7457 @subsection The weekly/daily agenda
7459 @cindex weekly agenda
7460 @cindex daily agenda
7462 The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
7463 paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
7466 @cindex org-agenda, command
7467 @orgcmd{C-c a a,org-agenda-list}
7468 Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda
7469 shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
7470 compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
7471 listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
7472 list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
7473 C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed.
7476 @vindex org-agenda-span
7477 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
7478 The default number of days displayed in the agenda is set by the variable
7479 @code{org-agenda-span} (or the obsolete @code{org-agenda-ndays}). This
7480 variable can be set to any number of days you want to see by default in the
7481 agenda, or to a span name, such a @code{day}, @code{week}, @code{month} or
7484 Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
7485 change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
7486 The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
7489 @subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
7490 @cindex calendar integration
7491 @cindex diary integration
7493 Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
7494 calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
7495 countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
7496 anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
7497 (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
7498 Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
7501 In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org mode's
7502 agenda, you only need to customize the variable
7505 (setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
7508 @noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
7509 entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the
7510 agenda buffer created by Org mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
7511 @key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
7512 file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
7513 insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
7514 well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
7515 Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
7516 calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
7517 between calendar and agenda.
7519 If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
7520 faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
7521 the entries into an Org file. Org mode evaluates diary-style sexp
7522 entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
7523 creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
7524 the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example,
7525 the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
7526 will be made in the agenda:
7529 * Birthdays and similar stuff
7531 %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
7533 %%(org-anniversary 1956 5 14)@footnote{@code{org-anniversary} is just like @code{diary-anniversary}, but the argument order is always according to ISO and therefore independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.} Arthur Dent is %d years old
7534 %%(org-anniversary 1869 10 2) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
7537 @subsubheading Anniversaries from BBDB
7538 @cindex BBDB, anniversaries
7539 @cindex anniversaries, from BBDB
7541 If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you will
7542 very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a
7543 separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB
7544 anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the
7545 following to one of your agenda files:
7552 %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
7555 You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically,
7556 you need to press @kbd{C-o anniversary @key{RET}} with the cursor in a BBDB
7557 record and then add the date in the format @code{YYYY-MM-DD} or @code{MM-DD},
7558 followed by a space and the class of the anniversary (@samp{birthday} or
7559 @samp{wedding}, or a format string). If you omit the class, it will default to
7560 @samp{birthday}. Here are a few examples, the header for the file
7561 @file{org-bbdb.el} contains more detailed information.
7567 2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org mode, %d years ago
7570 After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs
7571 session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org updates its
7572 hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast---much
7573 faster in fact than a long list of @samp{%%(diary-anniversary)} entries
7574 in an Org or Diary file.
7576 @subsubheading Appointment reminders
7577 @cindex @file{appt.el}
7578 @cindex appointment reminders
7582 Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add the
7583 appointments of your agenda files, use the command @code{org-agenda-to-appt}.
7584 This command lets you filter through the list of your appointments and add
7585 only those belonging to a specific category or matching a regular expression.
7586 It also reads a @code{APPT_WARNTIME} property which will then override the
7587 value of @code{appt-message-warning-time} for this appointment. See the
7588 docstring for details.
7590 @node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
7591 @subsection The global TODO list
7592 @cindex global TODO list
7593 @cindex TODO list, global
7595 The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
7596 collected into a single place.
7599 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
7600 Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all agenda
7601 files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. By default, this lists
7602 items with a state the is not a DONE state. The buffer is in
7603 @code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate the TODO
7604 entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
7605 @orgcmd{C-c a T,org-todo-list}
7606 @cindex TODO keyword matching
7607 @vindex org-todo-keywords
7608 Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You can
7609 also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. You are
7610 prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several keywords by
7611 separating them with @samp{|} as the boolean OR operator. With a numeric
7612 prefix, the Nth keyword in @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
7614 The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
7615 a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
7616 for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
7617 keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
7618 Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
7619 search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
7622 Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
7623 TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
7624 TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
7626 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
7627 Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
7628 keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
7632 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled
7633 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines
7634 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp
7635 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date
7636 Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for execution or
7637 have a @emph{deadline} (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}.
7638 Configure the variables @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled},
7639 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines},
7640 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp} and/or
7641 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date} to exclude such items from the global
7644 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
7645 TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
7646 such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
7647 and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
7648 @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
7651 @node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
7652 @subsection Matching tags and properties
7653 @cindex matching, of tags
7654 @cindex matching, of properties
7658 If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} (@pxref{Tags}),
7659 or have properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), you can select headlines
7660 based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match
7661 syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with @kbd{C-c /
7665 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
7666 Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
7667 command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
7668 expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
7669 @samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
7670 define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
7671 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
7672 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
7673 @vindex org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options
7674 Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items in a
7675 not-DONE state and force checking subitems (see variable
7676 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). To exclude scheduled/deadline items,
7677 see the variable @code{org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options}. Matching
7678 specific TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see
7682 The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
7685 @subsubheading Match syntax
7687 @cindex Boolean logic, for tag/property searches
7688 A search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and @samp{|} for
7689 OR. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}. Parentheses are currently
7690 not implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular
7691 expression matching tags, or an expression like @code{PROPERTY OPERATOR
7692 VALUE} with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each element
7693 may be preceded by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic
7694 sugar for positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when
7695 @samp{+} or @samp{-} is present. Here are some examples, using only tags.
7699 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
7702 Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
7703 @item work|laptop+night
7704 Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
7708 @cindex regular expressions, with tags search
7709 Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly
7710 braces. For example,
7711 @samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
7712 @samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}.
7714 @cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
7715 @cindex level, require for tags/property match
7716 @cindex category, require for tags/property match
7717 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
7718 You may also test for properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same
7719 time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special
7720 properties that represent other metadata (@pxref{Special properties}). For
7721 example, the ``property'' @code{TODO} represents the TODO keyword of the
7722 entry. Or, the ``property'' @code{LEVEL} represents the level of an entry.
7723 So a search @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"} lists all level three headlines
7724 that have the tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword
7725 DONE. In buffers with @code{org-odd-levels-only} set, @samp{LEVEL} does not
7726 count the number of stars, but @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars etc.
7727 The ITEM special property cannot currently be used in tags/property
7728 searches@footnote{But @pxref{x-agenda-skip-entry-regexp,
7729 ,skipping entries based on regexp}.}.
7731 Here are more examples:
7733 @item work+TODO="WAITING"
7734 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
7735 keyword @samp{WAITING}.
7736 @item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
7737 Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
7740 When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test
7741 the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
7744 +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
7745 +With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
7749 The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
7752 If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
7753 and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
7754 @samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
7756 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes,
7757 a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
7759 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes @emph{and} angular
7760 brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
7761 assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
7762 comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
7763 are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
7764 @code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e.@: without a time
7765 specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
7766 @code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
7767 respectively, can be used.
7769 If the comparison value is enclosed
7770 in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
7771 regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
7775 So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
7776 not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
7777 @samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
7778 property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
7779 matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
7780 on or after October 11, 2008.
7782 Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
7783 other properties will slow down the search. However, once you have paid the
7784 price by accessing one property, testing additional properties is cheap
7787 You can configure Org mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
7788 beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
7789 inheritance}, for details.
7791 For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a
7792 different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the
7793 tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms
7794 connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then specify a Boolean
7795 expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for
7796 tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive selection on
7797 several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with boolean AND.
7798 However, @emph{negative selection} combined with AND can be meaningful. To
7799 make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any TODO keyword
7800 (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M}, or equivalently start the TODO
7801 part after the slash with @samp{!}. Using @kbd{C-c a M} or @samp{/!} will
7802 not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples:
7806 Same as @samp{work+TODO="WAITING"}
7807 @item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
7808 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
7810 @item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
7811 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
7815 @node Timeline, Search view, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
7816 @subsection Timeline for a single file
7817 @cindex timeline, single file
7818 @cindex time-sorted view
7820 The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org mode
7821 file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
7822 to give an overview over events in a project.
7825 @orgcmd{C-c a L,org-timeline}
7826 Show a time-sorted view of the Org file, with all time-stamped items.
7827 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
7828 (scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
7832 The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
7833 @ref{Agenda commands}.
7835 @node Search view, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
7836 @subsection Search view
7839 @cindex searching, for text
7841 This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org mode entries.
7842 It is particularly useful to find notes.
7845 @orgcmd{C-c a s,org-search-view}
7846 This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring
7847 or specific words using a boolean logic.
7849 For example, the search string @samp{computer equipment} will find entries
7850 that contain @samp{computer equipment} as a substring. If the two words are
7851 separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match.
7852 Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean
7853 logic. The search string @samp{+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}}
7854 will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
7855 and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
7856 not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
7857 exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first @samp{+} is necessary to turn on
7858 word search, other @samp{+} characters are optional. For more details, see
7859 the docstring of the command @code{org-search-view}.
7861 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7862 Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
7863 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
7865 @node Stuck projects, , Search view, Built-in agenda views
7866 @subsection Stuck projects
7867 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
7869 If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
7870 work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
7871 that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
7872 has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
7873 Org mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
7874 projects and define next actions for them.
7877 @orgcmd{C-c a #,org-agenda-list-stuck-projects}
7878 List projects that are stuck.
7881 @vindex org-stuck-projects
7882 Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
7883 project is and how to find it.
7886 You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
7887 work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
7888 level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
7889 one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
7891 Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org mode, identify
7892 projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
7893 indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
7894 assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
7895 and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
7896 is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
7897 contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
7898 either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
7899 with a tags/todo match@footnote{@xref{Tag searches}.}
7900 @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and
7901 IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The
7902 correct customization for this is
7905 (setq org-stuck-projects
7906 '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
7910 Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry
7911 will still be searched for stuck projects.
7913 @node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
7914 @section Presentation and sorting
7915 @cindex presentation, of agenda items
7917 @vindex org-agenda-prefix-format
7918 @vindex org-agenda-tags-column
7919 Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org mode visually prepares the
7920 items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line starts
7921 with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category} (@pxref{Categories})
7922 of the item and other important information. You can customize in which
7923 column tags will be displayed through @code{org-agenda-tags-column}. You can
7924 also customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
7925 This prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
7926 associated with the item.
7929 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
7930 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
7931 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
7934 @node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
7935 @subsection Categories
7939 The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
7940 the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
7941 specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
7942 backward compatibility, the following also works: if there are several
7943 such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
7944 The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
7945 line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
7946 incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
7947 method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
7955 @cindex property, CATEGORY
7956 If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
7957 (sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the
7958 special category you want to apply as the value.
7961 The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
7962 longer than 10 characters.
7965 You can set up icons for category by customizing the
7966 @code{org-agenda-category-icon-alist} variable.
7968 @node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
7969 @subsection Time-of-day specifications
7970 @cindex time-of-day specification
7972 Org mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
7973 time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
7974 agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
7975 ranges can be specified with two timestamps, like
7977 @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
7979 In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
7980 plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
7981 integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
7982 specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
7984 For agenda display, Org mode extracts the time and displays it in a
7985 standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
7986 the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
7989 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7990 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7991 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7992 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7996 If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
7997 timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
8000 8:00...... ------------------
8001 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
8002 10:00...... ------------------
8003 12:00...... ------------------
8004 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
8005 14:00...... ------------------
8006 16:00...... ------------------
8007 18:00...... ------------------
8008 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
8009 20:00...... ------------------
8010 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
8013 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
8014 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
8015 The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
8016 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
8017 @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
8019 @node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
8020 @subsection Sorting of agenda items
8021 @cindex sorting, of agenda items
8022 @cindex priorities, of agenda items
8023 Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
8024 done depends on the type of view.
8027 @vindex org-agenda-files
8028 For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
8029 default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
8030 time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
8031 of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
8032 grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
8033 Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
8034 which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
8035 for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
8036 overdue scheduled or deadline items.
8038 For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
8039 each category, sorting takes place according to priority
8040 (@pxref{Priorities}). The priority used for sorting derives from the
8041 priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due
8044 For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
8045 sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
8048 @vindex org-agenda-sorting-strategy
8049 Sorting can be customized using the variable
8050 @code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
8051 the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
8053 @node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
8054 @section Commands in the agenda buffer
8055 @cindex commands, in agenda buffer
8057 Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
8058 file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
8059 buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
8060 original entry location, and to edit the Org files ``remotely'' from
8061 the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
8062 removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
8064 Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
8065 the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
8068 @tsubheading{Motion}
8069 @cindex motion commands in agenda
8070 @orgcmd{n,org-agenda-next-line}
8071 Next line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
8072 @orgcmd{p,org-agenda-previous-line}
8073 Previous line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
8074 @tsubheading{View/Go to Org file}
8075 @orgcmdkkc{@key{SPC},mouse-3,org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up}
8076 Display the original location of the item in another window.
8077 With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
8078 outline, not only the heading.
8080 @orgcmd{L,org-agenda-recenter}
8081 Display original location and recenter that window.
8083 @orgcmdkkc{@key{TAB},mouse-2,org-agenda-goto}
8084 Go to the original location of the item in another window.
8086 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-agenda-switch-to}
8087 Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
8089 @orgcmd{F,org-agenda-follow-mode}
8090 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode
8091 Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
8092 the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
8093 location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
8094 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
8095 @code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
8097 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
8098 Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
8099 numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
8100 negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
8101 previously used indirect buffer.
8103 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-agenda-open-link}
8104 Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any links in the
8105 text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, it
8106 will be followed without a selection prompt.
8108 @tsubheading{Change display}
8109 @cindex display changing, in agenda
8112 Interactively select another agenda view and append it to the current view.
8116 Delete other windows.
8118 @orgcmdkskc{v d,d,org-agenda-day-view}
8119 @xorgcmdkskc{v w,w,org-agenda-week-view}
8120 @xorgcmd{v m,org-agenda-month-view}
8121 @xorgcmd{v y,org-agenda-year-view}
8122 @xorgcmd{v SPC,org-agenda-reset-view}
8123 @vindex org-agenda-span
8124 Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view, this
8125 setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda refreshes. Since month and
8126 year views are slow to create, they do not become the default. A numeric
8127 prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day of the year,
8128 ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example, @kbd{32 d} jumps to
8129 February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When setting day, week, or
8130 month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix argument as well. For
8131 example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in 2007. If such a year
8132 specification has only one or two digits, it will be mapped to the interval
8133 1938-2037. @kbd{v @key{SPC}} will reset to what is set in
8134 @code{org-agenda-span}.
8136 @orgcmd{f,org-agenda-later}
8137 Go forward in time to display the following @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
8138 For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week.
8139 With prefix arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
8141 @orgcmd{b,org-agenda-earlier}
8142 Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
8144 @orgcmd{.,org-agenda-goto-today}
8147 @orgcmd{j,org-agenda-goto-date}
8148 Prompt for a date and go there.
8150 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
8151 Go to the currently clocked-in task @i{in the agenda buffer}.
8153 @orgcmd{D,org-agenda-toggle-diary}
8154 Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
8156 @orgcmdkskc{v l,l,org-agenda-log-mode}
8158 @vindex org-log-done
8159 @vindex org-agenda-log-mode-items
8160 Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while
8161 logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
8162 entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
8163 types that should be included in log mode using the variable
8164 @code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
8165 all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
8166 prefix args @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
8167 @kbd{v L} is equivalent to @kbd{C-u v l}.
8169 @orgcmdkskc{v [,[,org-agenda-manipulate-query-add}
8170 Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily
8171 agenda and timeline views.
8173 @orgcmd{v a,org-agenda-archives-mode}
8174 @xorgcmd{v A,org-agenda-archives-mode 'files}
8175 Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked
8176 @code{ARCHIVED} are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you use the
8177 capital @kbd{A}, even all archive files are included. To exit archives mode,
8178 press @kbd{v a} again.
8180 @orgcmdkskc{v R,R,org-agenda-clockreport-mode}
8181 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode
8182 @vindex org-clock-report-include-clocking-task
8183 Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
8184 always show a table with the clocked times for the timespan and file scope
8185 covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
8186 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
8187 @code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}. By using a prefix argument
8188 when toggling this mode (i.e.@: @kbd{C-u R}), the clock table will not show
8189 contributions from entries that are hidden by agenda filtering@footnote{Only
8190 tags filtering will be respected here, effort filtering is ignored.}. See
8191 also the variable @code{org-clock-report-include-clocking-task}.
8194 @vindex org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks
8195 Show overlapping clock entries, clocking gaps, and other clocking problems in
8196 the current agenda range. You can then visit clocking lines and fix them
8197 manually. See the variable @code{org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks} for
8198 information on how to customize the definition of what constituted a clocking
8199 problem. To return to normal agenda display, press @kbd{l} to exit Logbook
8202 @orgcmdkskc{v E,E,org-agenda-entry-text-mode}
8203 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode
8204 @vindex org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines
8205 Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org
8206 outline node referenced by an agenda line will be displayed below the line.
8207 The maximum number of lines is given by the variable
8208 @code{org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines}. Calling this command with a numeric
8209 prefix argument will temporarily modify that number to the prefix value.
8211 @orgcmd{G,org-agenda-toggle-time-grid}
8212 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
8213 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
8214 Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
8215 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
8217 @orgcmd{r,org-agenda-redo}
8218 Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after
8219 modification of the timestamps of items with @kbd{S-@key{left}} and
8220 @kbd{S-@key{right}}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
8221 argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
8223 @orgcmd{g,org-agenda-redo}
8226 @orgcmdkskc{C-x C-s,s,org-save-all-org-buffers}
8227 Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of
8230 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8231 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8232 Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
8233 view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
8234 point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
8235 that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
8236 @code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
8237 @code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
8239 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
8240 Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a
8241 file or subtree (@pxref{Agenda files}).
8243 @tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
8244 @cindex filtering, by tag category and effort, in agenda
8245 @cindex tag filtering, in agenda
8246 @cindex category filtering, in agenda
8247 @cindex effort filtering, in agenda
8248 @cindex query editing, in agenda
8250 @orgcmd{<,org-agenda-filter-by-category}
8251 @vindex org-agenda-category-filter-preset
8253 Filter the current agenda view with respect to the category of the item at
8254 point. Pressing @code{<} another time will remove this filter. You can add
8255 a filter preset through the option @code{org-agenda-category-filter-preset}
8258 @orgcmd{/,org-agenda-filter-by-tag}
8259 @vindex org-agenda-tag-filter-preset
8260 Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
8261 The difference between this and a custom agenda command is that filtering is
8262 very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without
8263 having to recreate the agenda.@footnote{Custom commands can preset a filter by
8264 binding the variable @code{org-agenda-tag-filter-preset} as an option. This
8265 filter will then be applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through
8266 refreshes and more secondary filtering. The filter is a global property of
8267 the entire agenda view---in a block agenda, you should only set this in the
8268 global options section, not in the section of an individual block.}
8270 You will be prompted for a tag selection letter; @key{SPC} will mean any tag at
8271 all. Pressing @key{TAB} at that prompt will offer use completion to select a
8272 tag (including any tags that do not have a selection character). The command
8273 then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag. When called
8274 with prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second
8275 @kbd{/} at the prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries.
8276 If the first key you press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter
8277 will be narrowed by requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag.
8278 Instead of pressing @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also
8279 immediately use the @kbd{\} command.
8281 @vindex org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high
8282 In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set up allowed
8283 efforts globally, for example
8285 (setq org-global-properties
8286 '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
8288 You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of
8289 @kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort
8290 estimate in your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value.
8291 The filter will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal,
8292 or larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0-9 are not used
8293 as fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit
8294 directly without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed. For
8295 application of the operator, entries without a defined effort will be treated
8296 according to the value of @code{org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high}. To filter
8297 for tasks without effort definition, press @kbd{?} as the operator.
8299 Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the variable
8300 @code{org-agenda-auto-exclude-function} is set to a user-defined function,
8301 that function can decide which tags should be excluded from the agenda
8302 automatically. Once this is set, the @kbd{/} command then accepts @kbd{RET}
8303 as a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example, let's
8304 say you use a @code{Net} tag to identify tasks which need network access, an
8305 @code{Errand} tag for errands in town, and a @code{Call} tag for making phone
8306 calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the
8307 Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this:
8311 (defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
8313 ((string= tag "Net")
8314 (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
8315 "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
8316 ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
8317 (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
8318 (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
8321 (setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
8325 @orgcmd{\\,org-agenda-filter-by-tag-refine}
8326 Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
8327 prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
8328 the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
8329 @kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
8338 @item @r{in} search view
8339 add new search words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions
8340 (@kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will
8341 add a positive search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search
8342 term @i{must} occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a
8343 negative search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
8347 @tsubheading{Remote editing}
8348 @cindex remote editing, from agenda
8353 @cindex undoing remote-editing events
8354 @cindex remote editing, undo
8355 @orgcmd{C-_,org-agenda-undo}
8356 Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
8357 both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
8359 @orgcmd{t,org-agenda-todo}
8360 Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
8363 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{right},org-agenda-todo-nextset}
8364 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{left},org-agenda-todo-previousset}
8365 Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords.
8367 @orgcmd{C-k,org-agenda-kill}
8368 @vindex org-agenda-confirm-kill
8369 Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
8370 to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
8371 is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
8372 variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
8374 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-agenda-refile}
8375 Refile the entry at point.
8377 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-a,a,org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation}
8378 @vindex org-archive-default-command
8379 Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default
8380 archiving command set in @code{org-archive-default-command}. When using the
8381 @code{a} key, confirmation will be required.
8383 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag}
8384 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
8386 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling}
8387 Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{archive
8390 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,$,org-agenda-archive}
8391 Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
8392 entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
8395 @orgcmd{T,org-agenda-show-tags}
8396 @vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
8397 Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
8398 turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
8399 tags of a headline occasionally.
8401 @orgcmd{:,org-agenda-set-tags}
8402 Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
8403 agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
8407 Set the priority for the current item (@command{org-agenda-priority}).
8408 Org mode prompts for the priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC},
8409 the priority cookie is removed from the entry.
8411 @orgcmd{P,org-agenda-show-priority}
8412 Display weighted priority of current item.
8414 @orgcmdkkc{+,S-@key{up},org-agenda-priority-up}
8415 Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
8416 the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
8419 @orgcmdkkc{-,S-@key{down},org-agenda-priority-down}
8420 Decrease the priority of the current item.
8422 @orgcmdkkc{z,C-c C-z,org-agenda-add-note}
8423 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
8424 Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then filed to the
8425 same location where state change notes are put. Depending on
8426 @code{org-log-into-drawer}, this may be inside a drawer.
8428 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
8429 Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
8431 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-agenda-schedule}
8432 Schedule this item. With prefix arg remove the scheduling timestamp
8434 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-agenda-deadline}
8435 Set a deadline for this item. With prefix arg remove the deadline.
8437 @orgcmd{S-@key{right},org-agenda-do-date-later}
8438 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the
8439 future. If the date is in the past, the first call to this command will move
8441 With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For example,
8442 @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
8443 change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the command, it will
8444 continue to change hours even without the prefix arg. With a double @kbd{C-u
8445 C-u} prefix, do the same for changing minutes.@*
8446 The stamp is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly
8447 reflected in the agenda buffer. Use @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} to update the buffer.
8449 @orgcmd{S-@key{left},org-agenda-do-date-earlier}
8450 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
8453 @orgcmd{>,org-agenda-date-prompt}
8454 Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key @kbd{>} has
8455 been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.} on my keyboard.
8457 @orgcmd{I,org-agenda-clock-in}
8458 Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
8461 @orgcmd{O,org-agenda-clock-out}
8462 Stop the previously started clock.
8464 @orgcmd{X,org-agenda-clock-cancel}
8465 Cancel the currently running clock.
8467 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
8468 Jump to the running clock in another window.
8470 @orgcmd{k,org-agenda-capture}
8471 Like @code{org-capture}, but use the date at point as the default date for
8472 the capture template. See @var{org-capture-use-agenda-date} to make this
8473 the default behavior of @code{org-capture}.
8474 @cindex capturing, from agenda
8475 @vindex org-capture-use-agenda-date
8477 @tsubheading{Bulk remote editing selected entries}
8478 @cindex remote editing, bulk, from agenda
8479 @vindex org-agenda-bulk-persistent-marks
8480 @vindex org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions
8482 @orgcmd{m,org-agenda-bulk-mark}
8483 Mark the entry at point for bulk action. With prefix arg, mark that many
8486 @orgcmd{%,org-agenda-bulk-mark-regexp}
8487 Mark entries matching a regular expression for bulk action.
8489 @orgcmd{u,org-agenda-bulk-unmark}
8490 Unmark entry for bulk action.
8492 @orgcmd{U,org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks}
8493 Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
8495 @orgcmd{B,org-agenda-bulk-action}
8496 Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will prompt for
8497 another key to select the action to be applied. The prefix arg to @kbd{B}
8498 will be passed through to the @kbd{s} and @kbd{d} commands, to bulk-remove
8499 these special timestamps. By default, marks are removed after the bulk. If
8500 you want them to persist, set @code{org-agenda-bulk-persistent-marks} to
8501 @code{t} or hit @kbd{p} at the prompt.
8504 * @r{Toggle persistent marks.}
8505 $ @r{Archive all selected entries.}
8506 A @r{Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings.}
8507 t @r{Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and}
8508 @r{changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and}
8509 @r{suppressing logging notes (but not timestamps).}
8510 + @r{Add a tag to all selected entries.}
8511 - @r{Remove a tag from all selected entries.}
8512 s @r{Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates}
8513 @r{by a fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus}
8514 @r{at the prompt, for example @samp{++8d} or @samp{++2w}.}
8515 d @r{Set deadline to a specific date.}
8516 r @r{Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries}
8517 @r{will no longer be in the agenda; refresh (@kbd{g}) to bring them back.}
8518 S @r{Reschedule randomly into the coming N days. N will be prompted for.}
8519 @r{With prefix arg (@kbd{C-u B S}), scatter only across weekdays.}
8520 f @r{Apply a function@footnote{You can also create persistent custom functions through@code{org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions}.} to marked entries.}
8521 @r{For example, the function below sets the CATEGORY property of the}
8523 @r{(defun set-category ()}
8524 @r{ (interactive "P")}
8525 @r{ (let* ((marker (or (org-get-at-bol 'org-hd-marker)}
8526 @r{ (org-agenda-error)))}
8527 @r{ (buffer (marker-buffer marker)))}
8528 @r{ (with-current-buffer buffer}
8529 @r{ (save-excursion}
8530 @r{ (save-restriction}
8532 @r{ (goto-char marker)}
8533 @r{ (org-back-to-heading t)}
8534 @r{ (org-set-property "CATEGORY" "web"))))))}
8538 @tsubheading{Calendar commands}
8539 @cindex calendar commands, from agenda
8541 @orgcmd{c,org-agenda-goto-calendar}
8542 Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
8544 @orgcmd{c,org-calendar-goto-agenda}
8545 When in the calendar, compute and show the Org mode agenda for the
8548 @cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
8549 @orgcmd{i,org-agenda-diary-entry}
8550 @vindex org-agenda-diary-file
8551 Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor and (for
8552 block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to the Emacs diary
8553 file@footnote{This file is parsed for the agenda when
8554 @code{org-agenda-include-diary} is set.}, in a way similar to the @kbd{i}
8555 command in the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where
8556 you can add the entry.
8558 If you configure @code{org-agenda-diary-file} to point to an Org mode file,
8559 Org will create entries (in Org mode syntax) in that file instead. Most
8560 entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it
8561 easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree will be
8562 built under an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, or else with years as
8563 top-level entries. Emacs will prompt you for the entry text---if you specify
8564 it, the entry will be created in @code{org-agenda-diary-file} without further
8565 interaction. If you directly press @key{RET} at the prompt without typing
8566 text, the target file will be shown in another window for you to finish the
8567 entry there. See also the @kbd{k r} command.
8569 @orgcmd{M,org-agenda-phases-of-moon}
8570 Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
8572 @orgcmd{S,org-agenda-sunrise-sunset}
8573 Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
8574 with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar.
8576 @orgcmd{C,org-agenda-convert-date}
8577 Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
8580 @orgcmd{H,org-agenda-holidays}
8581 Show holidays for three months around the cursor date.
8583 @item M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
8584 Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
8585 This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
8587 @tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
8588 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-agenda-write}
8589 @cindex exporting agenda views
8590 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8591 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8592 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8593 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8594 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), PDF (extension @file{.pdf}),
8595 and plain text (any other extension). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix
8596 argument, immediately open the newly created file. Use the variable
8597 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8598 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
8600 @tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
8601 @orgcmd{q,org-agenda-quit}
8602 Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
8604 @cindex agenda files, removing buffers
8605 @orgcmd{x,org-agenda-exit}
8606 Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
8607 for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
8608 visit Org files will not be removed.
8612 @node Custom agenda views, Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
8613 @section Custom agenda views
8614 @cindex custom agenda views
8615 @cindex agenda views, custom
8617 Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
8618 frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
8619 agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
8620 dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
8623 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
8624 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
8625 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
8628 @node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
8629 @subsection Storing searches
8631 The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
8632 shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
8633 buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
8636 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8638 Custom commands are configured in the variable
8639 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
8640 example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with Emacs
8641 Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid search
8646 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8647 '(("w" todo "WAITING")
8648 ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
8649 ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
8650 ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
8651 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
8652 ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
8653 ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
8654 ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
8655 ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
8656 ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
8661 The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
8662 after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
8663 Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
8664 similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
8665 first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
8666 prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
8667 inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
8668 parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
8669 expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
8674 as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
8677 as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
8678 results as a sparse tree
8680 as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
8683 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
8684 headlines that are also TODO items
8686 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
8687 displaying the result as a sparse tree
8689 to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
8690 containing the word @samp{FIXME}
8692 as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
8693 additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
8694 Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
8697 @node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
8698 @subsection Block agenda
8699 @cindex block agenda
8700 @cindex agenda, with block views
8702 Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
8703 the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
8704 the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
8705 daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
8706 for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
8707 matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
8708 @code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
8712 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8713 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8717 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8725 This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
8726 you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
8727 your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
8728 @samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
8729 command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
8731 @node Setting Options, , Block agenda, Custom agenda views
8732 @subsection Setting options for custom commands
8733 @cindex options, for custom agenda views
8735 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8736 Org mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
8737 and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
8738 commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
8739 some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
8740 options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
8741 right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
8745 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8746 '(("w" todo "WAITING"
8747 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
8748 (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
8749 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
8750 ((org-show-following-heading nil)
8751 (org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
8753 ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
8754 (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
8759 Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
8760 priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
8761 instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
8762 @kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
8763 headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
8764 will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
8765 to only a single file.
8767 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8768 For command sets creating a block agenda,
8769 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
8770 options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
8771 command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
8772 the set. The former are just added to the command entry; the latter
8773 must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
8774 agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
8775 for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
8776 the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
8777 @code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
8781 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8782 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8786 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
8787 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
8788 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8795 As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
8796 When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it
8797 fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in
8798 this interface, the @emph{values} are just Lisp expressions. So if the
8799 value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
8802 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
8803 To control whether an agenda command should be accessible from a specific
8804 context, you can customize @var{org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts}. Let's
8805 say for example that you have an agenda commands @code{"o"} displaying a view
8806 that you only need when reading emails. Then you would configure this option
8810 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
8811 '(("o" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
8814 You can also tell that the command key @code{"o"} should refer to another
8815 command key @code{"r"}. In that case, add this command key like this:
8818 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
8819 '(("o" "r" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
8822 See the docstring of the variable for more information.
8824 @node Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda column view, Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
8825 @section Exporting Agenda Views
8826 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8828 If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed
8829 version of some agenda views to carry around. Org mode can export custom
8830 agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's
8831 @file{htmlize.el}.}, Postscript, PDF@footnote{To create PDF output, the
8832 ghostscript @file{ps2pdf} utility must be installed on the system. Selecting
8833 a PDF file will also create the postscript file.}, and iCalendar files. If
8834 you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
8837 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-agenda-write}
8838 @cindex exporting agenda views
8839 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8840 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8841 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8842 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8843 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), iCalendar (extension
8844 @file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
8845 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8846 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export, for example
8848 @vindex org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines
8849 @vindex htmlize-output-type
8850 @vindex ps-number-of-columns
8851 @vindex ps-landscape-mode
8853 (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
8854 '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8855 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8856 (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
8857 (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
8861 If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
8862 any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
8863 @footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
8864 or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
8865 them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
8866 that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global
8867 TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
8868 Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
8869 as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
8874 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8875 '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
8876 ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
8877 ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8882 ("~/views/home.html"))
8883 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8888 ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
8892 The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
8893 @file{.html}, Org mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
8894 the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
8895 @file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
8896 Postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
8897 run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
8898 limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other
8899 extension produces a plain ASCII file.
8901 The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
8902 commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
8903 Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
8907 @orgcmd{C-c a e,org-store-agenda-views}
8908 Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
8912 You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
8913 set options for the export commands. For example:
8916 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8918 ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8919 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8920 (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
8921 (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
8922 (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
8927 This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
8928 print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be cut
8929 in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
8930 the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
8931 instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
8932 to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
8933 black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
8934 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
8935 in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
8938 From the command line you may also use
8940 emacs -eval (org-batch-store-agenda-views) -kill
8943 or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting depends on the
8944 system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.}
8946 emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
8947 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
8948 org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
8949 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
8950 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
8954 which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
8955 @file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with a 30-day
8958 You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
8959 processing by other programs. See @ref{Extracting agenda information}, for
8963 @node Agenda column view, , Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda Views
8964 @section Using column view in the agenda
8965 @cindex column view, in agenda
8966 @cindex agenda, column view
8968 Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
8969 properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
8970 quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
8971 collected by certain criteria.
8974 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8975 Turn on column view in the agenda.
8978 To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
8979 entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
8980 This causes the following issues:
8984 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8985 @vindex org-overriding-columns-format
8986 Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
8987 entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
8988 may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
8989 Org first checks if the variable @code{org-agenda-overriding-columns-format} is
8990 currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
8991 the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
8992 does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in its file), it
8993 uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
8995 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
8996 If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
8997 turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
8998 make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
8999 also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
9000 values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
9001 cover a single day; in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
9002 vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
9003 example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
9004 same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and its @emph{child}). In these
9005 cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
9006 some values will count double.
9008 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
9009 the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
9010 the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
9011 current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
9012 a column listing the planned total effort for a task---one of the major
9013 applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
9014 clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
9018 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM_T
9019 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM_T}, that is
9020 always today's clocked time for this item. So even in the weekly agenda,
9021 the clocksum listed in column view only originates from today. This lets
9022 you compare the time you spent on a task for today, with the time already
9023 spent (via @code{CLOCKSUM}) and with the planned total effort for it.
9027 @node Markup, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
9028 @chapter Markup for rich export
9030 When exporting Org mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
9031 structure of the document as accurately as possible in the backend. Since
9032 export targets like HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook allow much richer formatting,
9033 Org mode has rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This section
9034 summarizes the markup rules used in an Org mode buffer.
9037 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
9038 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
9039 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
9040 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
9041 * Index entries:: Making an index
9042 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
9043 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
9046 @node Structural markup elements, Images and tables, Markup, Markup
9047 @section Structural markup elements
9050 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
9051 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
9052 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
9053 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
9055 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
9056 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
9057 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
9058 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
9059 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
9062 @node Document title, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements, Structural markup elements
9063 @subheading Document title
9064 @cindex document title, markup rules
9067 The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
9071 #+TITLE: This is the title of the document
9075 If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first non-empty,
9076 non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or if you have
9077 turned off exporting of the text before the first headline (see below), the
9078 title will be the file name without extension.
9080 @cindex property, EXPORT_TITLE
9081 If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the heading
9082 of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the subtree has a
9083 property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take precedence.
9085 @node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Structural markup elements
9086 @subheading Headings and sections
9087 @cindex headings and sections, markup rules
9089 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
9090 The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
9091 Structure}, forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
9092 However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
9093 tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
9094 levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
9095 switch globally by setting the variable @code{org-export-headline-levels}, or on a
9096 per-file basis with a line
9103 @node Table of contents, Initial text, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements
9104 @subheading Table of contents
9105 @cindex table of contents, markup rules
9107 @vindex org-export-with-toc
9108 The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
9109 of the file. If you would like to get it to a different location, insert the
9110 string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by itself at the desired
9111 location. The depth of the table of contents is by default the same as the
9112 number of headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number, or turn off
9113 the table of contents entirely, by configuring the variable
9114 @code{org-export-with-toc}, or on a per-file basis with a line like
9117 #+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
9118 #+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
9121 @node Initial text, Lists, Table of contents, Structural markup elements
9122 @subheading Text before the first headline
9123 @cindex text before first headline, markup rules
9126 Org mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even uses
9127 the first line as the document title. The text will be fully marked up. If
9128 you need to include literal HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook code, use the special
9129 constructs described below in the sections for the individual exporters.
9131 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
9132 Some people like to use the space before the first headline for setup and
9133 internal links and therefore would like to control the exported text before
9134 the first headline in a different way. You can do so by setting the variable
9135 @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{t}. On a per-file
9136 basis, you can get the same effect with @samp{#+OPTIONS: skip:t}.
9139 If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
9140 @code{#+TEXT} construct:
9144 #+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
9145 #+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
9146 #+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the *first* headline
9149 @node Lists, Paragraphs, Initial text, Structural markup elements
9151 @cindex lists, markup rules
9153 Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists}, are translated to the backend's
9154 syntax for such lists. Most backends support unordered, ordered, and
9157 @node Paragraphs, Footnote markup, Lists, Structural markup elements
9158 @subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
9159 @cindex paragraphs, markup rules
9161 Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
9162 a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
9164 To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
9165 can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
9167 @cindex #+BEGIN_VERSE
9170 Great clouds overhead
9171 Tiny black birds rise and fall
9178 When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
9179 as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
9180 can include quotations in Org mode documents like this:
9182 @cindex #+BEGIN_QUOTE
9185 Everything should be made as simple as possible,
9186 but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
9190 If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
9191 @cindex #+BEGIN_CENTER
9194 Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
9200 @node Footnote markup, Emphasis and monospace, Paragraphs, Structural markup elements
9201 @subheading Footnote markup
9202 @cindex footnotes, markup rules
9203 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
9205 Footnotes defined in the way described in @ref{Footnotes}, will be exported
9206 by all backends. Org allows multiple references to the same note, and
9207 multiple footnotes side by side.
9209 @node Emphasis and monospace, Horizontal rules, Footnote markup, Structural markup elements
9210 @subheading Emphasis and monospace
9212 @cindex underlined text, markup rules
9213 @cindex bold text, markup rules
9214 @cindex italic text, markup rules
9215 @cindex verbatim text, markup rules
9216 @cindex code text, markup rules
9217 @cindex strike-through text, markup rules
9218 You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
9219 and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
9220 in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org mode specific
9221 syntax; it is exported verbatim.
9223 @node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, Emphasis and monospace, Structural markup elements
9224 @subheading Horizontal rules
9225 @cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
9226 A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be exported as
9227 a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML and @code{\hrule} in @LaTeX{}).
9229 @node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Structural markup elements
9230 @subheading Comment lines
9231 @cindex comment lines
9232 @cindex exporting, not
9233 @cindex #+BEGIN_COMMENT
9235 Lines starting with zero or more whitespace characters followed by @samp{#}
9236 are treated as comments and will never be exported. Also entire subtrees
9237 starting with the word @samp{COMMENT} will never be exported. Finally,
9238 regions surrounded by @samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT} ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will
9244 Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
9248 @node Images and tables, Literal examples, Structural markup elements, Markup
9249 @section Images and Tables
9251 @cindex tables, markup rules
9254 Both the native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
9255 the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org mode tables,
9256 the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
9257 lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign
9258 a caption and a label for cross references, and in the text you can refer to
9259 the object with @code{\ref@{tab:basic-data@}}:
9262 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
9263 #+LABEL: tab:basic-data
9268 Optionally, the caption can take the form:
9270 #+CAPTION: [Caption for list of figures]@{Caption for table (or link).@}
9273 @cindex inlined images, markup rules
9274 Some backends (HTML, @LaTeX{}, and DocBook) allow you to directly include
9275 images into the exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image
9276 files does not have a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}.
9277 If you wish to define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal
9278 cross references, make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede
9279 it with @code{#+CAPTION} and @code{#+LABEL} as follows:
9282 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
9283 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
9287 You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
9288 backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for more
9291 @xref{Handling links,the discussion of image links}.
9293 @node Literal examples, Include files, Images and tables, Markup
9294 @section Literal examples
9295 @cindex literal examples, markup rules
9296 @cindex code line references, markup rules
9298 You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
9299 markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
9300 for source code and similar examples.
9301 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
9305 Some example from a text file.
9309 Note that such blocks may be @i{indented} in order to align nicely with
9310 indented text and in particular with plain list structure (@pxref{Plain
9311 lists}). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the
9312 example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
9313 whitespace before the colon:
9317 : Some example from a text file.
9320 @cindex formatting source code, markup rules
9321 If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
9322 that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
9323 look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{This works automatically for
9324 the HTML backend (it requires version 1.34 of the @file{htmlize.el} package,
9325 which is distributed with Org). Fontified code chunks in @LaTeX{} can be
9326 achieved using either the listings or the
9327 @url{http://code.google.com/p/minted, minted,} package. Refer to
9328 @code{org-export-latex-listings} documentation for details.}. This is done
9329 with the @samp{src} block, where you also need to specify the name of the
9330 major mode that should be used to fontify the example@footnote{Code in
9331 @samp{src} blocks may also be evaluated either interactively or on export.
9332 See @pxref{Working With Source Code} for more information on evaluating code
9333 blocks.}, see @ref{Easy Templates} for shortcuts to easily insert code
9338 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
9339 (defun org-xor (a b)
9345 Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
9346 switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
9347 numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
9348 numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
9349 Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as
9350 targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]} (i.e.@: the reference name
9351 enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a
9352 link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of
9355 You can also add a @code{-r} switch which @i{removes} the labels from the
9356 source code@footnote{Adding @code{-k} to @code{-n -r} will @i{keep} the
9357 labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might
9358 be useful to explain those in an Org mode example code.}. With the @code{-n}
9359 switch, links to these references will be labeled by the line numbers from
9360 the code listing, otherwise links will use the labels with no parentheses.
9364 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
9365 (save-excursion (ref:sc)
9366 (goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
9368 In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
9372 @vindex org-coderef-label-format
9373 If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
9374 @code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
9375 -n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
9377 HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas (@pxref{Text
9378 areas in HTML export}).
9380 Because the @code{#+BEGIN_...} and @code{#+END_...} patterns need to be added
9381 so often, shortcuts are provided using the Easy Templates facility
9382 (@pxref{Easy Templates}).
9387 Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
9388 switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by
9389 pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon exit, lines starting with @samp{*}
9390 or @samp{#} will get a comma prepended, to keep them from being interpreted
9391 by Org as outline nodes or special comments. These commas will be stripped
9392 for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and also for export.}. The edited version will
9393 then replace the old version in the Org buffer. Fixed-width regions
9394 (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space) will be edited
9395 using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select a different-mode with the
9396 variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.} to allow creating ASCII
9397 drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line will create a new
9401 Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
9402 temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label. Make sure
9403 that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
9404 formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
9405 label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
9409 @node Include files, Index entries, Literal examples, Markup
9410 @section Include files
9411 @cindex include files, markup rules
9413 During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
9414 include your @file{.emacs} file, you could use:
9418 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
9421 The optional second and third parameter are the markup (e.g.@: @samp{quote},
9422 @samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
9423 language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional; if it is not
9424 given, the text will be assumed to be in Org mode format and will be
9425 processed normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
9426 parameters @code{:prefix1} and @code{:prefix} to specify prefixes for the
9427 first line and for each following line, @code{:minlevel} in order to get
9428 Org mode content demoted to a specified level, as well as any options
9429 accepted by the selected markup. For example, to include a file as an item,
9433 #+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
9436 You can also include a portion of a file by specifying a lines range using
9437 the @code{:lines} parameter. The line at the upper end of the range will not
9438 be included. The start and/or the end of the range may be omitted to use the
9442 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "5-10" @r{Include lines 5 to 10, 10 excluded}
9443 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "-10" @r{Include lines 1 to 10, 10 excluded}
9444 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "10-" @r{Include lines from 10 to EOF}
9450 Visit the include file at point.
9453 @node Index entries, Macro replacement, Include files, Markup
9454 @section Index entries
9455 @cindex index entries, for publishing
9457 You can specify entries that will be used for generating an index during
9458 publishing. This is done by lines starting with @code{#+INDEX}. An entry
9459 the contains an exclamation mark will create a sub item. See @ref{Generating
9460 an index} for more information.
9465 #+INDEX: Application!CV
9471 @node Macro replacement, Embedded @LaTeX{}, Index entries, Markup
9472 @section Macro replacement
9473 @cindex macro replacement, during export
9476 You can define text snippets with
9479 #+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments
9482 @noindent which can be referenced anywhere in the document (even in
9483 code examples) with @code{@{@{@{name(arg1,arg2)@}@}@}}. In addition to
9484 defined macros, @code{@{@{@{title@}@}@}}, @code{@{@{@{author@}@}@}}, etc.,
9485 will reference information set by the @code{#+TITLE:}, @code{#+AUTHOR:}, and
9486 similar lines. Also, @code{@{@{@{date(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} and
9487 @code{@{@{@{modification-time(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} refer to current date time
9488 and to the modification time of the file being exported, respectively.
9489 @var{FORMAT} should be a format string understood by
9490 @code{format-time-string}.
9492 Macro expansion takes place during export, and some people use it to
9493 construct complex HTML code.
9496 @node Embedded @LaTeX{}, , Macro replacement, Markup
9497 @section Embedded @LaTeX{}
9498 @cindex @TeX{} interpretation
9499 @cindex @LaTeX{} interpretation
9501 Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. Exceptions
9502 include scientific notes, which often require mathematical symbols and the
9503 occasional formula. @LaTeX{}@footnote{@LaTeX{} is a macro system based on
9504 Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the features described here as
9505 ``@LaTeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for simplicity I am blurring this
9506 distinction.} is widely used to typeset scientific documents. Org mode
9507 supports embedding @LaTeX{} code into its files, because many academics are
9508 used to writing and reading @LaTeX{} source code, and because it can be
9509 readily processed to produce pretty output for a number of export backends.
9512 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
9513 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
9514 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
9515 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
9516 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
9519 @node Special symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded @LaTeX{}, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9520 @subsection Special symbols
9521 @cindex math symbols
9522 @cindex special symbols
9523 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9524 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, markup rules
9525 @cindex HTML entities
9526 @cindex @LaTeX{} entities
9528 You can use @LaTeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha} to
9529 indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. Completion
9530 for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a few letters,
9531 and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. Unlike @LaTeX{}
9532 code, Org mode allows these macros to be present without surrounding math
9533 delimiters, for example:
9536 Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
9539 @vindex org-entities
9540 During export, these symbols will be transformed into the native format of
9541 the exporter backend. Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as
9542 @code{α} in the HTML output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the @LaTeX{}
9543 output. Similarly, @code{\nbsp} will become @code{ } in HTML and
9544 @code{~} in @LaTeX{}. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it
9545 like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
9547 A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and
9548 @LaTeX{}; see the variable @code{org-entities} for the complete list.
9549 @samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
9550 @samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
9551 different lengths or a compact set of dots.
9553 If you would like to see entities displayed as UTF8 characters, use the
9554 following command@footnote{You can turn this on by default by setting the
9555 variable @code{org-pretty-entities}, or on a per-file base with the
9556 @code{#+STARTUP} option @code{entitiespretty}.}:
9561 Toggle display of entities as UTF-8 characters. This does not change the
9562 buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it overlays the UTF-8 character
9563 for display purposes only.
9566 @node Subscripts and superscripts, @LaTeX{} fragments, Special symbols, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9567 @subsection Subscripts and superscripts
9571 Just like in @LaTeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super-
9572 and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
9573 math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
9574 not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
9575 with curly braces. For example
9578 The mass of the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
9579 the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
9582 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
9583 To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote @samp{^} and
9584 @samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\^} and @samp{\_}. If you write a text
9585 where the underscore is often used in a different context, Org's convention
9586 to always interpret these as subscripts can get in your way. Configure the
9587 variable @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts} to globally change this
9588 convention, or use, on a per-file basis:
9594 @noindent With this setting, @samp{a_b} will not be interpreted as a
9595 subscript, but @samp{a_@{b@}} will.
9600 In addition to showing entities as UTF-8 characters, this command will also
9601 format sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way.
9604 @node @LaTeX{} fragments, Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9605 @subsection @LaTeX{} fragments
9606 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9608 @vindex org-format-latex-header
9609 Going beyond symbols and sub- and superscripts, a full formula language is
9610 needed. Org mode can contain @LaTeX{} math fragments, and it supports ways
9611 to process these for several export backends. When exporting to @LaTeX{},
9612 the code is obviously left as it is. When exporting to HTML, Org invokes the
9613 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax library} (@pxref{Math formatting in
9614 HTML export}) to process and display the math@footnote{If you plan to use
9615 this regularly or on pages with significant page views, you should install
9616 @file{MathJax} on your own
9617 server in order to limit the load of our server.}. Finally, it can also
9618 process the mathematical expressions into images@footnote{For this to work
9619 you need to be on a system with a working @LaTeX{} installation. You also
9620 need the @file{dvipng} program or the @file{convert}, respectively available
9621 at @url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/} and from the
9622 @file{imagemagick} suite. The @LaTeX{} header that will be used when
9623 processing a fragment can be configured with the variable
9624 @code{org-format-latex-header}.} that can be displayed in a browser or in
9627 @LaTeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
9628 snippets will be identified as @LaTeX{} source code:
9631 Environments of any kind@footnote{When @file{MathJax} is used, only the
9632 environment recognized by @file{MathJax} will be processed. When
9633 @file{dvipng} is used to create images, any @LaTeX{} environments will be
9634 handled.}. The only requirement is that the @code{\begin} statement appears
9635 on a new line, preceded by only whitespace.
9637 Text within the usual @LaTeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
9638 currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
9639 math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
9640 directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
9641 and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash.
9642 For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use
9643 @samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
9646 @noindent For example:
9649 \begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments,
9650 x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures
9651 \end@{equation@} % etc
9653 If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
9654 either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
9658 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9659 If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
9660 can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
9661 ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the @LaTeX{} converter.
9663 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
9664 @LaTeX{} processing can be configured with the variable
9665 @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}. The default setting is @code{t}
9666 which means @file{MathJax} for HTML, and no processing for DocBook, ASCII and
9667 @LaTeX{} backends. You can also set this variable on a per-file basis using one
9671 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:t @r{Do the right thing automatically (MathJax)}
9672 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng @r{Force using dvipng images}
9673 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:nil @r{Do not process @LaTeX{} fragments at all}
9674 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:verbatim @r{Verbatim export, for jsMath or so}
9677 @node Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, CDLaTeX mode, @LaTeX{} fragments, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9678 @subsection Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments
9679 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, preview
9681 If you have @file{dvipng} installed, @LaTeX{} fragments can be processed to
9682 produce preview images of the typeset expressions:
9687 Produce a preview image of the @LaTeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
9688 over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
9689 fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
9690 with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
9691 two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
9692 process the entire buffer.
9695 Remove the overlay preview images.
9698 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9699 You can customize the variable @code{org-format-latex-options} to influence
9700 some aspects of the preview. In particular, the @code{:scale} (and for HTML
9701 export, @code{:html-scale}) property can be used to adjust the size of the
9704 @node CDLaTeX mode, , Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9705 @subsection Using CD@LaTeX{} to enter math
9708 CD@LaTeX{} mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
9709 major @LaTeX{} mode like AUC@TeX{} in order to speed-up insertion of
9710 environments and math templates. Inside Org mode, you can make use of
9711 some of the features of CD@LaTeX{} mode. You need to install
9712 @file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
9713 AUC@TeX{}) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
9714 Don't use CD@LaTeX{} mode itself under Org mode, but use the light
9715 version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org mode. Turn it
9716 on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all
9720 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
9723 When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
9724 details see the documentation of CD@LaTeX{} mode):
9728 Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
9731 The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
9732 @LaTeX{} fragment@footnote{Org mode has a method to test if the cursor is
9733 inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
9734 @code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
9735 expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
9736 correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
9737 the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
9738 environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
9739 you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
9740 this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
9741 To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}.
9745 @vindex cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts
9746 Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a @LaTeX{} fragment will insert these
9747 characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
9748 out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
9749 macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
9750 @code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
9753 Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
9754 macros, also outside @LaTeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
9755 after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
9758 Pressing the single-quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
9759 the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
9760 1.5 seconds after the single-quote, a help window will pop up. Character
9761 modification will work only inside @LaTeX{} fragments; outside the quote
9765 @node Exporting, Publishing, Markup, Top
9769 Org mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
9770 printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and simple
9771 version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a notes file on
9772 the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for exchange with a
9773 broad range of other applications. @LaTeX{} export lets you use Org mode and
9774 its structured editing functions to easily create @LaTeX{} files. DocBook
9775 export makes it possible to convert Org files to many other formats using
9776 DocBook tools. OpenDocument Text (ODT) export allows seamless
9777 collaboration across organizational boundaries. For project management you
9778 can create gantt and resource charts by using TaskJuggler export. To
9779 incorporate entries with associated times like deadlines or appointments into
9780 a desktop calendar program like iCal, Org mode can also produce extracts in
9781 the iCalendar format. Currently, Org mode only supports export, not import of
9782 these different formats.
9784 Org supports export of selected regions when @code{transient-mark-mode} is
9785 enabled (default in Emacs 23).
9788 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
9789 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
9790 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
9791 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
9792 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
9793 * @LaTeX{} and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
9794 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
9795 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
9796 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
9797 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
9798 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
9799 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
9802 @node Selective export, Export options, Exporting, Exporting
9803 @section Selective export
9804 @cindex export, selective by tags or TODO keyword
9806 @vindex org-export-select-tags
9807 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
9808 @cindex org-export-with-tasks
9809 You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be exported,
9810 or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed by two variables:
9811 @code{org-export-select-tags} and @code{org-export-exclude-tags},
9812 respectively defaulting to @code{'(:export:)} and @code{'(:noexport:)}.
9816 Org first checks if any of the @emph{select} tags is present in the
9817 buffer. If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be
9818 excluded. If a selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above it
9819 will also be selected for export, but not the text below those headings.
9822 If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected for
9826 Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the @emph{exclude} tags will
9827 be removed from the export buffer.
9830 The variable @code{org-export-with-tasks} can be configured to select which
9831 kind of tasks should be included for export. See the docstring of the
9832 variable for more information.
9834 @node Export options, The export dispatcher, Selective export, Exporting
9835 @section Export options
9836 @cindex options, for export
9838 @cindex completion, of option keywords
9839 The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
9840 additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
9841 The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c
9842 C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
9843 correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion
9844 (@pxref{Completion}). For a summary of other in-buffer settings not
9845 specifically related to export, see @ref{In-buffer settings}.
9846 In particular, note that you can place commonly-used (export) options in
9847 a separate file which can be included using @code{#+SETUPFILE}.
9850 @orgcmd{C-c C-e t,org-insert-export-options-template}
9851 Insert template with export options, see example below.
9858 @cindex #+DESCRIPTION
9866 @cindex #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS
9867 @cindex #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS
9869 @cindex #+LaTeX_HEADER
9870 @vindex user-full-name
9871 @vindex user-mail-address
9872 @vindex org-export-default-language
9873 @vindex org-export-date-timestamp-format
9875 #+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
9876 #+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name})
9877 #+DATE: a date, an Org timestamp@footnote{@code{org-export-date-timestamp-format} defines how this timestamp will be exported.}, or a format string for @code{format-time-string}
9878 #+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address})
9879 #+DESCRIPTION: the page description, e.g.@: for the XHTML meta tag
9880 #+KEYWORDS: the page keywords, e.g.@: for the XHTML meta tag
9881 #+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g.@: @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language})
9882 #+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
9883 #+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
9884 #+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
9885 #+BIND: lisp-var lisp-val, e.g.@:: @code{org-export-latex-low-levels itemize}
9886 @r{You need to confirm using these, or configure @code{org-export-allow-BIND}}
9887 #+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
9888 #+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
9889 #+LaTeX_HEADER: extra line(s) for the @LaTeX{} header, like \usepackage@{xyz@}
9890 #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
9891 #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
9892 #+XSLT: the XSLT stylesheet used by DocBook exporter to generate FO file
9896 The @code{#+OPTIONS} line is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure many options
9897 this way, you can use several @code{#+OPTIONS} lines.} form to specify export
9898 settings. Here you can:
9899 @cindex headline levels
9900 @cindex section-numbers
9901 @cindex table of contents
9902 @cindex line-break preservation
9903 @cindex quoted HTML tags
9904 @cindex fixed-width sections
9906 @cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts
9908 @cindex special strings
9909 @cindex emphasized text
9910 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9911 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9912 @cindex author info, in export
9913 @cindex time info, in export
9914 @vindex org-export-plist-vars
9915 @vindex org-export-author-info
9916 @vindex org-export-creator-info
9917 @vindex org-export-email-info
9918 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
9920 H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export}
9921 num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers}
9922 toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)}
9923 \n: @r{turn on/off line-break-preservation (DOES NOT WORK)}
9924 @@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags}
9925 :: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections}
9926 |: @r{turn on/off tables}
9927 ^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If}
9928 @r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but}
9929 @r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.}
9930 -: @r{turn on/off conversion of special strings.}
9931 f: @r{turn on/off footnotes like this[1].}
9932 todo: @r{turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text}
9933 tasks: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tasks (TODO items), can be nil to remove}
9934 @r{all tasks, @code{todo} to remove DONE tasks, or list of kwds to keep}
9935 pri: @r{turn on/off priority cookies}
9936 tags: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}}
9937 <: @r{turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES}
9938 *: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)}
9939 TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text}
9940 LaTeX: @r{configure export of @LaTeX{} fragments. Default @code{auto}}
9941 skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading}
9942 author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file}
9943 email: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author email into exported file}
9944 creator: @r{turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file}
9945 timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file}
9946 d: @r{turn on/off inclusion of drawers, or list drawers to include}
9949 These options take effect in both the HTML and @LaTeX{} export, except for
9950 @code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX} options, which are respectively @code{t} and
9951 @code{nil} for the @LaTeX{} export.
9953 The default values for these and many other options are given by a set of
9954 variables. For a list of such variables, the corresponding OPTIONS keys and
9955 also the publishing keys (@pxref{Project alist}), see the constant
9956 @code{org-export-plist-vars}.
9958 When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with @kbd{C-c @@} before
9959 calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the file's export
9960 settings with properties @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, @code{EXPORT_TITLE},
9961 @code{EXPORT_TEXT}, @code{EXPORT_AUTHOR}, @code{EXPORT_DATE}, and
9962 @code{EXPORT_OPTIONS}.
9964 @node The export dispatcher, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Export options, Exporting
9965 @section The export dispatcher
9966 @cindex dispatcher, for export commands
9968 All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which is a
9969 prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the command.
9970 Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an active region that
9971 contains one outline tree, the first heading is used as document title and
9972 the subtrees are exported.
9975 @orgcmd{C-c C-e,org-export}
9976 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9977 Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window
9978 listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing
9979 command. The prefix arg is passed through to the exporter. A double prefix
9980 @kbd{C-u C-u} causes most commands to be executed in the background, in a
9981 separate Emacs process@footnote{To make this behavior the default, customize
9982 the variable @code{org-export-run-in-background}.}.
9983 @orgcmd{C-c C-e v,org-export-visible}
9984 Like @kbd{C-c C-e}, but only export the text that is currently visible
9985 (i.e.@: not hidden by outline visibility).
9986 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-e,org-export}
9987 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9988 Call the exporter, but reverse the setting of
9989 @code{org-export-run-in-background}, i.e.@: request background processing if
9990 not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if set.
9993 @node ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, HTML export, The export dispatcher, Exporting
9994 @section ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export
9995 @cindex ASCII export
9996 @cindex Latin-1 export
9997 @cindex UTF-8 export
9999 ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org mode
10000 file, containing only plain ASCII. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export augment the file
10001 with special characters and symbols available in these encodings.
10003 @cindex region, active
10004 @cindex active region
10005 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10007 @orgcmd{C-c C-e a,org-export-as-ascii}
10008 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10009 Export as an ASCII file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
10010 will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without
10011 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10012 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10013 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10014 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will
10015 become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an
10016 @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
10018 @orgcmd{C-c C-e A,org-export-as-ascii-to-buffer}
10019 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10020 @orgcmd{C-c C-e n,org-export-as-latin1}
10021 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e N,org-export-as-latin1-to-buffer}
10022 Like the above commands, but use Latin-1 encoding.
10023 @orgcmd{C-c C-e u,org-export-as-utf8}
10024 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e U,org-export-as-utf8-to-buffer}
10025 Like the above commands, but use UTF-8 encoding.
10026 @item C-c C-e v a/n/u
10027 Export only the visible part of the document.
10030 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10031 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
10032 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
10033 will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur
10034 at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example,
10037 @kbd{C-1 C-c C-e a}
10041 creates only top level headlines and exports the rest as items. When
10042 headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
10043 the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
10044 the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation of
10045 the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve
10046 the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less
10047 indentation than the first one, these are left alone.
10049 @vindex org-export-ascii-links-to-notes
10050 Links will be exported in a footnote-like style, with the descriptive part in
10051 the text and the link in a note before the next heading. See the variable
10052 @code{org-export-ascii-links-to-notes} for details and other options.
10054 @node HTML export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Exporting
10055 @section HTML export
10056 @cindex HTML export
10058 Org mode contains a HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
10059 HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
10060 language, but with additional support for tables.
10063 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
10064 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
10065 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
10066 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
10067 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
10068 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
10069 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
10070 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
10071 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
10072 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
10075 @node HTML Export commands, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML export, HTML export
10076 @subsection HTML export commands
10078 @cindex region, active
10079 @cindex active region
10080 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10082 @orgcmd{C-c C-e h,org-export-as-html}
10083 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10084 Export as a HTML file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org},
10085 the HTML file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
10086 without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10087 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10088 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10089 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10090 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10091 property, that name will be used for the export.
10092 @orgcmd{C-c C-e b,org-export-as-html-and-open}
10093 Export as a HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
10094 @orgcmd{C-c C-e H,org-export-as-html-to-buffer}
10095 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10096 @orgcmd{C-c C-e R,org-export-region-as-html}
10097 Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix argument, do
10098 not produce the file header and footer, but just the plain HTML section for
10099 the region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations.
10100 @item C-c C-e v h/b/H/R
10101 Export only the visible part of the document.
10102 @item M-x org-export-region-as-html
10103 Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was in Org mode
10104 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
10106 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML
10107 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by HTML
10111 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10112 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
10113 defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
10114 itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
10115 specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
10118 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e b}
10122 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
10125 @node HTML preamble and postamble, Quoting HTML tags, HTML Export commands, HTML export
10126 @subsection HTML preamble and postamble
10127 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
10128 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
10129 @vindex org-export-html-preamble-format
10130 @vindex org-export-html-postamble-format
10131 @vindex org-export-html-validation-link
10132 @vindex org-export-author-info
10133 @vindex org-export-email-info
10134 @vindex org-export-creator-info
10135 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
10137 The HTML exporter lets you define a preamble and a postamble.
10139 The default value for @code{org-export-html-preamble} is @code{t}, which
10140 means that the preamble is inserted depending on the relevant format string
10141 in @code{org-export-html-preamble-format}.
10143 Setting @code{org-export-html-preamble} to a string will override the default
10144 format string. Setting it to a function, will insert the output of the
10145 function, which must be a string; such a function takes no argument but you
10146 can check against the value of @code{opt-plist}, which contains the list of
10147 publishing properties for the current file. Setting to @code{nil} will not
10148 insert any preamble.
10150 The default value for @code{org-export-html-postamble} is @code{'auto}, which
10151 means that the HTML exporter will look for the value of
10152 @code{org-export-author-info}, @code{org-export-email-info},
10153 @code{org-export-creator-info} and @code{org-export-time-stamp-file},
10154 @code{org-export-html-validation-link} and build the postamble from these
10155 values. Setting @code{org-export-html-postamble} to @code{t} will insert the
10156 postamble from the relevant format string found in
10157 @code{org-export-html-postamble-format}. Setting it to @code{nil} will not
10158 insert any postamble.
10160 @node Quoting HTML tags, Links in HTML export, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML export
10161 @subsection Quoting HTML tags
10163 Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{<} and
10164 @samp{>} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags
10165 which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in
10166 @samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for
10167 simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to
10168 the exported file use either
10171 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
10173 #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
10177 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
10181 All lines between these markers are exported literally
10186 @node Links in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
10187 @subsection Links in HTML export
10189 @cindex links, in HTML export
10190 @cindex internal links, in HTML export
10191 @cindex external links, in HTML export
10192 Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML. This
10193 includes automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
10194 targets}). Links to external files will still work if the target file is on
10195 the same @i{relative} path as the published Org file. Links to other
10196 @file{.org} files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
10197 that a HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same relative
10198 path. @samp{id:} links can then be used to jump to specific entries across
10199 files. For information related to linking files while publishing them to a
10200 publishing directory see @ref{Publishing links}.
10202 If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
10203 @code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that will be added to the
10204 @code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{title}
10205 and @code{style} attributes for a link:
10207 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10209 #+ATTR_HTML: title="The Org mode homepage" style="color:red;"
10210 [[http://orgmode.org]]
10213 @node Tables in HTML export, Images in HTML export, Links in HTML export, HTML export
10215 @cindex tables, in HTML
10216 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
10218 Org mode tables are exported to HTML using the table tag defined in
10219 @code{org-export-html-table-tag}. The default setting makes tables without
10220 cell borders and frame. If you would like to change this for individual
10221 tables, place something like the following before the table:
10224 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10226 #+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
10227 #+ATTR_HTML: border="2" rules="all" frame="border"
10230 @node Images in HTML export, Math formatting in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, HTML export
10231 @subsection Images in HTML export
10233 @cindex images, inline in HTML
10234 @cindex inlining images in HTML
10235 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
10236 HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
10237 it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
10238 default@footnote{But see the variable
10239 @code{org-export-html-inline-images}.}, images are inlined if a link does
10240 not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
10241 while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
10242 @samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
10243 itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
10244 image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
10245 image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
10246 will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
10249 [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
10252 If you need to add attributes to an inlined image, use a @code{#+ATTR_HTML}.
10253 In the example below we specify the @code{alt} and @code{title} attributes to
10254 support text viewers and accessibility, and align it to the right.
10257 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10259 #+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
10260 #+ATTR_HTML: alt="cat/spider image" title="Action!" align="right"
10265 You could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
10267 @node Math formatting in HTML export, Text areas in HTML export, Images in HTML export, HTML export
10268 @subsection Math formatting in HTML export
10272 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be displayed in two
10273 different ways on HTML pages. The default is to use the
10274 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax system} which should work out of the
10275 box with Org mode installation because @code{http://orgmode.org} serves
10276 @file{MathJax} for Org mode users for small applications and for testing
10277 purposes. @b{If you plan to use this regularly or on pages with significant
10278 page views, you should install@footnote{Installation instructions can be
10279 found on the MathJax website, see
10280 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org/resources/docs/?installation.html}.} MathJax on
10281 your own server in order to limit the load of our server.} To configure
10282 @file{MathJax}, use the variable @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} or
10283 insert something like the following into the buffer:
10286 #+MATHJAX: align:"left" mathml:t path:"/MathJax/MathJax.js"
10289 @noindent See the docstring of the variable
10290 @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} for the meaning of the parameters in
10293 If you prefer, you can also request that @LaTeX{} fragments are processed
10294 into small images that will be inserted into the browser page. Before the
10295 availability of MathJax, this was the default method for Org files. This
10296 method requires that the @file{dvipng} program is available on your system.
10297 You can still get this processing with
10300 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
10303 @node Text areas in HTML export, CSS support, Math formatting in HTML export, HTML export
10304 @subsection Text areas in HTML export
10306 @cindex text areas, in HTML
10307 An alternative way to publish literal code examples in HTML is to use text
10308 areas, where the example can even be edited before pasting it into an
10309 application. It is triggered by a @code{-t} switch at an @code{example} or
10310 @code{src} block. Using this switch disables any options for syntax and
10311 label highlighting, and line numbering, which may be present. You may also
10312 use @code{-h} and @code{-w} switches to specify the height and width of the
10313 text area, which default to the number of lines in the example, and 80,
10314 respectively. For example
10317 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE -t -w 40
10318 (defun org-xor (a b)
10325 @node CSS support, JavaScript support, Text areas in HTML export, HTML export
10326 @subsection CSS support
10327 @cindex CSS, for HTML export
10328 @cindex HTML export, CSS
10330 @vindex org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix
10331 @vindex org-export-html-tag-class-prefix
10332 You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML exporter
10333 assigns the following special CSS classes@footnote{If the classes on TODO
10334 keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables
10335 @code{org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} and
10336 @code{org-export-html-tag-class-prefix} to make them unique.} to appropriate
10337 parts of the document---your style specifications may change these, in
10338 addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, tables, etc.
10340 p.author @r{author information, including email}
10341 p.date @r{publishing date}
10342 p.creator @r{creator info, about org mode version}
10343 .title @r{document title}
10344 .todo @r{TODO keywords, all not-done states}
10345 .done @r{the DONE keywords, all states that count as done}
10346 .WAITING @r{each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself}
10347 .timestamp @r{timestamp}
10348 .timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED}
10349 .timestamp-wrapper @r{span around keyword plus timestamp}
10350 .tag @r{tag in a headline}
10351 ._HOME @r{each tag uses itself as a class, "@@" replaced by "_"}
10352 .target @r{target for links}
10353 .linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
10354 .code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
10355 div.outline-N @r{div for outline level N (headline plus text))}
10356 div.outline-text-N @r{extra div for text at outline level N}
10357 .section-number-N @r{section number in headlines, different for each level}
10358 div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
10359 pre.src @r{formatted source code}
10360 pre.example @r{normal example}
10361 p.verse @r{verse paragraph}
10362 div.footnotes @r{footnote section headline}
10363 p.footnote @r{footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote}
10364 .footref @r{a footnote reference number (always a <sup>)}
10365 .footnum @r{footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>)}
10368 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
10369 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
10370 @vindex org-export-html-style
10371 @vindex org-export-html-extra
10372 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
10373 Each exported file contains a compact default style that defines these
10374 classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
10375 @code{org-export-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
10376 inclusion of these defaults off, customize
10377 @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}}. You may overwrite these
10378 settings, or add to them by using the variables @code{org-export-html-style}
10379 (for Org-wide settings) and @code{org-export-html-style-extra} (for more
10380 fine-grained settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter variable
10381 individually for each file, you can use
10385 #+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
10389 For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
10390 directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
10391 referring to an external file.
10393 In order to add styles to a subtree, use the @code{:HTML_CONTAINER_CLASS:}
10394 property to assign a class to the tree. In order to specify CSS styles for a
10395 particular headline, you can use the id specified in a @code{:CUSTOM_ID:}
10398 @c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
10399 @c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
10401 @node JavaScript support, , CSS support, HTML export
10402 @subsection JavaScript supported display of web pages
10404 @cindex Rose, Sebastian
10405 Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
10406 enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
10407 program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one
10408 is an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
10409 navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
10410 as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
10411 view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs. The
10412 script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can find
10413 the documentation for it at @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}.
10414 We host the script at our site, but if you use it a lot, you might
10415 not want to be dependent on @url{orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local
10416 copy on your own web server.
10418 To use the script, you need to make sure that the @file{org-jsinfo.el} module
10419 gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try @kbd{M-x
10420 customize-variable @key{RET} org-modules @key{RET}} to convince yourself that
10421 this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the program is
10422 adding a single line to the Org file:
10424 @cindex #+INFOJS_OPT
10426 #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
10430 If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
10431 needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
10435 path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
10436 @r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
10437 @r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
10438 view: @r{Initial view when the website is first shown. Possible values are:}
10439 info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
10440 overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
10441 content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
10442 showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
10443 sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
10444 @r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
10445 @r{@code{org-export-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
10446 @r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-export-headline-levels}, each}
10447 @r{info/folding section can still contain child headlines.}
10448 toc: @r{Should the table of contents @emph{initially} be visible?}
10449 @r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the "toc" with @kbd{i}.}
10450 tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
10451 @r{the variables @code{org-export-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
10452 ftoc: @r{Does the CSS of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?}
10453 @r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
10454 ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
10455 @r{Make this @code{above} if the section should be above initial text.}
10456 mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
10457 @r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
10458 buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
10459 @r{default), only one such button will be present.}
10462 @vindex org-infojs-options
10463 @vindex org-export-html-use-infojs
10464 You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
10465 @code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
10466 pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}.
10468 @node @LaTeX{} and PDF export, DocBook export, HTML export, Exporting
10469 @section @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10470 @cindex @LaTeX{} export
10472 @cindex Guerry, Bastien
10474 Org mode contains a @LaTeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
10475 further processing@footnote{The default @LaTeX{} output is designed for
10476 processing with @code{pdftex} or @LaTeX{}. It includes packages that are not
10477 compatible with @code{xetex} and possibly @code{luatex}. See the variables
10478 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
10479 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}.}, this backend is also used to
10480 produce PDF output. Since the @LaTeX{} output uses @file{hyperref} to
10481 implement links and cross references, the PDF output file will be fully
10482 linked. Beware of the fact that your @code{org} file has to be properly
10483 structured in order to be correctly exported: respect the hierarchy of
10487 * @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands::
10488 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
10489 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
10490 * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
10491 * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
10492 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
10495 @node @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands, Header and sectioning, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10496 @subsection @LaTeX{} export commands
10498 @cindex region, active
10499 @cindex active region
10500 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10502 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l,org-export-as-latex}
10503 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10504 Export as a @LaTeX{} file. For an Org file
10505 @file{myfile.org}, the @LaTeX{} file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will
10506 be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This
10507 requires @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10508 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10509 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10510 title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10511 property, that name will be used for the export.
10512 @orgcmd{C-c C-e L,org-export-as-latex-to-buffer}
10513 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10514 @item C-c C-e v l/L
10515 Export only the visible part of the document.
10516 @item M-x org-export-region-as-latex
10517 Convert the region to @LaTeX{} under the assumption that it was in Org mode
10518 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
10520 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex
10521 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by @LaTeX{}
10523 @orgcmd{C-c C-e p,org-export-as-pdf}
10524 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF.
10525 @orgcmd{C-c C-e d,org-export-as-pdf-and-open}
10526 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10529 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10530 @vindex org-latex-low-levels
10531 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
10532 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
10533 will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
10534 convert them to a custom string depending on
10535 @code{org-latex-low-levels}.
10537 If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
10538 with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
10541 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e l}
10545 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
10547 @node Header and sectioning, Quoting @LaTeX{} code, @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10548 @subsection Header and sectioning structure
10549 @cindex @LaTeX{} class
10550 @cindex @LaTeX{} sectioning structure
10551 @cindex @LaTeX{} header
10552 @cindex header, for @LaTeX{} files
10553 @cindex sectioning structure, for @LaTeX{} export
10555 By default, the @LaTeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
10557 @vindex org-export-latex-default-class
10558 @vindex org-export-latex-classes
10559 @vindex org-export-latex-default-packages-alist
10560 @vindex org-export-latex-packages-alist
10561 @cindex #+LaTeX_HEADER
10562 @cindex #+LaTeX_CLASS
10563 @cindex #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS
10564 @cindex property, LaTeX_CLASS
10565 @cindex property, LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS
10566 You can change this globally by setting a different value for
10567 @code{org-export-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
10568 @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass} in your file, or with a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS:}
10569 property that applies when exporting a region containing only this (sub)tree.
10570 The class must be listed in @code{org-export-latex-classes}. This variable
10571 defines a header template for each class@footnote{Into which the values of
10572 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
10573 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist} are spliced.}, and allows you to
10574 define the sectioning structure for each class. You can also define your own
10575 classes there. @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS} or a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS:}
10576 property can specify the options for the @code{\documentclass} macro. The
10577 options to documentclass have to be provided, as expected by @LaTeX{}, within
10578 square brackets. You can also use @code{#+LaTeX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}}
10579 to add lines to the header. See the docstring of
10580 @code{org-export-latex-classes} for more information. An example is shown
10584 #+LaTeX_CLASS: article
10585 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [a4paper]
10586 #+LaTeX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}
10592 @node Quoting @LaTeX{} code, Tables in @LaTeX{} export, Header and sectioning, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10593 @subsection Quoting @LaTeX{} code
10595 Embedded @LaTeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded @LaTeX{}}, will be correctly
10596 inserted into the @LaTeX{} file. This includes simple macros like
10597 @samp{\ref@{LABEL@}} to create a cross reference to a figure. Furthermore,
10598 you can add special code that should only be present in @LaTeX{} export with
10599 the following constructs:
10602 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10604 #+LaTeX: Literal @LaTeX{} code for export
10608 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10612 All lines between these markers are exported literally
10617 @node Tables in @LaTeX{} export, Images in @LaTeX{} export, Quoting @LaTeX{} code, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10618 @subsection Tables in @LaTeX{} export
10619 @cindex tables, in @LaTeX{} export
10621 For @LaTeX{} export of a table, you can specify a label, a caption and
10622 placement options (@pxref{Images and tables}). You can also use the
10623 @code{ATTR_LaTeX} line to request a @code{longtable} environment for the
10624 table, so that it may span several pages, or to change the default table
10625 environment from @code{table} to @code{table*} or to change the default inner
10626 tabular environment to @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}. Finally, you can
10627 set the alignment string, and (with @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}) the
10632 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10634 #+CAPTION: A long table
10636 #+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable align=l|lp@{3cm@}r|l
10641 or to specify a multicolumn table with @code{tabulary}
10645 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10647 #+CAPTION: A wide table with tabulary
10649 #+ATTR_LaTeX: table* tabulary width=\textwidth
10654 @node Images in @LaTeX{} export, Beamer class export, Tables in @LaTeX{} export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10655 @subsection Images in @LaTeX{} export
10656 @cindex images, inline in @LaTeX{}
10657 @cindex inlining images in @LaTeX{}
10659 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10660 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
10661 output file resulting from @LaTeX{} processing. Org will use an
10662 @code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
10663 caption and/or a label as described in @ref{Images and tables}, the figure
10664 will be wrapped into a @code{figure} environment and thus become a floating
10665 element. You can use an @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line to specify various other
10666 options. You can ask org to export an image as a float without specifying
10667 a label or a caption by using the keyword @code{float} in this line. Various
10668 optional arguments to the @code{\includegraphics} macro can also be specified
10669 in this fashion. To modify the placement option of the floating environment,
10670 add something like @samp{placement=[h!]} to the attributes. It is to be noted
10671 this option can be used with tables as well@footnote{One can also take
10672 advantage of this option to pass other, unrelated options into the figure or
10673 table environment. For an example see the section ``Exporting org files'' in
10674 @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-hacks.html}}.
10676 If you would like to let text flow around the image, add the word @samp{wrap}
10677 to the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line, which will make the figure occupy the left
10678 half of the page. To fine-tune, the @code{placement} field will be the set
10679 of additional arguments needed by the @code{wrapfigure} environment. Note
10680 that if you change the size of the image, you need to use compatible settings
10681 for @code{\includegraphics} and @code{wrapfigure}.
10685 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10687 #+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
10688 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
10689 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
10690 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
10692 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=0.38\textwidth wrap placement=@{r@}@{0.4\textwidth@}
10696 If you wish to include an image which spans multiple columns in a page, you
10697 can use the keyword @code{multicolumn} in the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX} line. This
10698 will export the image wrapped in a @code{figure*} environment.
10700 If you need references to a label created in this way, write
10701 @samp{\ref@{fig:SED-HR4049@}} just like in @LaTeX{}.
10703 @node Beamer class export, , Images in @LaTeX{} export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10704 @subsection Beamer class export
10706 The @LaTeX{} class @file{beamer} allows production of high quality presentations
10707 using @LaTeX{} and pdf processing. Org mode has special support for turning an
10708 Org mode file or tree into a @file{beamer} presentation.
10710 When the @LaTeX{} class for the current buffer (as set with @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS:
10711 beamer}) or subtree (set with a @code{LaTeX_CLASS} property) is
10712 @code{beamer}, a special export mode will turn the file or tree into a beamer
10713 presentation. Any tree with not-too-deep level nesting should in principle be
10714 exportable as a beamer presentation. By default, the top-level entries (or
10715 the first level below the selected subtree heading) will be turned into
10716 frames, and the outline structure below this level will become itemize lists.
10717 You can also configure the variable @code{org-beamer-frame-level} to a
10718 different level---then the hierarchy above frames will produce the sectioning
10719 structure of the presentation.
10721 A template for useful in-buffer settings or properties can be inserted into
10722 the buffer with @kbd{M-x org-insert-beamer-options-template}. Among other
10723 things, this will install a column view format which is very handy for
10724 editing special properties used by beamer.
10726 You can influence the structure of the presentation using the following
10731 The environment that should be used to format this entry. Valid environments
10732 are defined in the constant @code{org-beamer-environments-default}, and you
10733 can define more in @code{org-beamer-environments-extra}. If this property is
10734 set, the entry will also get a @code{:B_environment:} tag to make this
10735 visible. This tag has no semantic meaning, it is only a visual aid.
10736 @item BEAMER_envargs
10737 The beamer-special arguments that should be used for the environment, like
10738 @code{[t]} or @code{[<+->]} of @code{<2-3>}. If the @code{BEAMER_col}
10739 property is also set, something like @code{C[t]} can be added here as well to
10740 set an options argument for the implied @code{columns} environment.
10741 @code{c[t]} or @code{c<2->} will set an options for the implied @code{column}
10744 The width of a column that should start with this entry. If this property is
10745 set, the entry will also get a @code{:BMCOL:} property to make this visible.
10746 Also this tag is only a visual aid. When this is a plain number, it will be
10747 interpreted as a fraction of @code{\textwidth}. Otherwise it will be assumed
10748 that you have specified the units, like @samp{3cm}. The first such property
10749 in a frame will start a @code{columns} environment to surround the columns.
10750 This environment is closed when an entry has a @code{BEAMER_col} property
10751 with value 0 or 1, or automatically at the end of the frame.
10753 Additional commands that should be inserted after the environment has been
10754 opened. For example, when creating a frame, this can be used to specify
10758 Frames will automatically receive a @code{fragile} option if they contain
10759 source code that uses the verbatim environment. Special @file{beamer}
10760 specific code can be inserted using @code{#+BEAMER:} and
10761 @code{#+BEGIN_BEAMER...#+END_BEAMER} constructs, similar to other export
10762 backends, but with the difference that @code{#+LaTeX:} stuff will be included
10763 in the presentation as well.
10765 Outline nodes with @code{BEAMER_env} property value @samp{note} or
10766 @samp{noteNH} will be formatted as beamer notes, i,e, they will be wrapped
10767 into @code{\note@{...@}}. The former will include the heading as part of the
10768 note text, the latter will ignore the heading of that node. To simplify note
10769 generation, it is actually enough to mark the note with a @emph{tag} (either
10770 @code{:B_note:} or @code{:B_noteNH:}) instead of creating the
10771 @code{BEAMER_env} property.
10773 You can turn on a special minor mode @code{org-beamer-mode} for editing
10781 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-beamer-select-environment}
10782 In @code{org-beamer-mode}, this key offers fast selection of a beamer
10783 environment or the @code{BEAMER_col} property.
10786 Column view provides a great way to set the environment of a node and other
10787 important parameters. Make sure you are using a COLUMN format that is geared
10788 toward this special purpose. The command @kbd{M-x
10789 org-insert-beamer-options-template} defines such a format.
10791 Here is a simple example Org document that is intended for beamer export.
10794 #+LaTeX_CLASS: beamer
10795 #+TITLE: Example Presentation
10796 #+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik
10797 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation]
10798 #+BEAMER_FRAME_LEVEL: 2
10799 #+BEAMER_HEADER_EXTRA: \usetheme@{Madrid@}\usecolortheme@{default@}
10800 #+COLUMNS: %35ITEM %10BEAMER_env(Env) %10BEAMER_envargs(Args) %4BEAMER_col(Col) %8BEAMER_extra(Ex)
10802 * This is the first structural section
10804 ** Frame 1 \\ with a subtitle
10805 *** Thanks to Eric Fraga :BMCOL:B_block:
10808 :BEAMER_envargs: C[t]
10811 for the first viable beamer setup in Org
10812 *** Thanks to everyone else :BMCOL:B_block:
10816 :BEAMER_envargs: <2->
10818 for contributing to the discussion
10819 **** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note:
10820 ** Frame 2 \\ where we will not use columns
10821 *** Request :B_block:
10822 Please test this stuff!
10828 For more information, see the documentation on Worg.
10830 @node DocBook export, OpenDocument Text export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, Exporting
10831 @section DocBook export
10832 @cindex DocBook export
10834 @cindex Cui, Baoqiu
10836 Org contains a DocBook exporter written by Baoqiu Cui. Once an Org file is
10837 exported to DocBook format, it can be further processed to produce other
10838 formats, including PDF, HTML, man pages, etc., using many available DocBook
10839 tools and stylesheets.
10841 Currently DocBook exporter only supports DocBook V5.0.
10844 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
10845 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
10846 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
10847 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
10848 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
10849 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
10852 @node DocBook export commands, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export, DocBook export
10853 @subsection DocBook export commands
10855 @cindex region, active
10856 @cindex active region
10857 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10859 @orgcmd{C-c C-e D,org-export-as-docbook}
10860 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10861 Export as a DocBook file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the DocBook XML
10862 file will be @file{myfile.xml}. The file will be overwritten without
10863 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10864 @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
10865 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10866 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10867 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10868 property, that name will be used for the export.
10869 @orgcmd{C-c C-e V,org-export-as-docbook-pdf-and-open}
10870 Export as a DocBook file, process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10872 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command
10873 @vindex org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command
10874 Note that, in order to produce PDF output based on an exported DocBook file,
10875 you need to have XSLT processor and XSL-FO processor software installed on your
10876 system. Check variables @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} and
10877 @code{org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command}.
10879 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet
10880 The stylesheet argument @code{%s} in variable
10881 @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} is replaced by the value of
10882 variable @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet}, which needs to be set by
10883 the user. You can also overrule this global setting on a per-file basis by
10884 adding an in-buffer setting @code{#+XSLT:} to the Org file.
10886 @orgkey{C-c C-e v D}
10887 Export only the visible part of the document.
10890 @node Quoting DocBook code, Recursive sections, DocBook export commands, DocBook export
10891 @subsection Quoting DocBook code
10893 You can quote DocBook code in Org files and copy it verbatim into exported
10894 DocBook file with the following constructs:
10897 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10899 #+DOCBOOK: Literal DocBook code for export
10903 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10907 All lines between these markers are exported by DocBook exporter
10912 For example, you can use the following lines to include a DocBook warning
10913 admonition. As to what this warning says, you should pay attention to the
10914 document context when quoting DocBook code in Org files. You may make
10915 exported DocBook XML files invalid by not quoting DocBook code correctly.
10920 <para>You should know what you are doing when quoting DocBook XML code
10921 in your Org file. Invalid DocBook XML may be generated by
10922 DocBook exporter if you are not careful!</para>
10927 @node Recursive sections, Tables in DocBook export, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export
10928 @subsection Recursive sections
10929 @cindex DocBook recursive sections
10931 DocBook exporter exports Org files as articles using the @code{article}
10932 element in DocBook. Recursive sections, i.e.@: @code{section} elements, are
10933 used in exported articles. Top level headlines in Org files are exported as
10934 top level sections, and lower level headlines are exported as nested
10935 sections. The entire structure of Org files will be exported completely, no
10936 matter how many nested levels of headlines there are.
10938 Using recursive sections makes it easy to port and reuse exported DocBook
10939 code in other DocBook document types like @code{book} or @code{set}.
10941 @node Tables in DocBook export, Images in DocBook export, Recursive sections, DocBook export
10942 @subsection Tables in DocBook export
10943 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
10945 Tables in Org files are exported as HTML tables, which have been supported since
10948 If a table does not have a caption, an informal table is generated using the
10949 @code{informaltable} element; otherwise, a formal table will be generated
10950 using the @code{table} element.
10952 @node Images in DocBook export, Special characters, Tables in DocBook export, DocBook export
10953 @subsection Images in DocBook export
10954 @cindex images, inline in DocBook
10955 @cindex inlining images in DocBook
10957 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10958 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, will be exported to DocBook
10959 using @code{mediaobject} elements. Each @code{mediaobject} element contains
10960 an @code{imageobject} that wraps an @code{imagedata} element. If you have
10961 specified a caption for an image as described in @ref{Images and tables}, a
10962 @code{caption} element will be added in @code{mediaobject}. If a label is
10963 also specified, it will be exported as an @code{xml:id} attribute of the
10964 @code{mediaobject} element.
10966 @vindex org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes
10967 Image attributes supported by the @code{imagedata} element, like @code{align}
10968 or @code{width}, can be specified in two ways: you can either customize
10969 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} or use the
10970 @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line. Attributes specified in variable
10971 @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} are applied to all inline
10972 images in the Org file to be exported (unless they are overridden by image
10973 attributes specified in @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} lines).
10975 The @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line can be used to specify additional image
10976 attributes or override default image attributes for individual images. If
10977 the same attribute appears in both the @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line and
10978 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes}, the former
10979 takes precedence. Here is an example about how image attributes can be
10984 @cindex #+ATTR_DOCBOOK
10986 #+CAPTION: The logo of Org mode
10987 #+LABEL: unicorn-svg
10988 #+ATTR_DOCBOOK: scalefit="1" width="100%" depth="100%"
10989 [[./img/org-mode-unicorn.svg]]
10992 @vindex org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions
10993 By default, DocBook exporter recognizes the following image file types:
10994 @file{jpeg}, @file{jpg}, @file{png}, @file{gif}, and @file{svg}. You can
10995 customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions} to add
10996 more types to this list as long as DocBook supports them.
10998 @node Special characters, , Images in DocBook export, DocBook export
10999 @subsection Special characters in DocBook export
11000 @cindex Special characters in DocBook export
11002 @vindex org-export-docbook-doctype
11003 @vindex org-entities
11004 Special characters that are written in @TeX{}-like syntax, such as @code{\alpha},
11005 @code{\Gamma}, and @code{\Zeta}, are supported by DocBook exporter. These
11006 characters are rewritten to XML entities, like @code{α},
11007 @code{Γ}, and @code{Ζ}, based on the list saved in variable
11008 @code{org-entities}. As long as the generated DocBook file includes the
11009 corresponding entities, these special characters are recognized.
11011 You can customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to include the
11012 entities you need. For example, you can set variable
11013 @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to the following value to recognize all
11014 special characters included in XHTML entities:
11017 "<!DOCTYPE article [
11018 <!ENTITY % xhtml1-symbol PUBLIC
11019 \"-//W3C//ENTITIES Symbol for HTML//EN//XML\"
11020 \"http://www.w3.org/2003/entities/2007/xhtml1-symbol.ent\"
11027 @c begin opendocument
11029 @node OpenDocument Text export, TaskJuggler export, DocBook export, Exporting
11030 @section OpenDocument Text export
11031 @cindex K, Jambunathan
11033 @cindex OpenDocument
11034 @cindex export, OpenDocument
11035 @cindex LibreOffice
11037 @cindex org-modules
11039 Org Mode@footnote{Versions 7.8 or later} supports export to OpenDocument Text
11040 (ODT) format using the @file{org-odt.el} module. Documents created
11041 by this exporter use the @cite{OpenDocument-v1.2
11042 specification}@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
11043 Open Document Format for Office Applications (OpenDocument) Version 1.2}} and
11044 are compatible with LibreOffice 3.4.
11047 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: What packages ODT exporter relies on
11048 * ODT export commands:: How to invoke ODT export
11049 * Extending ODT export:: How to produce @samp{doc}, @samp{pdf} files
11050 * Applying custom styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
11051 * Links in ODT export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
11052 * Tables in ODT export:: How Tables are exported
11053 * Images in ODT export:: How to insert images
11054 * Math formatting in ODT export:: How @LaTeX{} fragments are formatted
11055 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: How captions are rendered
11056 * Literal examples in ODT export:: How source and example blocks are formatted
11057 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: Read this if you are a power user
11060 @node Pre-requisites for ODT export, ODT export commands, OpenDocument Text export, OpenDocument Text export
11061 @subsection Pre-requisites for ODT export
11063 The ODT exporter relies on the @file{zip} program to create the final
11064 output. Check the availability of this program before proceeding further.
11066 @node ODT export commands, Extending ODT export, Pre-requisites for ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11067 @subsection ODT export commands
11069 @subsubheading Exporting to ODT
11070 @anchor{x-export-to-odt}
11072 @cindex region, active
11073 @cindex active region
11074 @cindex transient-mark-mode
11076 @orgcmd{C-c C-e o,org-export-as-odt}
11077 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
11079 Export as OpenDocument Text file.
11081 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
11082 If @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, automatically
11083 convert the exported file to that format. @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, ,
11084 Automatically exporting to other formats}.
11086 For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the ODT file will be
11087 @file{myfile.odt}. The file will be overwritten without warning. If there
11088 is an active region,@footnote{This requires @code{transient-mark-mode} to be
11089 turned on} only the region will be exported. If the selected region is a
11090 single tree,@footnote{To select the current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}} the
11091 tree head will become the document title. If the tree head entry has, or
11092 inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
11095 @orgcmd{C-c C-e O,org-export-as-odt-and-open}
11096 Export as an OpenDocument Text file and open the resulting file.
11098 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
11099 If @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, open the
11100 converted file instead. @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, , Automatically
11101 exporting to other formats}.
11104 @node Extending ODT export, Applying custom styles, ODT export commands, OpenDocument Text export
11105 @subsection Extending ODT export
11107 The ODT exporter can interface with a variety of document
11108 converters and supports popular converters out of the box. As a result, you
11109 can use it to export to formats like @samp{doc} or convert a document from
11110 one format (say @samp{csv}) to another format (say @samp{ods} or @samp{xls}).
11112 @cindex @file{unoconv}
11113 @cindex LibreOffice
11114 If you have a working installation of LibreOffice, a document converter is
11115 pre-configured for you and you can use it right away. If you would like to
11116 use @file{unoconv} as your preferred converter, customize the variable
11117 @code{org-export-odt-convert-process} to point to @code{unoconv}. You can
11118 also use your own favorite converter or tweak the default settings of the
11119 @file{LibreOffice} and @samp{unoconv} converters. @xref{Configuring a
11120 document converter}.
11122 @subsubsection Automatically exporting to other formats
11123 @anchor{x-export-to-other-formats}
11125 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
11126 Very often, you will find yourself exporting to ODT format, only to
11127 immediately save the exported document to other formats like @samp{doc},
11128 @samp{docx}, @samp{rtf}, @samp{pdf} etc. In such cases, you can specify your
11129 preferred output format by customizing the variable
11130 @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format}. This way, the export commands
11131 (@pxref{x-export-to-odt,,Exporting to ODT}) can be extended to export to a
11132 format that is of immediate interest to you.
11134 @subsubsection Converting between document formats
11135 @anchor{x-convert-to-other-formats}
11137 There are many document converters in the wild which support conversion to
11138 and from various file formats, including, but not limited to the
11139 ODT format. LibreOffice converter, mentioned above, is one such
11140 converter. Once a converter is configured, you can interact with it using
11141 the following command.
11143 @vindex org-export-odt-convert
11146 @item M-x org-export-odt-convert
11147 Convert an existing document from one format to another. With a prefix
11148 argument, also open the newly produced file.
11151 @node Applying custom styles, Links in ODT export, Extending ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11152 @subsection Applying custom styles
11153 @cindex styles, custom
11154 @cindex template, custom
11156 The ODT exporter ships with a set of OpenDocument styles
11157 (@pxref{Working with OpenDocument style files}) that ensure a well-formatted
11158 output. These factory styles, however, may not cater to your specific
11159 tastes. To customize the output, you can either modify the above styles
11160 files directly, or generate the required styles using an application like
11161 LibreOffice. The latter method is suitable for expert and non-expert
11162 users alike, and is described here.
11164 @subsubsection Applying custom styles - the easy way
11168 Create a sample @file{example.org} file with the below settings and export it
11172 #+OPTIONS: H:10 num:t
11176 Open the above @file{example.odt} using LibreOffice. Use the @file{Stylist}
11177 to locate the target styles - these typically have the @samp{Org} prefix -
11178 and modify those to your taste. Save the modified file either as an
11179 OpenDocument Text (@file{.odt}) or OpenDocument Template (@file{.ott}) file.
11182 @cindex #+ODT_STYLES_FILE
11183 @vindex org-export-odt-styles-file
11184 Customize the variable @code{org-export-odt-styles-file} and point it to the
11185 newly created file. For additional configuration options
11186 @pxref{x-overriding-factory-styles,,Overriding factory styles}.
11188 If you would like to choose a style on a per-file basis, you can use the
11189 @code{#+ODT_STYLES_FILE} option. A typical setting will look like
11192 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: "/path/to/example.ott"
11198 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: ("/path/to/file.ott" ("styles.xml" "image/hdr.png"))
11203 @subsubsection Using third-party styles and templates
11205 You can use third-party styles and templates for customizing your output.
11206 This will produce the desired output only if the template provides all
11207 style names that the @samp{ODT} exporter relies on. Unless this condition is
11208 met, the output is going to be less than satisfactory. So it is highly
11209 recommended that you only work with templates that are directly derived from
11210 the factory settings.
11212 @node Links in ODT export, Tables in ODT export, Applying custom styles, OpenDocument Text export
11213 @subsection Links in ODT export
11214 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
11216 ODT exporter creates native cross-references for internal links. It creates
11217 Internet-style links for all other links.
11219 A link with no description and destined to a regular (un-itemized) outline
11220 heading is replaced with a cross-reference and section number of the heading.
11222 A @samp{\ref@{label@}}-style reference to an image, table etc. is replaced
11223 with a cross-reference and sequence number of the labeled entity.
11224 @xref{Labels and captions in ODT export}.
11226 @node Tables in ODT export, Images in ODT export, Links in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11227 @subsection Tables in ODT export
11228 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
11230 Export of native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and simple @file{table.el}
11231 tables is supported. However, export of complex @file{table.el} tables -
11232 tables that have column or row spans - is not supported. Such tables are
11233 stripped from the exported document.
11235 By default, a table is exported with top and bottom frames and with rules
11236 separating row and column groups (@pxref{Column groups}). Furthermore, all
11237 tables are typeset to occupy the same width. If the table specifies
11238 alignment and relative width for its columns (@pxref{Column width and
11239 alignment}) then these are honored on export.@footnote{The column widths are
11240 interpreted as weighted ratios with the default weight being 1}
11243 You can control the width of the table by specifying @code{:rel-width}
11244 property using an @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line.
11246 For example, consider the following table which makes use of all the rules
11250 #+ATTR_ODT: :rel-width 50
11251 | Area/Month | Jan | Feb | Mar | Sum |
11252 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
11254 | <l13> | <r5> | <r5> | <r5> | <r6> |
11255 | North America | 1 | 21 | 926 | 948 |
11256 | Middle East | 6 | 75 | 844 | 925 |
11257 | Asia Pacific | 9 | 27 | 790 | 826 |
11258 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
11259 | Sum | 16 | 123 | 2560 | 2699 |
11262 On export, the table will occupy 50% of text area. The columns will be sized
11263 (roughly) in the ratio of 13:5:5:5:6. The first column will be left-aligned
11264 and rest of the columns will be right-aligned. There will be vertical rules
11265 after separating the header and last columns from other columns. There will
11266 be horizontal rules separating the header and last rows from other rows.
11268 If you are not satisfied with the above formatting options, you can create
11269 custom table styles and associate them with a table using the
11270 @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. @xref{Customizing tables in ODT export}.
11272 @node Images in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export, Tables in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11273 @subsection Images in ODT export
11274 @cindex images, embedding in ODT
11275 @cindex embedding images in ODT
11277 @subsubheading Embedding images
11278 You can embed images within the exported document by providing a link to the
11279 desired image file with no link description. For example, to embed
11280 @samp{img.png} do either of the following:
11290 @subsubheading Embedding clickable images
11291 You can create clickable images by providing a link whose description is a
11292 link to an image file. For example, to embed a image
11293 @file{org-mode-unicorn.png} which when clicked jumps to
11294 @uref{http://Orgmode.org} website, do the following
11297 [[http://orgmode.org][./org-mode-unicorn.png]]
11300 @subsubheading Sizing and scaling of embedded images
11303 You can control the size and scale of the embedded images using the
11304 @code{#+ATTR_ODT} attribute.
11306 @cindex identify, ImageMagick
11307 @vindex org-export-odt-pixels-per-inch
11308 The exporter specifies the desired size of the image in the final document in
11309 units of centimeters. In order to scale the embedded images, the exporter
11310 queries for pixel dimensions of the images using one of a) ImageMagick's
11311 @file{identify} program or b) Emacs `create-image' and `image-size'
11312 APIs.@footnote{Use of @file{ImageMagick} is only desirable. However, if you
11313 routinely produce documents that have large images or you export your Org
11314 files that has images using a Emacs batch script, then the use of
11315 @file{ImageMagick} is mandatory.} The pixel dimensions are subsequently
11316 converted in to units of centimeters using
11317 @code{org-export-odt-pixels-per-inch}. The default value of this variable is
11318 set to @code{display-pixels-per-inch}. You can tweak this variable to
11319 achieve the best results.
11321 The examples below illustrate the various possibilities.
11324 @item Explicitly size the image
11325 To embed @file{img.png} as a 10 cm x 10 cm image, do the following:
11328 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10 :height 10
11332 @item Scale the image
11333 To embed @file{img.png} at half its size, do the following:
11336 #+ATTR_ODT: :scale 0.5
11340 @item Scale the image to a specific width
11341 To embed @file{img.png} with a width of 10 cm while retaining the original
11342 height:width ratio, do the following:
11345 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10
11349 @item Scale the image to a specific height
11350 To embed @file{img.png} with a height of 10 cm while retaining the original
11351 height:width ratio, do the following
11354 #+ATTR_ODT: :height 10
11359 @subsubheading Anchoring of images
11362 You can control the manner in which an image is anchored by setting the
11363 @code{:anchor} property of it's @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. You can specify one
11364 of the the following three values for the @code{:anchor} property -
11365 @samp{"as-char"}, @samp{"paragraph"} and @samp{"page"}.
11367 To create an image that is anchored to a page, do the following:
11369 #+ATTR_ODT: :anchor "page"
11373 @node Math formatting in ODT export, Labels and captions in ODT export, Images in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11374 @subsection Math formatting in ODT export
11376 The ODT exporter has special support for handling math.
11379 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: How to embed @LaTeX{} math fragments
11380 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: How to embed equations in native format
11383 @node Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets, Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, Math formatting in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export
11384 @subsubsection Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets
11386 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be embedded in the ODT
11387 document in one of the following ways:
11393 This option is activated on a per-file basis with
11399 With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are first converted into MathML
11400 fragments using an external @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter program. The
11401 resulting MathML fragments are then embedded as an OpenDocument Formula in
11402 the exported document.
11404 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
11405 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
11407 You can specify the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter by customizing the variables
11408 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command} and
11409 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file}.
11411 If you prefer to use @file{MathToWeb}@footnote{See
11412 @uref{http://www.mathtoweb.com/cgi-bin/mathtoweb_home.pl, MathToWeb}} as your
11413 converter, you can configure the above variables as shown below.
11416 (setq org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
11417 "java -jar %j -unicode -force -df %o %I"
11418 org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
11419 "/path/to/mathtoweb.jar")
11422 You can use the following commands to quickly verify the reliability of
11423 the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter.
11427 @item M-x org-export-as-odf
11428 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file.
11430 @item M-x org-export-as-odf-and-open
11431 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file
11432 and open the formula file with the system-registered application.
11438 This option is activated on a per-file basis with
11441 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
11444 With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are processed into PNG images and the
11445 resulting images are embedded in the exported document. This method requires
11446 that the @file{dvipng} program be available on your system.
11449 @node Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, , Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets, Math formatting in ODT export
11450 @subsubsection Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files
11452 For various reasons, you may find embedding @LaTeX{} math snippets in an
11453 ODT document less than reliable. In that case, you can embed a
11454 math equation by linking to its MathML (@file{.mml}) source or its
11455 OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file as shown below:
11467 @node Labels and captions in ODT export, Literal examples in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11468 @subsection Labels and captions in ODT export
11470 You can label and caption various category of objects - an inline image, a
11471 table, a @LaTeX{} fragment or a Math formula - using @code{#+LABEL} and
11472 @code{#+CAPTION} lines. @xref{Images and tables}. ODT exporter enumerates
11473 each labeled or captioned object of a given category separately. As a
11474 result, each such object is assigned a sequence number based on order of it's
11475 appearance in the Org file.
11477 In the exported document, a user-provided caption is augmented with the
11478 category and sequence number. Consider the following inline image in an Org
11482 #+CAPTION: Bell curve
11483 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
11487 It could be rendered as shown below in the exported document.
11490 Figure 2: Bell curve
11493 @vindex org-export-odt-category-strings
11494 You can modify the category component of the caption by customizing the
11495 variable @code{org-export-odt-category-strings}. For example, to tag all
11496 embedded images with the string @samp{Illustration} (instead of the default
11497 @samp{Figure}) use the following setting.
11500 (setq org-export-odt-category-strings
11501 '(("en" "Table" "Illustration" "Equation" "Equation")))
11504 With this, previous image will be captioned as below in the exported
11508 Illustration 2: Bell curve
11511 @node Literal examples in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export, Labels and captions in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11512 @subsection Literal examples in ODT export
11514 Export of literal examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) with full fontification
11515 is supported. Internally, the exporter relies on @file{htmlfontify.el} to
11516 generate all style definitions needed for a fancy listing.@footnote{Your
11517 @file{htmlfontify.el} library must at least be at Emacs 24.1 levels for
11518 fontification to be turned on.} The auto-generated styles have @samp{OrgSrc}
11519 as prefix and inherit their color from the faces used by Emacs
11520 @code{font-lock} library for the source language.
11522 @vindex org-export-odt-fontify-srcblocks
11523 If you prefer to use your own custom styles for fontification, you can do so
11524 by customizing the variable
11525 @code{org-export-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks}.
11527 @vindex org-export-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks
11528 You can turn off fontification of literal examples by customizing the
11529 variable @code{org-export-odt-fontify-srcblocks}.
11531 @node Advanced topics in ODT export, , Literal examples in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11532 @subsection Advanced topics in ODT export
11534 If you rely heavily on ODT export, you may want to exploit the full
11535 set of features that the exporter offers. This section describes features
11536 that would be of interest to power users.
11539 * Configuring a document converter:: How to register a document converter
11540 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Explore the internals
11541 * Creating one-off styles:: How to produce custom highlighting etc
11542 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: How to define and use Table templates
11543 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: How to debug corrupt OpenDocument files
11546 @node Configuring a document converter, Working with OpenDocument style files, Advanced topics in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export
11547 @subsubsection Configuring a document converter
11549 @cindex doc, docx, rtf
11552 The ODT exporter can work with popular converters with little or no
11553 extra configuration from your side. @xref{Extending ODT export}.
11554 If you are using a converter that is not supported by default or if you would
11555 like to tweak the default converter settings, proceed as below.
11558 @item Register the converter
11560 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-processes
11561 Name your converter and add it to the list of known converters by customizing
11562 the variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-processes}. Also specify how the
11563 converter can be invoked via command-line to effect the conversion.
11565 @item Configure its capabilities
11567 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-capabilities
11568 @anchor{x-odt-converter-capabilities}
11569 Specify the set of formats the converter can handle by customizing the
11570 variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-capabilities}. Use the default value
11571 for this variable as a guide for configuring your converter. As suggested by
11572 the default setting, you can specify the full set of formats supported by the
11573 converter and not limit yourself to specifying formats that are related to
11574 just the OpenDocument Text format.
11576 @item Choose the converter
11578 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-process
11579 Select the newly added converter as the preferred one by customizing the
11580 variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-process}.
11583 @node Working with OpenDocument style files, Creating one-off styles, Configuring a document converter, Advanced topics in ODT export
11584 @subsubsection Working with OpenDocument style files
11585 @cindex styles, custom
11586 @cindex template, custom
11588 This section explores the internals of the ODT exporter and the
11589 means by which it produces styled documents. Read this section if you are
11590 interested in exploring the automatic and custom OpenDocument styles used by
11593 @anchor{x-factory-styles}
11594 @subsubheading Factory styles
11596 The ODT exporter relies on two files for generating its output.
11597 These files are bundled with the distribution under the directory pointed to
11598 by the variable @code{org-odt-styles-dir}. The two files are:
11601 @anchor{x-orgodtstyles-xml}
11603 @file{OrgOdtStyles.xml}
11605 This file contributes to the @file{styles.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
11606 document. This file gets modified for the following purposes:
11610 To control outline numbering based on user settings.
11613 To add styles generated by @file{htmlfontify.el} for fontification of code
11617 @anchor{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml}
11619 @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
11621 This file contributes to the @file{content.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
11622 document. The contents of the Org outline are inserted between the
11623 @samp{<office:text>}@dots{}@samp{</office:text>} elements of this file.
11625 Apart from serving as a template file for the final @file{content.xml}, the
11626 file serves the following purposes:
11630 It contains automatic styles for formatting of tables which are referenced by
11634 It contains @samp{<text:sequence-decl>}@dots{}@samp{</text:sequence-decl>}
11635 elements that control how various entities - tables, images, equations etc -
11640 @anchor{x-overriding-factory-styles}
11641 @subsubheading Overriding factory styles
11642 The following two variables control the location from which the ODT
11643 exporter picks up the custom styles and content template files. You can
11644 customize these variables to override the factory styles used by the
11648 @anchor{x-org-export-odt-styles-file}
11650 @code{org-export-odt-styles-file}
11652 Use this variable to specify the @file{styles.xml} that will be used in the
11653 final output. You can specify one of the following values:
11656 @item A @file{styles.xml} file
11658 Use this file instead of the default @file{styles.xml}
11660 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file
11662 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
11665 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file and a subset of files contained within them
11667 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
11668 Template file. Additionally extract the specified member files and embed
11669 those within the final @samp{ODT} document.
11671 Use this option if the @file{styles.xml} file references additional files
11672 like header and footer images.
11676 Use the default @file{styles.xml}
11679 @anchor{x-org-export-odt-content-template-file}
11681 @code{org-export-odt-content-template-file}
11683 Use this variable to specify the blank @file{content.xml} that will be used
11684 in the final output.
11687 @node Creating one-off styles, Customizing tables in ODT export, Working with OpenDocument style files, Advanced topics in ODT export
11688 @subsubsection Creating one-off styles
11690 There are times when you would want one-off formatting in the exported
11691 document. You can achieve this by embedding raw OpenDocument XML in the Org
11692 file. The use of this feature is better illustrated with couple of examples.
11695 @item Embedding ODT tags as part of regular text
11697 You can include simple OpenDocument tags by prefixing them with
11698 @samp{@@}. For example, to highlight a region of text do the following:
11701 @@<text:span text:style-name="Highlight">This is a
11702 highlighted text@@</text:span>. But this is a
11706 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your
11707 @file{styles.xml} (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a
11708 custom @samp{Highlight} style as shown below.
11711 <style:style style:name="Highlight" style:family="text">
11712 <style:text-properties fo:background-color="#ff0000"/>
11716 @item Embedding a one-line OpenDocument XML
11718 You can add a simple OpenDocument one-liner using the @code{#+ODT:}
11719 directive. For example, to force a page break do the following:
11722 #+ODT: <text:p text:style-name="PageBreak"/>
11725 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your
11726 @file{styles.xml} (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a
11727 custom @samp{PageBreak} style as shown below.
11730 <style:style style:name="PageBreak" style:family="paragraph"
11731 style:parent-style-name="Text_20_body">
11732 <style:paragraph-properties fo:break-before="page"/>
11736 @item Embedding a block of OpenDocument XML
11738 You can add a large block of OpenDocument XML using the
11739 @code{#+BEGIN_ODT}@dots{}@code{#+END_ODT} construct.
11741 For example, to create a one-off paragraph that uses bold text, do the
11746 <text:p text:style-name="Text_20_body_20_bold">
11747 This paragraph is specially formatted and uses bold text.
11754 @node Customizing tables in ODT export, Validating OpenDocument XML, Creating one-off styles, Advanced topics in ODT export
11755 @subsubsection Customizing tables in ODT export
11756 @cindex tables, in ODT export
11759 You can override the default formatting of the table by specifying a custom
11760 table style with the @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. For a discussion on default
11761 formatting of tables @pxref{Tables in ODT export}.
11763 This feature closely mimics the way table templates are defined in the
11765 specification.@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
11766 OpenDocument-v1.2 Specification}}
11770 @subsubheading Custom table styles - an illustration
11772 To have a quick preview of this feature, install the below setting and export
11773 the table that follows.
11776 (setq org-export-odt-table-styles
11777 (append org-export-odt-table-styles
11778 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
11779 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11780 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
11781 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
11782 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11783 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
11787 #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn"
11788 | Name | Phone | Age |
11789 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
11790 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
11793 In the above example, you used a template named @samp{Custom} and installed
11794 two table styles with the names @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and
11795 @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}. (@strong{Important:} The OpenDocument
11796 styles needed for producing the above template have been pre-defined for you.
11797 These styles are available under the section marked @samp{Custom Table
11798 Template} in @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
11799 (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory styles}). If you need
11800 additional templates you have to define these styles yourselves.
11802 @subsubheading Custom table styles - the nitty-gritty
11803 To use this feature proceed as follows:
11807 Create a table template@footnote{See the @code{<table:table-template>}
11808 element of the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
11810 A table template is nothing but a set of @samp{table-cell} and
11811 @samp{paragraph} styles for each of the following table cell categories:
11825 The names for the above styles must be chosen based on the name of the table
11826 template using a well-defined convention.
11828 The naming convention is better illustrated with an example. For a table
11829 template with the name @samp{Custom}, the needed style names are listed in
11830 the following table.
11832 @multitable {Table cell type} {CustomEvenColumnTableCell} {CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
11833 @headitem Table cell type
11834 @tab @code{table-cell} style
11835 @tab @code{paragraph} style
11840 @tab @samp{CustomTableCell}
11841 @tab @samp{CustomTableParagraph}
11843 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableCell}
11844 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableParagraph}
11846 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableCell}
11847 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableParagraph}
11849 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableCell}
11850 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableParagraph}
11852 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableCell}
11853 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableParagraph}
11855 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableCell}
11856 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableParagraph}
11858 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableCell}
11859 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableParagraph}
11861 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableCell}
11862 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
11864 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableCell}
11865 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableParagraph}
11868 To create a table template with the name @samp{Custom}, define the above
11870 @code{<office:automatic-styles>}...@code{</office:automatic-styles>} element
11871 of the content template file (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory
11875 Define a table style@footnote{See the attributes @code{table:template-name},
11876 @code{table:use-first-row-styles}, @code{table:use-last-row-styles},
11877 @code{table:use-first-column-styles}, @code{table:use-last-column-styles},
11878 @code{table:use-banding-rows-styles}, and
11879 @code{table:use-banding-column-styles} of the @code{<table:table>} element in
11880 the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
11882 @vindex org-export-odt-table-styles
11883 To define a table style, create an entry for the style in the variable
11884 @code{org-export-odt-table-styles} and specify the following:
11887 @item the name of the table template created in step (1)
11888 @item the set of cell styles in that template that are to be activated
11891 For example, the entry below defines two different table styles
11892 @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}
11893 based on the same template @samp{Custom}. The styles achieve their intended
11894 effect by selectively activating the individual cell styles in that template.
11897 (setq org-export-odt-table-styles
11898 (append org-export-odt-table-styles
11899 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
11900 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11901 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
11902 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
11903 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11904 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
11908 Associate a table with the table style
11910 To do this, specify the table style created in step (2) as part of
11911 the @code{ATTR_ODT} line as shown below.
11914 #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn"
11915 | Name | Phone | Age |
11916 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
11917 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
11921 @node Validating OpenDocument XML, , Customizing tables in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export
11922 @subsubsection Validating OpenDocument XML
11924 Occasionally, you will discover that the document created by the
11925 ODT exporter cannot be opened by your favorite application. One of
11926 the common reasons for this is that the @file{.odt} file is corrupt. In such
11927 cases, you may want to validate the document against the OpenDocument RELAX
11928 NG Compact Syntax (RNC) schema.
11930 For de-compressing the @file{.odt} file@footnote{@file{.odt} files are
11931 nothing but @samp{zip} archives}: @inforef{File Archives,,emacs}. For
11932 general help with validation (and schema-sensitive editing) of XML files:
11933 @inforef{Introduction,,nxml-mode}.
11935 @vindex org-export-odt-schema-dir
11936 If you have ready access to OpenDocument @file{.rnc} files and the needed
11937 schema-locating rules in a single folder, you can customize the variable
11938 @code{org-export-odt-schema-dir} to point to that directory. The
11939 ODT exporter will take care of updating the
11940 @code{rng-schema-locating-files} for you.
11942 @c end opendocument
11944 @node TaskJuggler export, Freemind export, OpenDocument Text export, Exporting
11945 @section TaskJuggler export
11946 @cindex TaskJuggler export
11947 @cindex Project management
11949 @uref{http://www.taskjuggler.org/, TaskJuggler} is a project management tool.
11950 It provides an optimizing scheduler that computes your project time lines and
11951 resource assignments based on the project outline and the constraints that
11954 The TaskJuggler exporter is a bit different from other exporters, such as the
11955 @code{HTML} and @LaTeX{} exporters for example, in that it does not export all the
11956 nodes of a document or strictly follow the order of the nodes in the
11959 Instead the TaskJuggler exporter looks for a tree that defines the tasks and
11960 a optionally tree that defines the resources for this project. It then
11961 creates a TaskJuggler file based on these trees and the attributes defined in
11964 @subsection TaskJuggler export commands
11967 @orgcmd{C-c C-e j,org-export-as-taskjuggler}
11968 Export as a TaskJuggler file.
11970 @orgcmd{C-c C-e J,org-export-as-taskjuggler-and-open}
11971 Export as a TaskJuggler file and then open the file with TaskJugglerUI.
11976 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag
11977 Create your tasks as you usually do with Org mode. Assign efforts to each
11978 task using properties (it is easiest to do this in the column view). You
11979 should end up with something similar to the example by Peter Jones in
11980 @url{http://www.contextualdevelopment.com/static/artifacts/articles/2008/project-planning/project-planning.org}.
11981 Now mark the top node of your tasks with a tag named
11982 @code{:taskjuggler_project:} (or whatever you customized
11983 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag} to). You are now ready to export
11984 the project plan with @kbd{C-c C-e J} which will export the project plan and
11985 open a gantt chart in TaskJugglerUI.
11987 @subsection Resources
11989 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag
11990 Next you can define resources and assign those to work on specific tasks. You
11991 can group your resources hierarchically. Tag the top node of the resources
11992 with @code{:taskjuggler_resource:} (or whatever you customized
11993 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag} to). You can optionally assign an
11994 identifier (named @samp{resource_id}) to the resources (using the standard
11995 Org properties commands, @pxref{Property syntax}) or you can let the exporter
11996 generate identifiers automatically (the exporter picks the first word of the
11997 headline as the identifier as long as it is unique---see the documentation of
11998 @code{org-taskjuggler-get-unique-id}). Using that identifier you can then
11999 allocate resources to tasks. This is again done with the @samp{allocate}
12000 property on the tasks. Do this in column view or when on the task type
12001 @kbd{C-c C-x p allocate @key{RET} <resource_id> @key{RET}}.
12003 Once the allocations are done you can again export to TaskJuggler and check
12004 in the Resource Allocation Graph which person is working on what task at what
12007 @subsection Export of properties
12009 The exporter also takes TODO state information into consideration, i.e.@: if a
12010 task is marked as done it will have the corresponding attribute in
12011 TaskJuggler (@samp{complete 100}). Also it will export any property on a task
12012 resource or resource node which is known to TaskJuggler, such as
12013 @samp{limits}, @samp{vacation}, @samp{shift}, @samp{booking},
12014 @samp{efficiency}, @samp{journalentry}, @samp{rate} for resources or
12015 @samp{account}, @samp{start}, @samp{note}, @samp{duration}, @samp{end},
12016 @samp{journalentry}, @samp{milestone}, @samp{reference}, @samp{responsible},
12017 @samp{scheduling}, etc for tasks.
12019 @subsection Dependencies
12021 The exporter will handle dependencies that are defined in the tasks either
12022 with the @samp{ORDERED} attribute (@pxref{TODO dependencies}), with the
12023 @samp{BLOCKER} attribute (see @file{org-depend.el}) or alternatively with a
12024 @samp{depends} attribute. Both the @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends}
12025 attribute can be either @samp{previous-sibling} or a reference to an
12026 identifier (named @samp{task_id}) which is defined for another task in the
12027 project. @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends} attribute can define multiple
12028 dependencies separated by either space or comma. You can also specify
12029 optional attributes on the dependency by simply appending it. The following
12030 examples should illustrate this:
12035 :task_id: preparation
12038 * Training material
12040 :task_id: training_material
12043 ** Markup Guidelines
12047 ** Workflow Guidelines
12054 :BLOCKER: training_material @{ gapduration 1d @} preparation
12058 @subsection Reports
12060 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports
12061 TaskJuggler can produce many kinds of reports (e.g.@: gantt chart, resource
12062 allocation, etc). The user defines what kind of reports should be generated
12063 for a project in the TaskJuggler file. The exporter will automatically insert
12064 some default reports in the file. These defaults are defined in
12065 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports}. They can be modified using
12066 customize along with a number of other options. For a more complete list, see
12067 @kbd{M-x customize-group @key{RET} org-export-taskjuggler @key{RET}}.
12069 For more information and examples see the Org-taskjuggler tutorial at
12070 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-taskjuggler.html}.
12072 @node Freemind export, XOXO export, TaskJuggler export, Exporting
12073 @section Freemind export
12074 @cindex Freemind export
12077 The Freemind exporter was written by Lennart Borgman.
12080 @orgcmd{C-c C-e m,org-export-as-freemind}
12081 Export as a Freemind mind map. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the Freemind
12082 file will be @file{myfile.mm}.
12085 @node XOXO export, iCalendar export, Freemind export, Exporting
12086 @section XOXO export
12087 @cindex XOXO export
12089 Org mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
12090 Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
12091 does not interpret any additional Org mode features.
12094 @orgcmd{C-c C-e x,org-export-as-xoxo}
12095 Export as an XOXO file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the XOXO file will be
12096 @file{myfile.html}.
12097 @orgkey{C-c C-e v x}
12098 Export only the visible part of the document.
12101 @node iCalendar export, , XOXO export, Exporting
12102 @section iCalendar export
12103 @cindex iCalendar export
12105 @vindex org-icalendar-include-todo
12106 @vindex org-icalendar-use-deadline
12107 @vindex org-icalendar-use-scheduled
12108 @vindex org-icalendar-categories
12109 @vindex org-icalendar-alarm-time
12110 Some people use Org mode for keeping track of projects, but still prefer a
12111 standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments. In this
12112 case it can be useful to show deadlines and other time-stamped items in Org
12113 files in the calendar application. Org mode can export calendar information
12114 in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to have TODO entries
12115 included in the export, configure the variable
12116 @code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. Plain timestamps are exported as VEVENT,
12117 and TODO items as VTODO. It will also create events from deadlines that are
12118 in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO items will be used
12119 to set the start and due dates for the TODO entry@footnote{See the variables
12120 @code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}.
12121 As categories, it will use the tags locally defined in the heading, and the
12122 file/tree category@footnote{To add inherited tags or the TODO state,
12123 configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-categories}.}. See the variable
12124 @code{org-icalendar-alarm-time} for a way to assign alarms to entries with a
12127 @vindex org-icalendar-store-UID
12128 @cindex property, ID
12129 The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
12130 identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
12131 the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
12132 @code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
12133 entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
12134 a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
12135 prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
12136 In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
12137 figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
12140 @orgcmd{C-c C-e i,org-export-icalendar-this-file}
12141 Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same
12142 directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
12143 @orgcmd{C-c C-e I, org-export-icalendar-all-agenda-files}
12144 @vindex org-agenda-files
12145 Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in
12146 @code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
12147 file will be written.
12148 @orgcmd{C-c C-e c,org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files}
12149 @vindex org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file
12150 Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
12151 @code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
12152 @code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}.
12155 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
12156 @vindex org-icalendar-include-body
12157 @cindex property, SUMMARY
12158 @cindex property, DESCRIPTION
12159 @cindex property, LOCATION
12160 The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
12161 property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
12162 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
12163 entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
12164 and the description from the body (limited to
12165 @code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
12167 How this calendar is best read and updated, depends on the application
12168 you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
12170 @node Publishing, Working With Source Code, Exporting, Top
12171 @chapter Publishing
12174 Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure
12175 automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of interlinked org
12176 files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML
12177 pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web
12180 You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF
12181 conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server.
12183 Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
12186 * Configuration:: Defining projects
12187 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
12188 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
12189 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
12192 @node Configuration, Uploading files, Publishing, Publishing
12193 @section Configuration
12195 Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
12196 and many other properties of a project.
12199 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
12200 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
12201 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
12202 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
12203 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
12204 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
12205 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
12206 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
12209 @node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
12210 @subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
12211 @cindex org-publish-project-alist
12212 @cindex projects, for publishing
12214 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
12215 Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one
12216 variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. Each element of the list
12217 configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms:
12220 ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
12221 @r{i.e.@: a well-formed property list with alternating keys and values}
12223 ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
12227 In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A
12228 project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as the
12229 publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project
12230 takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the
12231 @code{:components} property are taken to be sub-projects, which group
12232 together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such
12233 a ``meta-project'', all the components will also be published, in the
12236 @node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
12237 @subsection Sources and destinations for files
12238 @cindex directories, for publishing
12240 Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
12241 particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files,
12242 and where to put published files.
12244 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
12245 @item @code{:base-directory}
12246 @tab Directory containing publishing source files
12247 @item @code{:publishing-directory}
12248 @tab Directory where output files will be published. You can directly
12249 publish to a webserver using a file name syntax appropriate for
12250 the Emacs @file{tramp} package. Or you can publish to a local directory and
12251 use external tools to upload your website (@pxref{Uploading files}).
12252 @item @code{:preparation-function}
12253 @tab Function or list of functions to be called before starting the
12254 publishing process, for example, to run @code{make} for updating files to be
12255 published. The project property list is scoped into this call as the
12256 variable @code{project-plist}.
12257 @item @code{:completion-function}
12258 @tab Function or list of functions called after finishing the publishing
12259 process, for example, to change permissions of the resulting files. The
12260 project property list is scoped into this call as the variable
12261 @code{project-plist}.
12265 @node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
12266 @subsection Selecting files
12267 @cindex files, selecting for publishing
12269 By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
12270 are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
12272 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12273 @item @code{:base-extension}
12274 @tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
12275 regular expression. Set this to the symbol @code{any} if you want to get all
12276 files in @code{:base-directory}, even without extension.
12278 @item @code{:exclude}
12279 @tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
12280 published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
12283 @item @code{:include}
12284 @tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
12285 and @code{:exclude}.
12287 @item @code{:recursive}
12288 @tab Non-nil means, check base-directory recursively for files to publish.
12291 @node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
12292 @subsection Publishing action
12293 @cindex action, for publishing
12295 Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
12296 possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
12297 Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
12298 @code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
12299 export}). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using
12300 @code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}, or as @code{ascii}, @code{latin1} or
12301 @code{utf8} encoded files using the corresponding functions. If you want to
12302 publish the Org file itself, but with @i{archived}, @i{commented}, and
12303 @i{tag-excluded} trees removed, use @code{org-publish-org-to-org} and set the
12304 parameters @code{:plain-source} and/or @code{:htmlized-source}. This will
12305 produce @file{file.org} and @file{file.org.html} in the publishing
12306 directory@footnote{@file{file-source.org} and @file{file-source.org.html} if
12307 source and publishing directories are equal. Note that with this kind of
12308 setup, you need to add @code{:exclude "-source\\.org"} to the project
12309 definition in @code{org-publish-project-alist} to prevent the published
12310 source files from being considered as new org files the next time the project
12311 is published.}. Other files like images only need to be copied to the
12312 publishing destination; for this you may use @code{org-publish-attachment}.
12313 For non-Org files, you always need to specify the publishing function:
12315 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
12316 @item @code{:publishing-function}
12317 @tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
12318 list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
12319 @item @code{:plain-source}
12320 @tab Non-nil means, publish plain source.
12321 @item @code{:htmlized-source}
12322 @tab Non-nil means, publish htmlized source.
12325 The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing at least
12326 a @code{:publishing-directory} property, the name of the file to be
12327 published, and the path to the publishing directory of the output file. It
12328 should take the specified file, make the necessary transformation (if any)
12329 and place the result into the destination folder.
12331 @node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
12332 @subsection Options for the HTML/@LaTeX{} exporters
12333 @cindex options, for publishing
12335 The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
12336 and @LaTeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
12337 variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
12338 with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
12339 respective variable for details.
12341 @vindex org-export-html-link-up
12342 @vindex org-export-html-link-home
12343 @vindex org-export-default-language
12344 @vindex org-display-custom-times
12345 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
12346 @vindex org-export-with-section-numbers
12347 @vindex org-export-section-number-format
12348 @vindex org-export-with-toc
12349 @vindex org-export-preserve-breaks
12350 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
12351 @vindex org-export-with-emphasize
12352 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
12353 @vindex org-export-with-special-strings
12354 @vindex org-export-with-footnotes
12355 @vindex org-export-with-drawers
12356 @vindex org-export-with-tags
12357 @vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords
12358 @vindex org-export-with-tasks
12359 @vindex org-export-with-done-tasks
12360 @vindex org-export-with-priority
12361 @vindex org-export-with-TeX-macros
12362 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
12363 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
12364 @vindex org-export-with-fixed-width
12365 @vindex org-export-with-timestamps
12366 @vindex org-export-author-info
12367 @vindex org-export-email-info
12368 @vindex org-export-creator-info
12369 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
12370 @vindex org-export-with-tables
12371 @vindex org-export-highlight-first-table-line
12372 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
12373 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-scripts
12374 @vindex org-export-html-style
12375 @vindex org-export-html-style-extra
12376 @vindex org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html
12377 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
12378 @vindex org-export-html-extension
12379 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
12380 @vindex org-export-html-expand
12381 @vindex org-export-html-with-timestamp
12382 @vindex org-export-publishing-directory
12383 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
12384 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
12385 @vindex user-full-name
12386 @vindex user-mail-address
12387 @vindex org-export-select-tags
12388 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
12390 @multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
12391 @item @code{:link-up} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-up}
12392 @item @code{:link-home} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-home}
12393 @item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
12394 @item @code{:customtime} @tab @code{org-display-custom-times}
12395 @item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
12396 @item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
12397 @item @code{:section-number-format} @tab @code{org-export-section-number-format}
12398 @item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
12399 @item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
12400 @item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
12401 @item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
12402 @item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
12403 @item @code{:special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
12404 @item @code{:footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
12405 @item @code{:drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
12406 @item @code{:tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
12407 @item @code{:todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
12408 @item @code{:tasks} @tab @code{org-export-with-tasks}
12409 @item @code{:priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
12410 @item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros}
12411 @item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}
12412 @item @code{:latex-listings} @tab @code{org-export-latex-listings}
12413 @item @code{:skip-before-1st-heading} @tab @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading}
12414 @item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
12415 @item @code{:timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
12416 @item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name}
12417 @item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address} : @code{addr;addr;..}
12418 @item @code{:author-info} @tab @code{org-export-author-info}
12419 @item @code{:email-info} @tab @code{org-export-email-info}
12420 @item @code{:creator-info} @tab @code{org-export-creator-info}
12421 @item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
12422 @item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line}
12423 @item @code{:style-include-default} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}
12424 @item @code{:style-include-scripts} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-scripts}
12425 @item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style}
12426 @item @code{:style-extra} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-extra}
12427 @item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html}
12428 @item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images}
12429 @item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-export-html-extension}
12430 @item @code{:html-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble}
12431 @item @code{:html-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble}
12432 @item @code{:xml-declaration} @tab @code{org-export-html-xml-declaration}
12433 @item @code{:html-table-tag} @tab @code{org-export-html-table-tag}
12434 @item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand}
12435 @item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp}
12436 @item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
12437 @item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
12438 @item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
12439 @item @code{:latex-image-options} @tab @code{org-export-latex-image-default-option}
12442 Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in
12443 both HTML and @LaTeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and
12444 @code{:LaTeX-fragments} options, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the
12445 @LaTeX{} export. See @code{org-export-plist-vars} to check this list of
12450 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
12451 When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist},
12452 its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if
12453 any) during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export
12454 options}), however, override everything.
12456 @node Publishing links, Sitemap, Publishing options, Configuration
12457 @subsection Links between published files
12458 @cindex links, publishing
12460 To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use
12461 something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply
12462 @samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). When published, this link
12463 becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the
12464 pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when
12465 you publish them to HTML. If you also publish the Org source file and want
12466 to link to that, use an @code{http:} link instead of a @code{file:} link,
12467 because @code{file:} links are converted to link to the corresponding
12470 You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful
12471 with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload
12472 the related files, these links will work too. See @ref{Complex example}, for
12473 an example of this usage.
12475 Sometimes an Org file to be published may contain links that are
12476 only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
12477 location. In this case, use the property
12479 @multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6
12480 @item @code{:link-validation-function}
12481 @tab Function to validate links
12485 to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
12486 accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
12487 the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
12488 function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a
12489 description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
12490 function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given
12491 file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
12493 @node Sitemap, Generating an index, Publishing links, Configuration
12494 @subsection Generating a sitemap
12495 @cindex sitemap, of published pages
12497 The following properties may be used to control publishing of
12498 a map of files for a given project.
12500 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.65
12501 @item @code{:auto-sitemap}
12502 @tab When non-nil, publish a sitemap during @code{org-publish-current-project}
12503 or @code{org-publish-all}.
12505 @item @code{:sitemap-filename}
12506 @tab Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to @file{sitemap.org} (which
12507 becomes @file{sitemap.html}).
12509 @item @code{:sitemap-title}
12510 @tab Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of file.
12512 @item @code{:sitemap-function}
12513 @tab Plug-in function to use for generation of the sitemap.
12514 Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-sitemap}, which generates a plain list
12515 of links to all files in the project.
12517 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-folders}
12518 @tab Where folders should appear in the sitemap. Set this to @code{first}
12519 (default) or @code{last} to display folders first or last,
12520 respectively. Any other value will mix files and folders.
12522 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-files}
12523 @tab How the files are sorted in the site map. Set this to
12524 @code{alphabetically} (default), @code{chronologically} or
12525 @code{anti-chronologically}. @code{chronologically} sorts the files with
12526 older date first while @code{anti-chronologically} sorts the files with newer
12527 date first. @code{alphabetically} sorts the files alphabetically. The date of
12528 a file is retrieved with @code{org-publish-find-date}.
12530 @item @code{:sitemap-ignore-case}
12531 @tab Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default @code{nil}.
12533 @item @code{:sitemap-file-entry-format}
12534 @tab With this option one can tell how a sitemap's entry is formatted in the
12535 sitemap. This is a format string with some escape sequences: @code{%t} stands
12536 for the title of the file, @code{%a} stands for the author of the file and
12537 @code{%d} stands for the date of the file. The date is retrieved with the
12538 @code{org-publish-find-date} function and formatted with
12539 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format}. Default @code{%t}.
12541 @item @code{:sitemap-date-format}
12542 @tab Format string for the @code{format-time-string} function that tells how
12543 a sitemap entry's date is to be formatted. This property bypasses
12544 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format} which defaults to @code{%Y-%m-%d}.
12546 @item @code{:sitemap-sans-extension}
12547 @tab When non-nil, remove filenames' extensions from the generated sitemap.
12548 Useful to have cool URIs (see @uref{http://www.w3.org/Provider/Style/URI}).
12549 Defaults to @code{nil}.
12553 @node Generating an index, , Sitemap, Configuration
12554 @subsection Generating an index
12555 @cindex index, in a publishing project
12557 Org mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project.
12559 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12560 @item @code{:makeindex}
12561 @tab When non-nil, generate in index in the file @file{theindex.org} and
12562 publish it as @file{theindex.html}.
12565 The file will be created when first publishing a project with the
12566 @code{:makeindex} set. The file only contains a statement @code{#+INCLUDE:
12567 "theindex.inc"}. You can then build around this include statement by adding
12568 a title, style information, etc.
12570 @node Uploading files, Sample configuration, Configuration, Publishing
12571 @section Uploading files
12575 For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
12576 @command{rsync} or @command{unison}, it might be preferable not to use the built in
12577 @i{remote} publishing facilities of Org mode which rely heavily on
12578 Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be
12579 so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems
12582 Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition
12583 to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute
12584 checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local
12585 directory (possibly even @i{in place} with your Org files) and then use
12586 @file{unison} or @file{rsync} to do the synchronization with the remote host.
12588 Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to transfer to
12589 a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing
12590 definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org
12591 files with @code{org-publish} and let the synchronization tool do the rest.
12592 You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as @file{jpg},
12593 @file{css} or @file{gif} files in the project definition since the 3rd party
12596 Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so
12597 that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set
12598 @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag} to @code{nil}, you gain the main
12599 benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example
12600 files you might include with @code{#+INCLUDE:}. The timestamp mechanism in
12601 Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified.
12603 @node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Uploading files, Publishing
12604 @section Sample configuration
12606 Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
12607 project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
12608 more complex, with a multi-component project.
12611 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
12612 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
12615 @node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
12616 @subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
12618 This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
12619 directory on the local machine.
12622 (setq org-publish-project-alist
12624 :base-directory "~/org/"
12625 :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
12626 :section-numbers nil
12627 :table-of-contents nil
12628 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
12629 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
12630 type=\"text/css\"/>")))
12633 @node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
12634 @subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
12636 This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
12637 Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
12638 style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are
12641 To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
12642 your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
12643 paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
12644 publishable images in @file{~/images}, you would link to an image with
12647 file:../images/myimage.png
12650 On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
12651 same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
12652 right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
12655 (setq org-publish-project-alist
12657 :base-directory "~/org/"
12658 :base-extension "org"
12659 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
12660 :publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
12661 :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
12663 :section-numbers nil
12664 :table-of-contents nil
12665 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
12666 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
12670 :base-directory "~/images/"
12671 :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
12672 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
12673 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
12676 :base-directory "~/other/"
12677 :base-extension "css\\|el"
12678 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
12679 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
12680 ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
12683 @node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
12684 @section Triggering publication
12686 Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
12689 @orgcmd{C-c C-e X,org-publish}
12690 Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
12691 @orgcmd{C-c C-e P,org-publish-current-project}
12692 Publish the project containing the current file.
12693 @orgcmd{C-c C-e F,org-publish-current-file}
12694 Publish only the current file.
12695 @orgcmd{C-c C-e E,org-publish-all}
12696 Publish every project.
12699 @vindex org-publish-use-timestamps-flag
12700 Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions
12701 normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force
12702 publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands
12703 above, or by customizing the variable @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag}.
12704 This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via
12705 @code{#+SETUPFILE:} or @code{#+INCLUDE:}.
12707 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12708 @comment Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
12710 @node Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
12711 @chapter Working with source code
12712 @cindex Schulte, Eric
12713 @cindex Davison, Dan
12714 @cindex source code, working with
12716 Source code can be included in Org mode documents using a @samp{src} block,
12720 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
12721 (defun org-xor (a b)
12727 Org mode provides a number of features for working with live source code,
12728 including editing of code blocks in their native major-mode, evaluation of
12729 code blocks, converting code blocks into source files (known as @dfn{tangling}
12730 in literate programming), and exporting code blocks and their
12731 results in several formats. This functionality was contributed by Eric
12732 Schulte and Dan Davison, and was originally named Org-babel.
12734 The following sections describe Org mode's code block handling facilities.
12737 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
12738 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
12739 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
12740 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
12741 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
12742 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
12743 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
12744 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
12745 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
12746 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
12747 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
12748 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
12751 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12752 @comment Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
12754 @node Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
12755 @section Structure of code blocks
12756 @cindex code block, structure
12757 @cindex source code, block structure
12759 @cindex #+BEGIN_SRC
12761 Live code blocks can be specified with a @samp{src} block or
12762 inline.@footnote{Note that @samp{src} blocks may be inserted using Org mode's
12763 @ref{Easy Templates} system} The structure of a @samp{src} block is
12767 #+BEGIN_SRC <language> <switches> <header arguments>
12772 The @code{#+NAME:} line is optional, and can be used to name the code
12773 block. Live code blocks require that a language be specified on the
12774 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line. Switches and header arguments are optional.
12775 @cindex source code, inline
12777 Live code blocks can also be specified inline using
12780 src_<language>@{<body>@}
12786 src_<language>[<header arguments>]@{<body>@}
12790 @item <#+NAME: name>
12791 This line associates a name with the code block. This is similar to the
12792 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} lines that can be used to name tables in Org mode
12793 files. Referencing the name of a code block makes it possible to evaluate
12794 the block from other places in the file, from other files, or from Org mode
12795 table formulas (see @ref{The spreadsheet}). Names are assumed to be unique
12796 and the behavior of Org mode when two or more blocks share the same name is
12800 The language of the code in the block (see @ref{Languages}).
12801 @cindex source code, language
12803 Optional switches control code block export (see the discussion of switches in
12804 @ref{Literal examples})
12805 @cindex source code, switches
12806 @item <header arguments>
12807 Optional header arguments control many aspects of evaluation, export and
12808 tangling of code blocks (see @ref{Header arguments}).
12809 Header arguments can also be set on a per-buffer or per-subtree
12810 basis using properties.
12811 @item source code, header arguments
12813 Source code in the specified language.
12816 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12817 @comment Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
12819 @node Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
12820 @section Editing source code
12821 @cindex code block, editing
12822 @cindex source code, editing
12825 Use @kbd{C-c '} to edit the current code block. This brings up
12826 a language major-mode edit buffer containing the body of the code
12827 block. Saving this buffer will write the new contents back to the Org
12828 buffer. Use @kbd{C-c '} again to exit.
12830 The @code{org-src-mode} minor mode will be active in the edit buffer. The
12831 following variables can be used to configure the behavior of the edit
12832 buffer. See also the customization group @code{org-edit-structure} for
12833 further configuration options.
12836 @item org-src-lang-modes
12837 If an Emacs major-mode named @code{<lang>-mode} exists, where
12838 @code{<lang>} is the language named in the header line of the code block,
12839 then the edit buffer will be placed in that major-mode. This variable
12840 can be used to map arbitrary language names to existing major modes.
12841 @item org-src-window-setup
12842 Controls the way Emacs windows are rearranged when the edit buffer is created.
12843 @item org-src-preserve-indentation
12844 This variable is especially useful for tangling languages such as
12845 Python, in which whitespace indentation in the output is critical.
12846 @item org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer
12847 By default, Org will ask before returning to an open edit buffer. Set this
12848 variable to nil to switch without asking.
12851 To turn on native code fontification in the @emph{Org} buffer, configure the
12852 variable @code{org-src-fontify-natively}.
12854 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12855 @comment Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
12857 @node Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
12858 @section Exporting code blocks
12859 @cindex code block, exporting
12860 @cindex source code, exporting
12862 It is possible to export the @emph{code} of code blocks, the @emph{results}
12863 of code block evaluation, @emph{both} the code and the results of code block
12864 evaluation, or @emph{none}. For most languages, the default exports code.
12865 However, for some languages (e.g.@: @code{ditaa}) the default exports the
12866 results of code block evaluation. For information on exporting code block
12867 bodies, see @ref{Literal examples}.
12869 The @code{:exports} header argument can be used to specify export
12872 @subsubheading Header arguments:
12874 @item :exports code
12875 The default in most languages. The body of the code block is exported, as
12876 described in @ref{Literal examples}.
12877 @item :exports results
12878 The code block will be evaluated and the results will be placed in the
12879 Org mode buffer for export, either updating previous results of the code
12880 block located anywhere in the buffer or, if no previous results exist,
12881 placing the results immediately after the code block. The body of the code
12882 block will not be exported.
12883 @item :exports both
12884 Both the code block and its results will be exported.
12885 @item :exports none
12886 Neither the code block nor its results will be exported.
12889 It is possible to inhibit the evaluation of code blocks during export.
12890 Setting the @code{org-export-babel-evaluate} variable to @code{nil} will
12891 ensure that no code blocks are evaluated as part of the export process. This
12892 can be useful in situations where potentially untrusted Org mode files are
12893 exported in an automated fashion, for example when Org mode is used as the
12894 markup language for a wiki.
12896 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12897 @comment Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
12898 @node Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
12899 @section Extracting source code
12901 @cindex source code, extracting
12902 @cindex code block, extracting source code
12904 Creating pure source code files by extracting code from source blocks is
12905 referred to as ``tangling''---a term adopted from the literate programming
12906 community. During ``tangling'' of code blocks their bodies are expanded
12907 using @code{org-babel-expand-src-block} which can expand both variable and
12908 ``noweb'' style references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}).
12910 @subsubheading Header arguments
12913 The default. The code block is not included in the tangled output.
12915 Include the code block in the tangled output. The output file name is the
12916 name of the org file with the extension @samp{.org} replaced by the extension
12917 for the block language.
12918 @item :tangle filename
12919 Include the code block in the tangled output to file @samp{filename}.
12923 @subsubheading Functions
12925 @item org-babel-tangle
12926 Tangle the current file. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v t}.
12927 @item org-babel-tangle-file
12928 Choose a file to tangle. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v f}.
12931 @subsubheading Hooks
12933 @item org-babel-post-tangle-hook
12934 This hook is run from within code files tangled by @code{org-babel-tangle}.
12935 Example applications could include post-processing, compilation or evaluation
12936 of tangled code files.
12939 @node Evaluating code blocks, Library of Babel, Extracting source code, Working With Source Code
12940 @section Evaluating code blocks
12941 @cindex code block, evaluating
12942 @cindex source code, evaluating
12945 Code blocks can be evaluated@footnote{Whenever code is evaluated there is a
12946 potential for that code to do harm. Org mode provides safeguards to ensure
12947 that code is only evaluated after explicit confirmation from the user. For
12948 information on these safeguards (and on how to disable them) see @ref{Code
12949 evaluation security}.} and the results of evaluation optionally placed in the
12950 Org mode buffer. The results of evaluation are placed following a line that
12951 begins by default with @code{#+RESULTS} and optionally a cache identifier
12952 and/or the name of the evaluated code block. The default value of
12953 @code{#+RESULTS} can be changed with the customizable variable
12954 @code{org-babel-results-keyword}.
12956 By default, the evaluation facility is only enabled for Lisp code blocks
12957 specified as @code{emacs-lisp}. However, source code blocks in many languages
12958 can be evaluated within Org mode (see @ref{Languages} for a list of supported
12959 languages and @ref{Structure of code blocks} for information on the syntax
12960 used to define a code block).
12963 There are a number of ways to evaluate code blocks. The simplest is to press
12964 @kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{C-c C-v e} with the point on a code block@footnote{The
12965 @code{org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c} variable can be used to remove code
12966 evaluation from the @kbd{C-c C-c} key binding.}. This will call the
12967 @code{org-babel-execute-src-block} function to evaluate the block and insert
12968 its results into the Org mode buffer.
12971 It is also possible to evaluate named code blocks from anywhere in an Org
12972 mode buffer or an Org mode table. Live code blocks located in the current
12973 Org mode buffer or in the ``Library of Babel'' (see @ref{Library of Babel})
12974 can be executed. Named code blocks can be executed with a separate
12975 @code{#+CALL:} line or inline within a block of text.
12977 The syntax of the @code{#+CALL:} line is
12980 #+CALL: <name>(<arguments>)
12981 #+CALL: <name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>) <end header arguments>
12984 The syntax for inline evaluation of named code blocks is
12987 ... call_<name>(<arguments>) ...
12988 ... call_<name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>)[<end header arguments>] ...
12993 The name of the code block to be evaluated (see @ref{Structure of code blocks}).
12995 Arguments specified in this section will be passed to the code block. These
12996 arguments use standard function call syntax, rather than
12997 header argument syntax. For example, a @code{#+CALL:} line that passes the
12998 number four to a code block named @code{double}, which declares the header
12999 argument @code{:var n=2}, would be written as @code{#+CALL: double(n=4)}.
13000 @item <inside header arguments>
13001 Inside header arguments are passed through and applied to the named code
13002 block. These arguments use header argument syntax rather than standard
13003 function call syntax. Inside header arguments affect how the code block is
13004 evaluated. For example, @code{[:results output]} will collect the results of
13005 everything printed to @code{STDOUT} during execution of the code block.
13006 @item <end header arguments>
13007 End header arguments are applied to the calling instance and do not affect
13008 evaluation of the named code block. They affect how the results are
13009 incorporated into the Org mode buffer and how the call line is exported. For
13010 example, @code{:results html} will insert the results of the call line
13011 evaluation in the Org buffer, wrapped in a @code{BEGIN_HTML:} block.
13013 For more examples of passing header arguments to @code{#+CALL:} lines see
13014 @ref{Header arguments in function calls}.
13017 @node Library of Babel, Languages, Evaluating code blocks, Working With Source Code
13018 @section Library of Babel
13019 @cindex babel, library of
13020 @cindex source code, library
13021 @cindex code block, library
13023 The ``Library of Babel'' consists of code blocks that can be called from any
13024 Org mode file. Code blocks defined in the ``Library of Babel'' can be called
13025 remotely as if they were in the current Org mode buffer (see @ref{Evaluating
13026 code blocks} for information on the syntax of remote code block evaluation).
13029 The central repository of code blocks in the ``Library of Babel'' is housed
13030 in an Org mode file located in the @samp{contrib} directory of Org mode.
13032 Users can add code blocks they believe to be generally useful to their
13033 ``Library of Babel.'' The code blocks can be stored in any Org mode file and
13034 then loaded into the library with @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}.
13038 Code blocks located in any Org mode file can be loaded into the ``Library of
13039 Babel'' with the @code{org-babel-lob-ingest} function, bound to @kbd{C-c C-v
13042 @node Languages, Header arguments, Library of Babel, Working With Source Code
13044 @cindex babel, languages
13045 @cindex source code, languages
13046 @cindex code block, languages
13048 Code blocks in the following languages are supported.
13050 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.3 0.22 0.2
13051 @item @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier} @tab @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier}
13052 @item Asymptote @tab asymptote @tab Awk @tab awk
13053 @item Emacs Calc @tab calc @tab C @tab C
13054 @item C++ @tab C++ @tab Clojure @tab clojure
13055 @item CSS @tab css @tab ditaa @tab ditaa
13056 @item Graphviz @tab dot @tab Emacs Lisp @tab emacs-lisp
13057 @item gnuplot @tab gnuplot @tab Haskell @tab haskell
13058 @item Java @tab java @tab @tab
13059 @item Javascript @tab js @tab LaTeX @tab latex
13060 @item Ledger @tab ledger @tab Lisp @tab lisp
13061 @item Lilypond @tab lilypond @tab MATLAB @tab matlab
13062 @item Mscgen @tab mscgen @tab Objective Caml @tab ocaml
13063 @item Octave @tab octave @tab Org mode @tab org
13064 @item Oz @tab oz @tab Perl @tab perl
13065 @item Plantuml @tab plantuml @tab Python @tab python
13066 @item R @tab R @tab Ruby @tab ruby
13067 @item Sass @tab sass @tab Scheme @tab scheme
13068 @item GNU Screen @tab screen @tab shell @tab sh
13069 @item SQL @tab sql @tab SQLite @tab sqlite
13072 Language-specific documentation is available for some languages. If
13073 available, it can be found at
13074 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages.html}.
13076 The @code{org-babel-load-languages} controls which languages are enabled for
13077 evaluation (by default only @code{emacs-lisp} is enabled). This variable can
13078 be set using the customization interface or by adding code like the following
13079 to your emacs configuration.
13082 The following disables @code{emacs-lisp} evaluation and enables evaluation of
13083 @code{R} code blocks.
13087 (org-babel-do-load-languages
13088 'org-babel-load-languages
13089 '((emacs-lisp . nil)
13093 It is also possible to enable support for a language by loading the related
13094 elisp file with @code{require}.
13097 The following adds support for evaluating @code{clojure} code blocks.
13101 (require 'ob-clojure)
13104 @node Header arguments, Results of evaluation, Languages, Working With Source Code
13105 @section Header arguments
13106 @cindex code block, header arguments
13107 @cindex source code, block header arguments
13109 Code block functionality can be configured with header arguments. This
13110 section provides an overview of the use of header arguments, and then
13111 describes each header argument in detail.
13114 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
13115 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
13118 @node Using header arguments, Specific header arguments, Header arguments, Header arguments
13119 @subsection Using header arguments
13121 The values of header arguments can be set in six different ways, each more
13122 specific (and having higher priority) than the last.
13124 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
13125 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
13126 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
13127 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
13128 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
13129 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
13133 @node System-wide header arguments, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments, Using header arguments
13134 @subsubheading System-wide header arguments
13135 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
13136 System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by customizing the
13137 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} variable:
13141 :results => "replace"
13148 @c org-babel-default-header-args is a variable defined in `org-babel.el'.
13150 @c ((:session . "none")
13151 @c (:results . "replace")
13152 @c (:exports . "code")
13154 @c (:noweb . "no"))
13158 @c Default arguments to use when evaluating a code block.
13161 For example, the following example could be used to set the default value of
13162 @code{:noweb} header arguments to @code{yes}. This would have the effect of
13163 expanding @code{:noweb} references by default when evaluating source code
13167 (setq org-babel-default-header-args
13168 (cons '(:noweb . "yes")
13169 (assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args)))
13172 @node Language-specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, System-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
13173 @subsubheading Language-specific header arguments
13174 Each language can define its own set of default header arguments. See the
13175 language-specific documentation available online at
13176 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel}.
13178 @node Buffer-wide header arguments, Header arguments in Org mode properties, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments
13179 @subsubheading Buffer-wide header arguments
13180 Buffer-wide header arguments may be specified as properties through the use
13181 of @code{#+PROPERTY:} lines placed anywhere in an Org mode file (see
13182 @ref{Property syntax}).
13184 For example the following would set @code{session} to @code{*R*}, and
13185 @code{results} to @code{silent} for every code block in the buffer, ensuring
13186 that all execution took place in the same session, and no results would be
13187 inserted into the buffer.
13190 #+PROPERTY: session *R*
13191 #+PROPERTY: results silent
13194 @node Header arguments in Org mode properties, Code block specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
13195 @subsubheading Header arguments in Org mode properties
13197 Header arguments are also read from Org mode properties (see @ref{Property
13198 syntax}), which can be set on a buffer-wide or per-heading basis. An example
13199 of setting a header argument for all code blocks in a buffer is
13202 #+PROPERTY: tangle yes
13205 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
13206 When properties are used to set default header arguments, they are looked up
13207 with inheritance, regardless of the value of
13208 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. In the following example the value of
13209 the @code{:cache} header argument will default to @code{yes} in all code
13210 blocks in the subtree rooted at the following heading:
13220 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
13221 Properties defined in this way override the properties set in
13222 @code{org-babel-default-header-args}. It is convenient to use the
13223 @code{org-set-property} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-x p} to set properties
13224 in Org mode documents.
13226 @node Code block specific header arguments, Header arguments in function calls, Header arguments in Org mode properties, Using header arguments
13227 @subsubheading Code block specific header arguments
13229 The most common way to assign values to header arguments is at the
13230 code block level. This can be done by listing a sequence of header
13231 arguments and their values as part of the @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line.
13232 Properties set in this way override both the values of
13233 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} and header arguments specified as
13234 properties. In the following example, the @code{:results} header argument
13235 is set to @code{silent}, meaning the results of execution will not be
13236 inserted in the buffer, and the @code{:exports} header argument is set to
13237 @code{code}, meaning only the body of the code block will be
13238 preserved on export to HTML or @LaTeX{}.
13242 #+BEGIN_SRC haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0
13244 fac n = n * fac (n-1)
13247 Similarly, it is possible to set header arguments for inline code blocks
13250 src_haskell[:exports both]@{fac 5@}
13253 Code block header arguments can span multiple lines using @code{#+HEADER:} or
13254 @code{#+HEADERS:} lines preceding a code block or nested between the
13255 @code{#+NAME:} line and the @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line of a named code block.
13259 Multi-line header arguments on an un-named code block:
13261 #+HEADERS: :var data1=1
13262 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data2=2
13263 (message "data1:%S, data2:%S" data1 data2)
13270 Multi-line header arguments on a named code block:
13272 #+NAME: named-block
13273 #+HEADER: :var data=2
13274 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13275 (message "data:%S" data)
13278 #+RESULTS: named-block
13282 @node Header arguments in function calls, , Code block specific header arguments, Using header arguments
13283 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
13284 @subsubheading Header arguments in function calls
13286 At the most specific level, header arguments for ``Library of Babel'' or
13287 @code{#+CALL:} lines can be set as shown in the two examples below. For more
13288 information on the structure of @code{#+CALL:} lines see @ref{Evaluating code
13291 The following will apply the @code{:exports results} header argument to the
13292 evaluation of the @code{#+CALL:} line.
13294 #+CALL: factorial(n=5) :exports results
13297 The following will apply the @code{:session special} header argument to the
13298 evaluation of the @code{factorial} code block.
13300 #+CALL: factorial[:session special](n=5)
13303 @node Specific header arguments, , Using header arguments, Header arguments
13304 @subsection Specific header arguments
13305 Header arguments consist of an initial colon followed by the name of the
13306 argument in lowercase letters. The following header arguments are defined:
13309 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
13310 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
13311 be collected and handled
13312 * file:: Specify a path for file output
13313 * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results
13314 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
13315 directory for code block execution
13316 * exports:: Export code and/or results
13317 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
13318 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
13319 files during tangling
13320 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
13322 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
13324 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
13325 expansion during tangling
13326 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
13327 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
13328 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
13329 * noweb-sep:: String used to separate noweb references
13330 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
13331 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
13332 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
13333 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
13334 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
13335 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
13336 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
13337 * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results
13340 Additional header arguments are defined on a language-specific basis, see
13343 @node var, results, Specific header arguments, Specific header arguments
13344 @subsubsection @code{:var}
13345 The @code{:var} header argument is used to pass arguments to code blocks.
13346 The specifics of how arguments are included in a code block vary by language;
13347 these are addressed in the language-specific documentation. However, the
13348 syntax used to specify arguments is the same across all languages. In every
13349 case, variables require a default value when they are declared.
13351 The values passed to arguments can either be literal values, references, or
13352 Emacs Lisp code (see @ref{var, Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables}). References
13353 include anything in the Org mode file that takes a @code{#+NAME:},
13354 @code{#+TBLNAME:}, or @code{#+RESULTS:} line. This includes tables, lists,
13355 @code{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE} blocks, other code blocks, and the results of other
13358 Argument values can be indexed in a manner similar to arrays (see @ref{var,
13359 Indexable variable values}).
13361 The following syntax is used to pass arguments to code blocks using the
13362 @code{:var} header argument.
13368 The argument, @code{assign}, can either be a literal value, such as a string
13369 @samp{"string"} or a number @samp{9}, or a reference to a table, a list, a
13370 literal example, another code block (with or without arguments), or the
13371 results of evaluating another code block.
13373 Here are examples of passing values by reference:
13378 an Org mode table named with either a @code{#+NAME:} or @code{#+TBLNAME:} line
13380 #+TBLNAME: example-table
13386 #+NAME: table-length
13387 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var table=example-table
13391 #+RESULTS: table-length
13396 a simple list named with a @code{#+NAME:} line (note that nesting is not
13397 carried through to the source code block)
13400 #+NAME: example-list
13406 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=example-list
13414 @item code block without arguments
13415 a code block name (from the example above), as assigned by @code{#+NAME:},
13416 optionally followed by parentheses
13419 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var length=table-length()
13427 @item code block with arguments
13428 a code block name, as assigned by @code{#+NAME:}, followed by parentheses and
13429 optional arguments passed within the parentheses following the
13430 code block name using standard function call syntax
13434 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=8
13442 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=1)
13450 @item literal example
13451 a literal example block named with a @code{#+NAME:} line
13454 #+NAME: literal-example
13460 #+NAME: read-literal-example
13461 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=literal-example
13462 (concatenate 'string x " for you.")
13465 #+RESULTS: read-literal-example
13466 : A literal example
13467 : on two lines for you.
13473 @subsubheading Alternate argument syntax
13474 It is also possible to specify arguments in a potentially more natural way
13475 using the @code{#+NAME:} line of a code block. As in the following
13476 example, arguments can be packed inside of parentheses, separated by commas,
13477 following the source name.
13480 #+NAME: double(input=0, x=2)
13481 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13486 @subsubheading Indexable variable values
13487 It is possible to reference portions of variable values by ``indexing'' into
13488 the variables. Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting back from
13489 the end. If an index is separated by @code{,}s then each subsequent section
13490 will index into the next deepest nesting or dimension of the value. Note
13491 that this indexing occurs @emph{before} other table related header arguments
13492 like @code{:hlines}, @code{:colnames} and @code{:rownames} are applied. The
13493 following example assigns the last cell of the first row the table
13494 @code{example-table} to the variable @code{data}:
13497 #+NAME: example-table
13503 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1]
13511 Ranges of variable values can be referenced using two integers separated by a
13512 @code{:}, in which case the entire inclusive range is referenced. For
13513 example the following assigns the middle three rows of @code{example-table}
13517 #+NAME: example-table
13524 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3]
13534 Additionally, an empty index, or the single character @code{*}, are both
13535 interpreted to mean the entire range and as such are equivalent to
13536 @code{0:-1}, as shown in the following example in which the entire first
13537 column is referenced.
13540 #+NAME: example-table
13546 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0]
13554 It is possible to index into the results of code blocks as well as tables.
13555 Any number of dimensions can be indexed. Dimensions are separated from one
13556 another by commas, as shown in the following example.
13560 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13561 '(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9))
13562 ((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18))
13563 ((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27)))
13566 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1]
13574 @subsubheading Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables
13576 Emacs lisp code can be used to initialize variable values. When a variable
13577 value starts with @code{(}, @code{[}, @code{'} or @code{`} it will be
13578 evaluated as Emacs Lisp and the result of the evaluation will be assigned as
13579 the variable value. The following example demonstrates use of this
13580 evaluation to reliably pass the file-name of the Org mode buffer to a code
13581 block---note that evaluation of header arguments is guaranteed to take place
13582 in the original Org mode file, while there is no such guarantee for
13583 evaluation of the code block body.
13586 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :var filename=(buffer-file-name) :exports both
13591 Note that values read from tables and lists will not be evaluated as
13592 Emacs Lisp, as shown in the following example.
13598 #+HEADERS: :var data=table[0,0]
13607 @node results, file, var, Specific header arguments
13608 @subsubsection @code{:results}
13610 There are three classes of @code{:results} header argument. Only one option
13611 per class may be supplied per code block.
13615 @b{collection} header arguments specify how the results should be collected
13616 from the code block
13618 @b{type} header arguments specify what type of result the code block will
13619 return---which has implications for how they will be inserted into the
13622 @b{handling} header arguments specify how the results of evaluating the code
13623 block should be handled.
13626 @subsubheading Collection
13627 The following options are mutually exclusive, and specify how the results
13628 should be collected from the code block.
13632 This is the default. The result is the value of the last statement in the
13633 code block. This header argument places the evaluation in functional
13634 mode. Note that in some languages, e.g., Python, use of this result type
13635 requires that a @code{return} statement be included in the body of the source
13636 code block. E.g., @code{:results value}.
13637 @item @code{output}
13638 The result is the collection of everything printed to STDOUT during the
13639 execution of the code block. This header argument places the
13640 evaluation in scripting mode. E.g., @code{:results output}.
13643 @subsubheading Type
13645 The following options are mutually exclusive and specify what type of results
13646 the code block will return. By default, results are inserted as either a
13647 table or scalar depending on their value.
13650 @item @code{table}, @code{vector}
13651 The results should be interpreted as an Org mode table. If a single value is
13652 returned, it will be converted into a table with one row and one column.
13653 E.g., @code{:results value table}.
13655 The results should be interpreted as an Org mode list. If a single scalar
13656 value is returned it will be converted into a list with only one element.
13657 @item @code{scalar}, @code{verbatim}
13658 The results should be interpreted literally---they will not be
13659 converted into a table. The results will be inserted into the Org mode
13660 buffer as quoted text. E.g., @code{:results value verbatim}.
13662 The results will be interpreted as the path to a file, and will be inserted
13663 into the Org mode buffer as a file link. E.g., @code{:results value file}.
13665 The results are interpreted as raw Org mode code and are inserted directly
13666 into the buffer. If the results look like a table they will be aligned as
13667 such by Org mode. E.g., @code{:results value raw}.
13669 The results are will be enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_SRC org} block.
13670 They are not comma-escaped by default but they will be if you hit @kbd{TAB}
13671 in the block and/or if you export the file. E.g., @code{:results value org}.
13673 Results are assumed to be HTML and will be enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_HTML}
13674 block. E.g., @code{:results value html}.
13676 Results assumed to be @LaTeX{} and are enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_LaTeX} block.
13677 E.g., @code{:results value latex}.
13679 Result are assumed to be parsable code and are enclosed in a code block.
13680 E.g., @code{:results value code}.
13682 The result is converted to pretty-printed code and is enclosed in a code
13683 block. This option currently supports Emacs Lisp, Python, and Ruby. E.g.,
13684 @code{:results value pp}.
13685 @item @code{drawer}
13686 The result is wrapped in a RESULTS drawer. This can be useful for
13687 inserting @code{raw} or @code{org} syntax results in such a way that their
13688 extent is known and they can be automatically removed or replaced.
13691 @subsubheading Handling
13692 The following results options indicate what happens with the
13693 results once they are collected.
13696 @item @code{silent}
13697 The results will be echoed in the minibuffer but will not be inserted into
13698 the Org mode buffer. E.g., @code{:results output silent}.
13699 @item @code{replace}
13700 The default value. Any existing results will be removed, and the new results
13701 will be inserted into the Org mode buffer in their place. E.g.,
13702 @code{:results output replace}.
13703 @item @code{append}
13704 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
13705 be appended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
13706 inserted as with @code{replace}.
13707 @item @code{prepend}
13708 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
13709 be prepended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
13710 inserted as with @code{replace}.
13713 @node file, file-desc, results, Specific header arguments
13714 @subsubsection @code{:file}
13716 The header argument @code{:file} is used to specify an external file in which
13717 to save code block results. After code block evaluation an Org mode style
13718 @code{[[file:]]} link (see @ref{Link format}) to the file will be inserted
13719 into the Org mode buffer. Some languages including R, gnuplot, dot, and
13720 ditaa provide special handling of the @code{:file} header argument
13721 automatically wrapping the code block body in the boilerplate code required
13722 to save output to the specified file. This is often useful for saving
13723 graphical output of a code block to the specified file.
13725 The argument to @code{:file} should be either a string specifying the path to
13726 a file, or a list of two strings in which case the first element of the list
13727 should be the path to a file and the second a description for the link.
13729 @node file-desc, dir, file, Specific header arguments
13730 @subsubsection @code{:file-desc}
13732 The value of the @code{:file-desc} header argument is used to provide a
13733 description for file code block results which are inserted as Org mode links
13734 (see @ref{Link format}). If the @code{:file-desc} header argument is given
13735 with no value the link path will be placed in both the ``link'' and the
13736 ``description'' portion of the Org mode link.
13738 @node dir, exports, file-desc, Specific header arguments
13739 @subsubsection @code{:dir} and remote execution
13741 While the @code{:file} header argument can be used to specify the path to the
13742 output file, @code{:dir} specifies the default directory during code block
13743 execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with the current
13744 buffer is used. In other words, supplying @code{:dir path} temporarily has
13745 the same effect as changing the current directory with @kbd{M-x cd path}, and
13746 then not supplying @code{:dir}. Under the surface, @code{:dir} simply sets
13747 the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}.
13749 When using @code{:dir}, you should supply a relative path for file output
13750 (e.g.@: @code{:file myfile.jpg} or @code{:file results/myfile.jpg}) in which
13751 case that path will be interpreted relative to the default directory.
13753 In other words, if you want your plot to go into a folder called @file{Work}
13754 in your home directory, you could use
13757 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work
13758 matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l")
13762 @subsubheading Remote execution
13763 A directory on a remote machine can be specified using tramp file syntax, in
13764 which case the code will be evaluated on the remote machine. An example is
13767 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file plot.png :dir /dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:
13768 plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE))
13772 Text results will be returned to the local Org mode buffer as usual, and file
13773 output will be created on the remote machine with relative paths interpreted
13774 relative to the remote directory. An Org mode link to the remote file will be
13777 So, in the above example a plot will be created on the remote machine,
13778 and a link of the following form will be inserted in the org buffer:
13781 [[file:/scp:dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]]
13784 Most of this functionality follows immediately from the fact that @code{:dir}
13785 sets the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}, thanks to
13786 tramp. Those using XEmacs, or GNU Emacs prior to version 23 may need to
13787 install tramp separately in order for these features to work correctly.
13789 @subsubheading Further points
13793 If @code{:dir} is used in conjunction with @code{:session}, although it will
13794 determine the starting directory for a new session as expected, no attempt is
13795 currently made to alter the directory associated with an existing session.
13797 @code{:dir} should typically not be used to create files during export with
13798 @code{:exports results} or @code{:exports both}. The reason is that, in order
13799 to retain portability of exported material between machines, during export
13800 links inserted into the buffer will @emph{not} be expanded against @code{default
13801 directory}. Therefore, if @code{default-directory} is altered using
13802 @code{:dir}, it is probable that the file will be created in a location to
13803 which the link does not point.
13806 @node exports, tangle, dir, Specific header arguments
13807 @subsubsection @code{:exports}
13809 The @code{:exports} header argument specifies what should be included in HTML
13810 or @LaTeX{} exports of the Org mode file.
13814 The default. The body of code is included into the exported file. E.g.,
13815 @code{:exports code}.
13816 @item @code{results}
13817 The result of evaluating the code is included in the exported file. E.g.,
13818 @code{:exports results}.
13820 Both the code and results are included in the exported file. E.g.,
13821 @code{:exports both}.
13823 Nothing is included in the exported file. E.g., @code{:exports none}.
13826 @node tangle, mkdirp, exports, Specific header arguments
13827 @subsubsection @code{:tangle}
13829 The @code{:tangle} header argument specifies whether or not the code
13830 block should be included in tangled extraction of source code files.
13833 @item @code{tangle}
13834 The code block is exported to a source code file named after the full path
13835 (including the directory) and file name (w/o extension) of the Org mode file.
13836 E.g., @code{:tangle yes}.
13838 The default. The code block is not exported to a source code file.
13839 E.g., @code{:tangle no}.
13841 Any other string passed to the @code{:tangle} header argument is interpreted
13842 as a path (directory and file name relative to the directory of the Org mode
13843 file) to which the block will be exported. E.g., @code{:tangle path}.
13846 @node mkdirp, comments, tangle, Specific header arguments
13847 @subsubsection @code{:mkdirp}
13849 The @code{:mkdirp} header argument can be used to create parent directories
13850 of tangled files when missing. This can be set to @code{yes} to enable
13851 directory creation or to @code{no} to inhibit directory creation.
13853 @node comments, padline, mkdirp, Specific header arguments
13854 @subsubsection @code{:comments}
13855 By default code blocks are tangled to source-code files without any insertion
13856 of comments beyond those which may already exist in the body of the code
13857 block. The @code{:comments} header argument can be set as follows to control
13858 the insertion of extra comments into the tangled code file.
13862 The default. No extra comments are inserted during tangling.
13864 The code block is wrapped in comments which contain pointers back to the
13865 original Org file from which the code was tangled.
13867 A synonym for ``link'' to maintain backwards compatibility.
13869 Include text from the Org mode file as a comment.
13871 The text is picked from the leading context of the tangled code and is
13872 limited by the nearest headline or source block as the case may be.
13874 Turns on both the ``link'' and ``org'' comment options.
13876 Turns on the ``link'' comment option, and additionally wraps expanded noweb
13877 references in the code block body in link comments.
13880 @node padline, no-expand, comments, Specific header arguments
13881 @subsubsection @code{:padline}
13882 Control in insertion of padding lines around code block bodies in tangled
13883 code files. The default value is @code{yes} which results in insertion of
13884 newlines before and after each tangled code block. The following arguments
13889 Insert newlines before and after each code block body in tangled code files.
13891 Do not insert any newline padding in tangled output.
13894 @node no-expand, session, padline, Specific header arguments
13895 @subsubsection @code{:no-expand}
13897 By default, code blocks are expanded with @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
13898 during tangling. This has the effect of assigning values to variables
13899 specified with @code{:var} (see @ref{var}), and of replacing ``noweb''
13900 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) with their targets. The
13901 @code{:no-expand} header argument can be used to turn off this behavior.
13903 @node session, noweb, no-expand, Specific header arguments
13904 @subsubsection @code{:session}
13906 The @code{:session} header argument starts a session for an interpreted
13907 language where state is preserved.
13909 By default, a session is not started.
13911 A string passed to the @code{:session} header argument will give the session
13912 a name. This makes it possible to run concurrent sessions for each
13913 interpreted language.
13915 @node noweb, noweb-ref, session, Specific header arguments
13916 @subsubsection @code{:noweb}
13918 The @code{:noweb} header argument controls expansion of ``noweb'' syntax
13919 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) when the code block is
13920 evaluated, tangled, or exported. The @code{:noweb} header argument can have
13921 one of the five values: @code{no}, @code{yes}, @code{tangle}, or
13922 @code{no-export} @code{strip-export}.
13926 The default. ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will
13927 not be expanded before the code block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
13929 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
13930 expanded before the code block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
13931 @item @code{tangle}
13932 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13933 before the code block is tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax references will
13934 not be expanded when the code block is evaluated or exported.
13935 @item @code{no-export}
13936 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13937 before the block is evaluated or tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax
13938 references will not be expanded when the code block is exported.
13939 @item @code{strip-export}
13940 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13941 before the block is evaluated or tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax
13942 references will not be removed when the code block is exported.
13944 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will only be
13945 expanded before the block is evaluated.
13948 @subsubheading Noweb prefix lines
13949 Noweb insertions are now placed behind the line prefix of the
13950 @code{<<reference>>}.
13951 This behavior is illustrated in the following example. Because the
13952 @code{<<example>>} noweb reference appears behind the SQL comment syntax,
13953 each line of the expanded noweb reference will be commented.
13966 -- multi-line body of example
13969 Note that noweb replacement text that does not contain any newlines will not
13970 be affected by this change, so it is still possible to use inline noweb
13973 @node noweb-ref, noweb-sep, noweb, Specific header arguments
13974 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-ref}
13975 When expanding ``noweb'' style references the bodies of all code block with
13976 @emph{either} a block name matching the reference name @emph{or} a
13977 @code{:noweb-ref} header argument matching the reference name will be
13978 concatenated together to form the replacement text.
13980 By setting this header argument at the sub-tree or file level, simple code
13981 block concatenation may be achieved. For example, when tangling the
13982 following Org mode file, the bodies of code blocks will be concatenated into
13983 the resulting pure code file@footnote{(The example needs property inheritance
13984 to be turned on for the @code{noweb-ref} property, see @ref{Property
13988 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :tangle yes :noweb yes :shebang #!/bin/sh
13991 * the mount point of the fullest disk
13993 :noweb-ref: fullest-disk
13996 ** query all mounted disks
14001 ** strip the header row
14006 ** sort by the percent full
14008 |awk '@{print $5 " " $6@}'|sort -n |tail -1 \
14011 ** extract the mount point
14013 |awk '@{print $2@}'
14017 The @code{:noweb-sep} (see @ref{noweb-sep}) header argument holds the string
14018 used to separate accumulate noweb references like those above. By default a
14021 @node noweb-sep, cache, noweb-ref, Specific header arguments
14022 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-sep}
14024 The @code{:noweb-sep} header argument holds the string used to separate
14025 accumulate noweb references (see @ref{noweb-ref}). By default a newline is
14028 @node cache, sep, noweb-sep, Specific header arguments
14029 @subsubsection @code{:cache}
14031 The @code{:cache} header argument controls the use of in-buffer caching of
14032 the results of evaluating code blocks. It can be used to avoid re-evaluating
14033 unchanged code blocks. Note that the @code{:cache} header argument will not
14034 attempt to cache results when the @code{:session} header argument is used,
14035 because the results of the code block execution may be stored in the session
14036 outside of the Org mode buffer. The @code{:cache} header argument can have
14037 one of two values: @code{yes} or @code{no}.
14041 The default. No caching takes place, and the code block will be evaluated
14042 every time it is called.
14044 Every time the code block is run a SHA1 hash of the code and arguments
14045 passed to the block will be generated. This hash is packed into the
14046 @code{#+RESULTS:} line and will be checked on subsequent
14047 executions of the code block. If the code block has not
14048 changed since the last time it was evaluated, it will not be re-evaluated.
14051 Code block caches notice if the value of a variable argument
14052 to the code block has changed. If this is the case, the cache is
14053 invalidated and the code block is re-run. In the following example,
14054 @code{caller} will not be re-run unless the results of @code{random} have
14055 changed since it was last run.
14059 #+BEGIN_SRC R :cache yes
14063 #+RESULTS[a2a72cd647ad44515fab62e144796432793d68e1]: random
14067 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=random :cache yes
14071 #+RESULTS[bec9c8724e397d5df3b696502df3ed7892fc4f5f]: caller
14075 @node sep, hlines, cache, Specific header arguments
14076 @subsubsection @code{:sep}
14078 The @code{:sep} header argument can be used to control the delimiter used
14079 when writing tabular results out to files external to Org mode. This is used
14080 either when opening tabular results of a code block by calling the
14081 @code{org-open-at-point} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-o} on the code block,
14082 or when writing code block results to an external file (see @ref{file})
14085 By default, when @code{:sep} is not specified output tables are tab
14088 @node hlines, colnames, sep, Specific header arguments
14089 @subsubsection @code{:hlines}
14091 Tables are frequently represented with one or more horizontal lines, or
14092 hlines. The @code{:hlines} argument to a code block accepts the
14093 values @code{yes} or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
14097 Strips horizontal lines from the input table. In most languages this is the
14098 desired effect because an @code{hline} symbol is interpreted as an unbound
14099 variable and raises an error. Setting @code{:hlines no} or relying on the
14100 default value yields the following results.
14103 #+TBLNAME: many-cols
14111 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols
14115 #+RESULTS: echo-table
14122 Leaves hlines in the table. Setting @code{:hlines yes} has this effect.
14125 #+TBLNAME: many-cols
14133 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes
14137 #+RESULTS: echo-table
14146 @node colnames, rownames, hlines, Specific header arguments
14147 @subsubsection @code{:colnames}
14149 The @code{:colnames} header argument accepts the values @code{yes},
14150 @code{no}, or @code{nil} for unassigned. The default value is @code{nil}.
14151 Note that the behavior of the @code{:colnames} header argument may differ
14152 across languages. For example Emacs Lisp code blocks ignore the
14153 @code{:colnames} header argument entirely given the ease with which tables
14154 with column names may be handled directly in Emacs Lisp.
14158 If an input table looks like it has column names
14159 (because its second row is an hline), then the column
14160 names will be removed from the table before
14161 processing, then reapplied to the results.
14164 #+TBLNAME: less-cols
14170 #+NAME: echo-table-again
14171 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=less-cols
14172 return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab]
14175 #+RESULTS: echo-table-again
14182 Please note that column names are not removed before the table is indexed
14183 using variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
14186 No column name pre-processing takes place
14189 Column names are removed and reapplied as with @code{nil} even if the table
14190 does not ``look like'' it has column names (i.e.@: the second row is not an
14194 @node rownames, shebang, colnames, Specific header arguments
14195 @subsubsection @code{:rownames}
14197 The @code{:rownames} header argument can take on the values @code{yes}
14198 or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
14202 No row name pre-processing will take place.
14205 The first column of the table is removed from the table before processing,
14206 and is then reapplied to the results.
14209 #+TBLNAME: with-rownames
14210 | one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 |
14211 | two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
14213 #+NAME: echo-table-once-again
14214 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes
14215 return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab]
14218 #+RESULTS: echo-table-once-again
14219 | one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 |
14220 | two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 |
14223 Please note that row names are not removed before the table is indexed using
14224 variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
14228 @node shebang, eval, rownames, Specific header arguments
14229 @subsubsection @code{:shebang}
14231 Setting the @code{:shebang} header argument to a string value
14232 (e.g.@: @code{:shebang "#!/bin/bash"}) causes the string to be inserted as the
14233 first line of any tangled file holding the code block, and the file
14234 permissions of the tangled file are set to make it executable.
14236 @node eval, wrap, shebang, Specific header arguments
14237 @subsubsection @code{:eval}
14238 The @code{:eval} header argument can be used to limit the evaluation of
14239 specific code blocks. The @code{:eval} header argument can be useful for
14240 protecting against the evaluation of dangerous code blocks or to ensure that
14241 evaluation will require a query regardless of the value of the
14242 @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable. The possible values of
14243 @code{:eval} and their effects are shown below.
14247 The code block will not be evaluated under any circumstances.
14249 Evaluation of the code block will require a query.
14250 @item never-export or no-export
14251 The code block will not be evaluated during export but may still be called
14254 Evaluation of the code block during export will require a query.
14257 If this header argument is not set then evaluation is determined by the value
14258 of the @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable see @ref{Code evaluation
14261 @node wrap, , eval, Specific header arguments
14262 @subsubsection @code{:wrap}
14263 The @code{:wrap} header argument is used to mark the results of source block
14264 evaluation. The header argument can be passed a string that will be appended
14265 to @code{#+BEGIN_} and @code{#+END_}, which will then be used to wrap the
14266 results. If not string is specified then the results will be wrapped in a
14267 @code{#+BEGIN/END_RESULTS} block.
14269 @node Results of evaluation, Noweb reference syntax, Header arguments, Working With Source Code
14270 @section Results of evaluation
14271 @cindex code block, results of evaluation
14272 @cindex source code, results of evaluation
14274 The way in which results are handled depends on whether a session is invoked,
14275 as well as on whether @code{:results value} or @code{:results output} is
14276 used. The following table shows the table possibilities. For a full listing
14277 of the possible results header arguments see @ref{results}.
14279 @multitable @columnfractions 0.26 0.33 0.41
14280 @item @tab @b{Non-session} @tab @b{Session}
14281 @item @code{:results value} @tab value of last expression @tab value of last expression
14282 @item @code{:results output} @tab contents of STDOUT @tab concatenation of interpreter output
14285 Note: With @code{:results value}, the result in both @code{:session} and
14286 non-session is returned to Org mode as a table (a one- or two-dimensional
14287 vector of strings or numbers) when appropriate.
14289 @subsection Non-session
14290 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
14291 This is the default. Internally, the value is obtained by wrapping the code
14292 in a function definition in the external language, and evaluating that
14293 function. Therefore, code should be written as if it were the body of such a
14294 function. In particular, note that Python does not automatically return a
14295 value from a function unless a @code{return} statement is present, and so a
14296 @samp{return} statement will usually be required in Python.
14298 This is the only one of the four evaluation contexts in which the code is
14299 automatically wrapped in a function definition.
14301 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
14302 The code is passed to the interpreter as an external process, and the
14303 contents of the standard output stream are returned as text. (In certain
14304 languages this also contains the error output stream; this is an area for
14307 @subsection Session
14308 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
14309 The code is passed to an interpreter running as an interactive Emacs inferior
14310 process. Only languages which provide tools for interactive evaluation of
14311 code have session support, so some language (e.g., C and ditaa) do not
14312 support the @code{:session} header argument, and in other languages (e.g.,
14313 Python and Haskell) which have limitations on the code which may be entered
14314 into interactive sessions, those limitations apply to the code in code blocks
14315 using the @code{:session} header argument as well.
14317 Unless the @code{:results output} option is supplied (see below) the result
14318 returned is the result of the last evaluation performed by the
14319 interpreter. (This is obtained in a language-specific manner: the value of
14320 the variable @code{_} in Python and Ruby, and the value of @code{.Last.value}
14323 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
14324 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
14325 inferior process. The result returned is the concatenation of the sequence of
14326 (text) output from the interactive interpreter. Notice that this is not
14327 necessarily the same as what would be sent to @code{STDOUT} if the same code
14328 were passed to a non-interactive interpreter running as an external
14329 process. For example, compare the following two blocks:
14332 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output
14343 In non-session mode, the `2' is not printed and does not appear.
14345 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output :session
14357 But in @code{:session} mode, the interactive interpreter receives input `2'
14358 and prints out its value, `2'. (Indeed, the other print statements are
14361 @node Noweb reference syntax, Key bindings and useful functions, Results of evaluation, Working With Source Code
14362 @section Noweb reference syntax
14363 @cindex code block, noweb reference
14364 @cindex syntax, noweb
14365 @cindex source code, noweb reference
14367 The ``noweb'' (see @uref{http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/}) Literate
14368 Programming system allows named blocks of code to be referenced by using the
14369 familiar Noweb syntax:
14372 <<code-block-name>>
14375 When a code block is tangled or evaluated, whether or not ``noweb''
14376 references are expanded depends upon the value of the @code{:noweb} header
14377 argument. If @code{:noweb yes}, then a Noweb reference is expanded before
14378 evaluation. If @code{:noweb no}, the default, then the reference is not
14379 expanded before evaluation. See the @ref{noweb-ref} header argument for
14380 a more flexible way to resolve noweb references.
14382 It is possible to include the @emph{results} of a code block rather than the
14383 body. This is done by appending parenthesis to the code block name which may
14384 optionally contain arguments to the code block as shown below.
14387 <<code-block-name(optional arguments)>>
14390 Note: the default value, @code{:noweb no}, was chosen to ensure that
14391 correct code is not broken in a language, such as Ruby, where
14392 @code{<<arg>>} is a syntactically valid construct. If @code{<<arg>>} is not
14393 syntactically valid in languages that you use, then please consider setting
14396 Note: if noweb tangling is slow in large Org mode files consider setting the
14397 @code{*org-babel-use-quick-and-dirty-noweb-expansion*} variable to true.
14398 This will result in faster noweb reference resolution at the expense of not
14399 correctly resolving inherited values of the @code{:noweb-ref} header
14402 @node Key bindings and useful functions, Batch execution, Noweb reference syntax, Working With Source Code
14403 @section Key bindings and useful functions
14404 @cindex code block, key bindings
14406 Many common Org mode key sequences are re-bound depending on
14409 Within a code block, the following key bindings
14412 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
14414 @item @kbd{C-c C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-src-block}
14416 @item @kbd{C-c C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
14418 @item @kbd{C-@key{up}} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
14420 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @code{org-babel-pop-to-session}
14423 In an Org mode buffer, the following key bindings are active:
14425 @multitable @columnfractions 0.45 0.55
14427 @kindex C-c C-v C-p
14428 @item @kbd{C-c C-v p} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-previous-src-block}
14430 @kindex C-c C-v C-n
14431 @item @kbd{C-c C-v n} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-n} @tab @code{org-babel-next-src-block}
14433 @kindex C-c C-v C-e
14434 @item @kbd{C-c C-v e} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-e} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-maybe}
14436 @kindex C-c C-v C-o
14437 @item @kbd{C-c C-v o} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
14439 @kindex C-c C-v C-v
14440 @item @kbd{C-c C-v v} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-v} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
14442 @kindex C-c C-v C-u
14443 @item @kbd{C-c C-v u} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-u} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-src-block-head}
14445 @kindex C-c C-v C-g
14446 @item @kbd{C-c C-v g} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-g} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-src-block}
14448 @kindex C-c C-v C-r
14449 @item @kbd{C-c C-v r} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-r} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-result}
14451 @kindex C-c C-v C-b
14452 @item @kbd{C-c C-v b} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
14454 @kindex C-c C-v C-s
14455 @item @kbd{C-c C-v s} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
14457 @kindex C-c C-v C-d
14458 @item @kbd{C-c C-v d} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-d} @tab @code{org-babel-demarcate-block}
14460 @kindex C-c C-v C-t
14461 @item @kbd{C-c C-v t} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
14463 @kindex C-c C-v C-f
14464 @item @kbd{C-c C-v f} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
14466 @kindex C-c C-v C-c
14467 @item @kbd{C-c C-v c} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-check-src-block}
14469 @kindex C-c C-v C-j
14470 @item @kbd{C-c C-v j} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-j} @tab @code{org-babel-insert-header-arg}
14472 @kindex C-c C-v C-l
14473 @item @kbd{C-c C-v l} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
14475 @kindex C-c C-v C-i
14476 @item @kbd{C-c C-v i} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-i} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
14478 @kindex C-c C-v C-I
14479 @item @kbd{C-c C-v I} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-I} @tab @code{org-babel-view-src-block-info}
14481 @kindex C-c C-v C-z
14482 @item @kbd{C-c C-v z} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session-with-code}
14484 @kindex C-c C-v C-a
14485 @item @kbd{C-c C-v a} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
14487 @kindex C-c C-v C-h
14488 @item @kbd{C-c C-v h} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-h} @tab @code{org-babel-describe-bindings}
14490 @kindex C-c C-v C-x
14491 @item @kbd{C-c C-v x} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-x} @tab @code{org-babel-do-key-sequence-in-edit-buffer}
14494 @c When possible these keybindings were extended to work when the control key is
14495 @c kept pressed, resulting in the following additional keybindings.
14497 @c @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
14498 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
14499 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
14500 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
14501 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
14502 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
14503 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
14504 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
14505 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session}
14508 @node Batch execution, , Key bindings and useful functions, Working With Source Code
14509 @section Batch execution
14510 @cindex code block, batch execution
14511 @cindex source code, batch execution
14513 It is possible to call functions from the command line. This shell
14514 script calls @code{org-babel-tangle} on every one of its arguments.
14516 Be sure to adjust the paths to fit your system.
14520 # -*- mode: shell-script -*-
14522 # tangle files with org-mode
14526 ORGINSTALL="~/src/org/lisp/org-install.el"
14528 # wrap each argument in the code required to call tangle on it
14530 FILES="$FILES \"$i\""
14533 emacs -Q --batch -l $ORGINSTALL \
14535 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/lisp/\"))
14536 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/contrib/lisp/\" t))
14537 (require 'org)(require 'org-exp)(require 'ob)(require 'ob-tangle)
14538 (mapc (lambda (file)
14539 (find-file (expand-file-name file \"$DIR\"))
14541 (kill-buffer)) '($FILES)))" 2>&1 |grep tangled
14544 @node Miscellaneous, Hacking, Working With Source Code, Top
14545 @chapter Miscellaneous
14548 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
14549 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
14550 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
14551 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
14552 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
14553 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
14554 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
14555 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
14556 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
14557 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
14558 * org-crypt.el:: Encrypting Org files
14562 @node Completion, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
14563 @section Completion
14564 @cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
14565 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
14566 @cindex completion, of dictionary words
14567 @cindex completion, of option keywords
14568 @cindex completion, of tags
14569 @cindex completion, of property keys
14570 @cindex completion, of link abbreviations
14571 @cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
14572 @cindex TODO keywords completion
14573 @cindex dictionary word completion
14574 @cindex option keyword completion
14575 @cindex tag completion
14576 @cindex link abbreviations, completion of
14578 Emacs would not be Emacs without completion, and Org mode uses it whenever it
14579 makes sense. If you prefer an @i{iswitchb}- or @i{ido}-like interface for
14580 some of the completion prompts, you can specify your preference by setting at
14581 most one of the variables @code{org-completion-use-iswitchb}
14582 @code{org-completion-use-ido}.
14584 Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
14585 not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
14586 the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
14589 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
14591 Complete word at point
14594 At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
14596 After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
14598 After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
14599 can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
14601 After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
14602 from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
14603 @samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
14604 dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
14606 After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
14607 of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
14610 After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
14612 After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
14613 @samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org mode. When the
14614 option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
14615 will insert example settings for this keyword.
14617 In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
14618 i.e.@: valid keys for this line.
14620 Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
14624 @node Easy Templates, Speed keys, Completion, Miscellaneous
14625 @section Easy Templates
14626 @cindex template insertion
14627 @cindex insertion, of templates
14629 Org mode supports insertion of empty structural elements (like
14630 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} and @code{#+END_SRC} pairs) with just a few key
14631 strokes. This is achieved through a native template expansion mechanism.
14632 Note that Emacs has several other template mechanisms which could be used in
14633 a similar way, for example @file{yasnippet}.
14635 To insert a structural element, type a @samp{<}, followed by a template
14636 selector and @kbd{@key{TAB}}. Completion takes effect only when the above
14637 keystrokes are typed on a line by itself.
14639 The following template selectors are currently supported.
14641 @multitable @columnfractions 0.1 0.9
14642 @item @kbd{s} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_SRC ... #+END_SRC}
14643 @item @kbd{e} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE ... #+END_EXAMPLE}
14644 @item @kbd{q} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_QUOTE ... #+END_QUOTE}
14645 @item @kbd{v} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_VERSE ... #+END_VERSE}
14646 @item @kbd{c} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_CENTER ... #+END_CENTER}
14647 @item @kbd{l} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_LaTeX ... #+END_LaTeX}
14648 @item @kbd{L} @tab @code{#+LaTeX:}
14649 @item @kbd{h} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_HTML ... #+END_HTML}
14650 @item @kbd{H} @tab @code{#+HTML:}
14651 @item @kbd{a} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_ASCII ... #+END_ASCII}
14652 @item @kbd{A} @tab @code{#+ASCII:}
14653 @item @kbd{i} @tab @code{#+INDEX:} line
14654 @item @kbd{I} @tab @code{#+INCLUDE:} line
14657 For example, on an empty line, typing "<e" and then pressing TAB, will expand
14658 into a complete EXAMPLE template.
14660 You can install additional templates by customizing the variable
14661 @code{org-structure-template-alist}. See the docstring of the variable for
14662 additional details.
14664 @node Speed keys, Code evaluation security, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous
14665 @section Speed keys
14667 @vindex org-use-speed-commands
14668 @vindex org-speed-commands-user
14670 Single keys can be made to execute commands when the cursor is at the
14671 beginning of a headline, i.e.@: before the first star. Configure the variable
14672 @code{org-use-speed-commands} to activate this feature. There is a
14673 pre-defined list of commands, and you can add more such commands using the
14674 variable @code{org-speed-commands-user}. Speed keys do not only speed up
14675 navigation and other commands, but they also provide an alternative way to
14676 execute commands bound to keys that are not or not easily available on a TTY,
14677 or on a small mobile device with a limited keyboard.
14679 To see which commands are available, activate the feature and press @kbd{?}
14680 with the cursor at the beginning of a headline.
14682 @node Code evaluation security, Customization, Speed keys, Miscellaneous
14683 @section Code evaluation and security issues
14685 Org provides tools to work with the code snippets, including evaluating them.
14687 Running code on your machine always comes with a security risk. Badly
14688 written or malicious code can be executed on purpose or by accident. Org has
14689 default settings which will only evaluate such code if you give explicit
14690 permission to do so, and as a casual user of these features you should leave
14691 these precautions intact.
14693 For people who regularly work with such code, the confirmation prompts can
14694 become annoying, and you might want to turn them off. This can be done, but
14695 you must be aware of the risks that are involved.
14697 Code evaluation can happen under the following circumstances:
14700 @item Source code blocks
14701 Source code blocks can be evaluated during export, or when pressing @kbd{C-c
14702 C-c} in the block. The most important thing to realize here is that Org mode
14703 files which contain code snippets are, in a certain sense, like executable
14704 files. So you should accept them and load them into Emacs only from trusted
14705 sources---just like you would do with a program you install on your computer.
14707 Make sure you know what you are doing before customizing the variables
14708 which take off the default security brakes.
14710 @defopt org-confirm-babel-evaluate
14711 When t (the default), the user is asked before every code block evaluation.
14712 When nil, the user is not asked. When set to a function, it is called with
14713 two arguments (language and body of the code block) and should return t to
14714 ask and nil not to ask.
14717 For example, here is how to execute "ditaa" code (which is considered safe)
14720 (defun my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate (lang body)
14721 (not (string= lang "ditaa"))) ; don't ask for ditaa
14722 (setq org-confirm-babel-evaluate 'my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate)
14725 @item Following @code{shell} and @code{elisp} links
14726 Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (@pxref{External
14727 links}). These links can be problematic because the code to be evaluated is
14730 @defopt org-confirm-shell-link-function
14731 Function to queries user about shell link execution.
14733 @defopt org-confirm-elisp-link-function
14734 Functions to query user for Emacs Lisp link execution.
14737 @item Formulas in tables
14738 Formulas in tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}) are code that is evaluated
14739 either by the @i{calc} interpreter, or by the @i{Emacs Lisp} interpreter.
14742 @node Customization, In-buffer settings, Code evaluation security, Miscellaneous
14743 @section Customization
14744 @cindex customization
14745 @cindex options, for customization
14746 @cindex variables, for customization
14748 There are more than 500 variables that can be used to customize
14749 Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
14750 describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
14751 variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select
14752 @code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
14753 settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
14754 lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
14756 @node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
14757 @section Summary of in-buffer settings
14758 @cindex in-buffer settings
14759 @cindex special keywords
14761 Org mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
14762 per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
14763 keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
14764 setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
14765 lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
14766 the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
14767 buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
14768 activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
14769 when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
14771 @vindex org-archive-location
14773 @item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
14774 This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
14775 all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
14776 of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
14777 The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
14779 This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
14780 for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
14781 end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
14782 @item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
14783 @cindex property, COLUMNS
14784 Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
14785 columns view is invoked in locations where no @code{COLUMNS} property
14787 @item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
14788 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
14789 @vindex org-table-formula
14790 Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
14791 line sets the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
14792 The global version of this variable is
14793 @code{org-table-formula-constants}.
14794 @item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
14795 Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
14797 @item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
14798 @vindex org-drawers
14799 Set the file-local set of additional drawers. The corresponding global
14800 variable is @code{org-drawers}.
14801 @item #+LINK: linkword replace
14802 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
14803 These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
14804 @xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
14805 @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
14806 @item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
14807 @vindex org-highest-priority
14808 @vindex org-lowest-priority
14809 @vindex org-default-priority
14810 This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
14811 must be either letters A-Z or numbers 0-9. The highest priority must
14812 have a lower ASCII number than the lowest priority.
14813 @item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
14814 This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
14815 buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
14816 @cindex #+SETUPFILE
14817 @item #+SETUPFILE: file
14818 This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
14819 entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
14820 (i.e.@: when starting Org mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
14821 settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
14822 as if they had been included in the buffer. In particular, the file can be
14823 any other Org mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
14824 cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
14827 This line sets options to be used at startup of Org mode, when an
14828 Org file is being visited.
14830 The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline
14831 tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is
14832 @code{org-startup-folded}, with a default value @code{t}, which means
14834 @vindex org-startup-folded
14835 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
14836 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
14837 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
14838 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
14840 overview @r{top-level headlines only}
14841 content @r{all headlines}
14842 showall @r{no folding of any entries}
14843 showeverything @r{show even drawer contents}
14846 @vindex org-startup-indented
14847 @cindex @code{indent}, STARTUP keyword
14848 @cindex @code{noindent}, STARTUP keyword
14849 Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
14850 @code{org-startup-indented}@footnote{Emacs 23 and Org mode 6.29 are required}
14852 indent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned on}
14853 noindent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned off}
14856 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
14857 Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
14858 is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
14859 variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
14861 @cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
14862 @cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
14864 align @r{align all tables}
14865 noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
14868 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
14869 When visiting a file, inline images can be automatically displayed. The
14870 corresponding variable is @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}, with a
14871 default value @code{nil} to avoid delays when visiting a file.
14872 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
14873 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
14875 inlineimages @r{show inline images}
14876 noinlineimages @r{don't show inline images on startup}
14879 @vindex org-log-done
14880 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
14881 @vindex org-log-repeat
14882 Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be
14883 configured using these options (see variables @code{org-log-done},
14884 @code{org-log-note-clock-out} and @code{org-log-repeat})
14885 @cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
14886 @cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
14887 @cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
14888 @cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
14889 @cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
14890 @cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14891 @cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14892 @cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14893 @cindex @code{logreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14894 @cindex @code{lognotereschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14895 @cindex @code{nologreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14896 @cindex @code{logredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14897 @cindex @code{lognoteredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14898 @cindex @code{nologredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14899 @cindex @code{logrefile}, STARTUP keyword
14900 @cindex @code{lognoterefile}, STARTUP keyword
14901 @cindex @code{nologrefile}, STARTUP keyword
14903 logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
14904 lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
14905 nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
14906 logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
14907 lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
14908 nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
14909 lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
14910 nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
14911 logreschedule @r{record a timestamp when scheduling time changes}
14912 lognotereschedule @r{record a note when scheduling time changes}
14913 nologreschedule @r{do not record when a scheduling date changes}
14914 logredeadline @r{record a timestamp when deadline changes}
14915 lognoteredeadline @r{record a note when deadline changes}
14916 nologredeadline @r{do not record when a deadline date changes}
14917 logrefile @r{record a timestamp when refiling}
14918 lognoterefile @r{record a note when refiling}
14919 nologrefile @r{do not record when refiling}
14921 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
14922 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
14923 Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
14924 indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
14925 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
14926 default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
14927 @cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
14928 @cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
14929 @cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
14930 @cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
14932 hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
14933 showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
14934 indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
14935 noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
14936 odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
14937 oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
14939 @vindex org-put-time-stamp-overlays
14940 @vindex org-time-stamp-overlay-formats
14941 To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
14942 @code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
14943 @code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
14944 @cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
14946 customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
14948 @vindex constants-unit-system
14949 The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
14950 @code{constants-unit-system}).
14951 @cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
14952 @cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
14954 constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
14955 constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
14957 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
14958 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
14959 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
14960 To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
14961 corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline},
14962 @code{org-footnote-auto-label}, and @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.
14963 @cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
14964 @cindex @code{nofninline}, STARTUP keyword
14965 @cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
14966 @cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
14967 @cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
14968 @cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
14969 @cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
14970 @cindex @code{fnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
14971 @cindex @code{nofnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
14973 fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
14974 fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
14975 fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
14976 fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
14977 fnauto @r{create @code{[fn:1]}-like labels automatically (default)}
14978 fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
14979 fnplain @r{create @code{[1]}-like labels automatically}
14980 fnadjust @r{automatically renumber and sort footnotes}
14981 nofnadjust @r{do not renumber and sort automatically}
14983 @cindex org-hide-block-startup
14984 To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is
14985 @code{org-hide-block-startup}.
14986 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
14987 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
14989 hideblocks @r{Hide all begin/end blocks on startup}
14990 nohideblocks @r{Do not hide blocks on startup}
14992 @cindex org-pretty-entities
14993 The display of entities as UTF-8 characters is governed by the variable
14994 @code{org-pretty-entities} and the keywords
14995 @cindex @code{entitiespretty}, STARTUP keyword
14996 @cindex @code{entitiesplain}, STARTUP keyword
14998 entitiespretty @r{Show entities as UTF-8 characters where possible}
14999 entitiesplain @r{Leave entities plain}
15001 @item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
15002 @vindex org-tag-alist
15003 These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
15004 this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
15005 keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
15007 This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
15008 @item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+DATE:,
15009 @itemx #+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:, #+XSLT:,
15010 @itemx #+DESCRIPTION:, #+KEYWORDS:,
15011 @itemx #+LaTeX_HEADER:, #+STYLE:, #+LINK_UP:, #+LINK_HOME:,
15012 @itemx #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:
15013 These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
15014 @ref{Export options}.
15015 @item #+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
15016 @vindex org-todo-keywords
15017 These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
15018 current file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-todo-keywords}.
15021 @node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
15022 @section The very busy C-c C-c key
15024 @cindex C-c C-c, overview
15026 The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
15027 mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
15028 this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
15029 other circumstances it means something like @emph{``Hey Org, look
15030 here and update according to what you see here''}. Here is a summary of
15031 what this means in different contexts.
15035 If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
15036 tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
15038 If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
15039 triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
15042 If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
15043 works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
15045 If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
15048 If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file it.
15049 With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
15052 If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
15053 corresponding links in this buffer.
15055 If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
15056 drawer, offer property commands.
15058 If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
15059 definition, and vice versa.
15061 If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it.
15063 If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
15066 If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
15069 If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamic block, the
15072 If the cursor is at a timestamp, fix the day name in the timestamp.
15075 @node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
15076 @section A cleaner outline view
15077 @cindex hiding leading stars
15078 @cindex dynamic indentation
15079 @cindex odd-levels-only outlines
15080 @cindex clean outline view
15082 Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines start with a
15083 potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines is not
15084 indented. While this is no problem when writing a @emph{book-like} document
15085 where the outline headings are really section headings, in a more
15086 @emph{list-oriented} outline, indented structure is a lot cleaner:
15090 * Top level headline | * Top level headline
15091 ** Second level | * Second level
15092 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
15093 some text | some text
15094 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
15095 more text | more text
15096 * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
15102 If you are using at least Emacs 23.2@footnote{Emacs 23.1 can actually crash
15103 with @code{org-indent-mode}} and version 6.29 of Org, this kind of view can
15104 be achieved dynamically at display time using @code{org-indent-mode}. In
15105 this minor mode, all lines are prefixed for display with the necessary amount
15106 of space@footnote{@code{org-indent-mode} also sets the @code{wrap-prefix}
15107 property, such that @code{visual-line-mode} (or purely setting
15108 @code{word-wrap}) wraps long lines (including headlines) correctly indented.
15109 }. Also headlines are prefixed with additional stars, so that the amount of
15110 indentation shifts by two@footnote{See the variable
15111 @code{org-indent-indentation-per-level}.} spaces per level. All headline
15112 stars but the last one are made invisible using the @code{org-hide}
15113 face@footnote{Turning on @code{org-indent-mode} sets
15114 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} to @code{t} and @code{org-adapt-indentation} to
15115 @code{nil}.} - see below under @samp{2.} for more information on how this
15116 works. You can turn on @code{org-indent-mode} for all files by customizing
15117 the variable @code{org-startup-indented}, or you can turn it on for
15118 individual files using
15124 If you want a similar effect in an earlier version of Emacs and/or Org, or if
15125 you want the indentation to be hard space characters so that the plain text
15126 file looks as similar as possible to the Emacs display, Org supports you in
15131 @emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
15132 You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
15133 with the headline, like
15137 more text, now indented
15140 @vindex org-adapt-indentation
15141 Org supports this with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure
15142 editing@footnote{See also the variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.},
15143 preserving or adapting the indentation as appropriate.
15146 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
15147 @emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
15148 all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
15149 the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
15153 #+STARTUP: hidestars
15154 #+STARTUP: showstars
15157 With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
15161 * Top level headline
15169 @vindex org-hide @r{(face)}
15170 The leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they are only
15171 fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the background color as
15172 font color. If you are not using either white or black background, you may
15173 have to customize this face to get the wanted effect. Another possibility is
15174 to set this font such that the extra stars are @i{almost} invisible, for
15175 example using the color @code{grey90} on a white background.
15178 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
15179 Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
15180 levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
15181 to the next@footnote{When you need to specify a level for a property search
15182 or refile targets, @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars, etc@.}. In this
15183 way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of this section. In order
15184 to make the structure editing and export commands handle this convention
15185 correctly, configure the variable @code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on
15186 a per-file basis with one of the following lines:
15193 You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
15194 double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
15195 RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
15196 org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
15199 @node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
15200 @section Using Org on a tty
15201 @cindex tty key bindings
15203 Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default many of
15204 Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
15205 accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
15206 @key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
15207 together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
15208 these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
15209 alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
15210 more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
15211 customized workaround suits you better. For example, changing a timestamp
15212 is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
15213 tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
15215 @multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.1 0.2
15216 @item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Speed key} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
15217 @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C} @tab
15218 @item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
15219 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab @kbd{L} @tab
15220 @item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{r} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
15221 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab @kbd{R} @tab
15222 @item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
15223 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab @kbd{U} @tab
15224 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
15225 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab @kbd{D} @tab
15226 @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15227 @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
15228 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15229 @item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15230 @item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15231 @item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15232 @item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15233 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15234 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15238 @node Interaction, org-crypt.el, TTY keys, Miscellaneous
15239 @section Interaction with other packages
15240 @cindex packages, interaction with other
15241 Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
15242 with other code out there.
15245 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
15246 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
15249 @node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
15250 @subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
15253 @cindex @file{calc.el}
15254 @cindex Gillespie, Dave
15255 @item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
15256 Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
15257 functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
15258 checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
15259 @code{calc-eval} which will have been autoloaded during setup if Calc has
15260 been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
15261 distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
15262 packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
15263 , Embedded Mode, calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
15264 @item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
15265 @cindex @file{constants.el}
15266 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
15267 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
15268 In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
15269 names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
15270 constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
15271 the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
15272 and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
15273 @samp{Mega}, etc@. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
15274 at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
15275 the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
15276 setup. See the installation instructions in the file
15277 @file{constants.el}.
15278 @item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
15279 @cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
15280 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
15281 Org mode can make use of the CD@LaTeX{} package to efficiently enter
15282 @LaTeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
15283 @item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
15284 @cindex @file{imenu.el}
15285 Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org mode
15286 supports Imenu---all you need to do to get the index is the following:
15288 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15289 (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
15291 @vindex org-imenu-depth
15292 By default the index is two levels deep---you can modify the depth using
15293 the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
15294 @item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
15295 @cindex @file{remember.el}
15296 @cindex Wiegley, John
15297 Org used to use this package for capture, but no longer does.
15298 @item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
15299 @cindex @file{speedbar.el}
15300 @cindex Ludlam, Eric M.
15301 Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
15302 index items in files. Org mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
15303 drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows you to
15304 restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
15305 the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
15306 @cindex @file{table.el}
15307 @item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
15309 @cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
15310 @cindex @file{table.el}
15311 @cindex Ota, Takaaki
15313 Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and row-spanning,
15314 and alignment can be created using the Emacs table package by Takaaki Ota
15315 (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table}, and also part of Emacs 22).
15316 Org mode will recognize these tables and export them properly. Because of
15317 interference with other Org mode functionality, you unfortunately cannot edit
15318 these tables directly in the buffer. Instead, you need to use the command
15319 @kbd{C-c '} to edit them, similar to source code snippets.
15322 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-edit-special}
15323 Edit a @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a table.el table.
15325 @orgcmd{C-c ~,org-table-create-with-table.el}
15326 Insert a @file{table.el} table. If there is already a table at point, this
15327 command converts it between the @file{table.el} format and the Org mode
15328 format. See the documentation string of the command
15329 @code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
15332 @file{table.el} is part of Emacs since Emacs 22.
15333 @item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
15334 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
15335 @cindex Baur, Steven L.
15336 Org mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package.
15337 However, Org mode also has its own footnote support (@pxref{Footnotes}),
15338 which makes using @file{footnote.el} unnecessary.
15341 @node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
15342 @subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org mode
15346 @cindex @code{shift-selection-mode}
15347 @vindex org-support-shift-select
15348 In Emacs 23, @code{shift-selection-mode} is on by default, meaning that
15349 cursor motions combined with the shift key should start or enlarge regions.
15350 This conflicts with the use of @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands in Org to change
15351 timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types if the cursor is
15352 at such a location. By default, @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands outside
15353 special contexts don't do anything, but you can customize the variable
15354 @code{org-support-shift-select}. Org mode then tries to accommodate shift
15355 selection by (i) using it outside of the special contexts where special
15356 commands apply, and by (ii) extending an existing active region even if the
15357 cursor moves across a special context.
15359 @item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
15360 @cindex @file{CUA.el}
15361 @cindex Storm, Kim. F.
15362 @vindex org-replace-disputed-keys
15363 Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by CUA mode
15364 (as well as @code{pc-select-mode} and @code{s-region-mode}) to select and extend the
15365 region. In fact, Emacs 23 has this built-in in the form of
15366 @code{shift-selection-mode}, see previous paragraph. If you are using Emacs
15367 23, you probably don't want to use another package for this purpose. However,
15368 if you prefer to leave these keys to a different package while working in
15369 Org mode, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set,
15370 Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda
15371 buffer (but not during date selection).
15374 S-UP @result{} M-p S-DOWN @result{} M-n
15375 S-LEFT @result{} M-- S-RIGHT @result{} M-+
15376 C-S-LEFT @result{} M-S-- C-S-RIGHT @result{} M-S-+
15379 @vindex org-disputed-keys
15380 Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
15381 to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
15382 @code{org-disputed-keys}.
15384 @item @file{filladapt.el} by Kyle Jones
15385 @cindex @file{filladapt.el}
15387 Org mode tries to do the right thing when filling paragraphs, list items and
15388 other elements. Many users reported they had problems using both
15389 @file{filladapt.el} and Org mode, so a safe thing to do is to disable it like
15393 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-off-filladapt-mode)
15396 @item @file{yasnippet.el}
15397 @cindex @file{yasnippet.el}
15398 The way Org mode binds the TAB key (binding to @code{[tab]} instead of
15399 @code{"\t"}) overrules YASnippet's access to this key. The following code
15400 fixed this problem:
15403 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15405 (org-set-local 'yas/trigger-key [tab])
15406 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-or-maybe-expand)))
15409 The latest version of yasnippet doesn't play well with Org mode. If the
15410 above code does not fix the conflict, start by defining the following
15414 (defun yas/org-very-safe-expand ()
15415 (let ((yas/fallback-behavior 'return-nil)) (yas/expand)))
15418 Then, tell Org mode what to do with the new function:
15421 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15423 (make-variable-buffer-local 'yas/trigger-key)
15424 (setq yas/trigger-key [tab])
15425 (add-to-list 'org-tab-first-hook 'yas/org-very-safe-expand)
15426 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field)))
15429 @item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
15430 @cindex @file{windmove.el}
15431 This package also uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
15432 in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you want make
15433 the windmove function active in locations where Org mode does not have
15434 special functionality on @kbd{S-@key{cursor}}, add this to your
15438 ;; Make windmove work in org-mode:
15439 (add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up)
15440 (add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left)
15441 (add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down)
15442 (add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right)
15445 @item @file{viper.el} by Michael Kifer
15446 @cindex @file{viper.el}
15448 Viper uses @kbd{C-c /} and therefore makes this key not access the
15449 corresponding Org mode command @code{org-sparse-tree}. You need to find
15450 another key for this command, or override the key in
15451 @code{viper-vi-global-user-map} with
15454 (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
15459 @node org-crypt.el, , Interaction, Miscellaneous
15460 @section org-crypt.el
15461 @cindex @file{org-crypt.el}
15462 @cindex @code{org-decrypt-entry}
15464 Org-crypt will encrypt the text of an entry, but not the headline, or
15465 properties. Org-crypt uses the Emacs EasyPG library to encrypt and decrypt
15468 Any text below a headline that has a @samp{:crypt:} tag will be automatically
15469 be encrypted when the file is saved. If you want to use a different tag just
15470 customize the @code{org-crypt-tag-matcher} setting.
15472 To use org-crypt it is suggested that you have the following in your
15476 (require 'org-crypt)
15477 (org-crypt-use-before-save-magic)
15478 (setq org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance (quote ("crypt")))
15480 (setq org-crypt-key nil)
15481 ;; GPG key to use for encryption
15482 ;; Either the Key ID or set to nil to use symmetric encryption.
15484 (setq auto-save-default nil)
15485 ;; Auto-saving does not cooperate with org-crypt.el: so you need
15486 ;; to turn it off if you plan to use org-crypt.el quite often.
15487 ;; Otherwise, you'll get an (annoying) message each time you
15490 ;; To turn it off only locally, you can insert this:
15492 ;; # -*- buffer-auto-save-file-name: nil; -*-
15495 Excluding the crypt tag from inheritance prevents already encrypted text
15496 being encrypted again.
15498 @node Hacking, MobileOrg, Miscellaneous, Top
15502 This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
15506 * Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals
15507 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
15508 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
15509 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
15510 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
15511 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
15512 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
15513 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
15514 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
15515 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
15518 @node Hooks, Add-on packages, Hacking, Hacking
15522 Org has a large number of hook variables that can be used to add
15523 functionality. This appendix about hacking is going to illustrate the
15524 use of some of them. A complete list of all hooks with documentation is
15525 maintained by the Worg project and can be found at
15526 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-configs/org-hooks.php}.
15528 @node Add-on packages, Adding hyperlink types, Hooks, Hacking
15529 @section Add-on packages
15530 @cindex add-on packages
15532 A large number of add-on packages have been written by various authors.
15533 These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed
15534 packages with the separate release available at the Org mode home page at
15535 @uref{http://orgmode.org}. The list of contributed packages, along with
15536 documentation about each package, is maintained by the Worg project at
15537 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/}.
15541 @node Adding hyperlink types, Context-sensitive commands, Add-on packages, Hacking
15542 @section Adding hyperlink types
15543 @cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
15545 Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
15546 (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, Org
15547 provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file,
15548 @file{org-man.el}, that will add support for creating links like
15549 @samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
15553 ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
15557 (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
15558 (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
15560 (defcustom org-man-command 'man
15561 "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
15563 :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
15565 (defun org-man-open (path)
15566 "Visit the manpage on PATH.
15567 PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
15568 (funcall org-man-command path))
15570 (defun org-man-store-link ()
15571 "Store a link to a manpage."
15572 (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
15573 ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
15574 (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
15575 (link (concat "man:" page))
15576 (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
15577 (org-store-link-props
15580 :description description))))
15582 (defun org-man-get-page-name ()
15583 "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
15584 ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
15585 (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
15586 (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
15587 (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
15591 ;;; org-man.el ends here
15595 You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
15602 Let's go through the file and see what it does.
15605 It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
15608 The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
15609 with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
15610 that will be called to follow such a link.
15612 @vindex org-store-link-functions
15613 The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
15614 order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
15615 buffer displaying a man page.
15618 The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
15619 First there is a customization variable that determines which Emacs
15620 command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
15621 @code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
15622 defined. It gets the link path as an argument---in this case the link
15623 path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
15624 value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
15626 Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
15627 to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, this function will be called to
15628 try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
15629 create the link for this buffer type; we do this by checking the value
15630 of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
15631 return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
15632 manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
15633 @samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
15634 and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
15635 can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
15636 the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
15637 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
15639 When it makes sense for your new link type, you may also define a function
15640 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g.@: completion)
15641 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
15642 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
15644 @node Context-sensitive commands, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
15645 @section Context-sensitive commands
15646 @cindex context-sensitive commands, hooks
15647 @cindex add-ons, context-sensitive commands
15648 @vindex org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook
15650 Org has several commands that act differently depending on context. The most
15651 important example is the @kbd{C-c C-c} (@pxref{The very busy C-c C-c key}).
15652 Also the @kbd{M-cursor} and @kbd{M-S-cursor} keys have this property.
15654 Add-ons can tap into this functionality by providing a function that detects
15655 special context for that add-on and executes functionality appropriate for
15656 the context. Here is an example from Dan Davison's @file{org-R.el} which
15657 allows you to evaluate commands based on the @file{R} programming language
15658 @footnote{@file{org-R.el} has been replaced by the Org mode functionality
15659 described in @ref{Working With Source Code} and is now obsolete.}. For this
15660 package, special contexts are lines that start with @code{#+R:} or
15664 (defun org-R-apply-maybe ()
15665 "Detect if this is context for org-R and execute R commands."
15666 (if (save-excursion
15667 (beginning-of-line 1)
15668 (looking-at "#\\+RR?:"))
15669 (progn (call-interactively 'org-R-apply)
15670 t) ;; to signal that we took action
15671 nil)) ;; to signal that we did not
15673 (add-hook 'org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook 'org-R-apply-maybe)
15676 The function first checks if the cursor is in such a line. If that is the
15677 case, @code{org-R-apply} is called and the function returns @code{t} to
15678 signal that action was taken, and @kbd{C-c C-c} will stop looking for other
15679 contexts. If the function finds it should do nothing locally, it returns
15680 @code{nil} so that other, similar functions can have a try.
15683 @node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Context-sensitive commands, Hacking
15684 @section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
15685 @cindex tables, in other modes
15686 @cindex lists, in other modes
15687 @cindex Orgtbl mode
15689 Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
15690 frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
15691 specific languages, for example @LaTeX{}. However, this is extremely
15692 hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
15693 and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl mode table
15696 This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
15697 table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
15698 function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
15699 @i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
15700 the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
15701 for a very flexible system.
15703 Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists, in Orgstruct mode. You
15704 can use Org's facilities to edit and structure lists by turning
15705 @code{orgstruct-mode} on, then locally exporting such lists in another format
15706 (HTML, @LaTeX{} or Texinfo.)
15710 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
15711 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
15712 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
15713 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
15716 @node Radio tables, A @LaTeX{} example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15717 @subsection Radio tables
15718 @cindex radio tables
15720 To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
15721 lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
15722 Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
15723 between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
15726 /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
15727 /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
15731 Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
15732 Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
15736 #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
15740 @code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
15741 in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
15742 that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
15743 arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
15744 passed as a property list to the translation function for
15745 interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
15746 acted upon before the translation function is called:
15750 Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
15753 @item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
15754 List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
15755 calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
15756 Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
15757 removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
15758 additional columns.
15761 When non-nil, do not escape special characters @code{&%#_^} when exporting
15762 the table. The default value is nil.
15766 The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
15767 without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
15768 compilation of a C file or processing of a @LaTeX{} file. There are a
15769 number of different solutions:
15773 The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
15774 language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
15775 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
15777 Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
15778 statement, for example @samp{\bye} in @TeX{} and @samp{\end@{document@}}
15781 You can just comment the table line-by-line whenever you want to process
15782 the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
15783 only sounds tedious---the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment}
15784 makes this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
15788 @node A @LaTeX{} example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15789 @subsection A @LaTeX{} example of radio tables
15790 @cindex @LaTeX{}, and Orgtbl mode
15792 The best way to wrap the source table in @LaTeX{} is to use the
15793 @code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
15794 activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
15795 header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
15796 default this works only for @LaTeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
15797 variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other
15798 modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will
15799 be prompted for a table name, let's say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
15800 will then get the following template:
15802 @cindex #+ORGTBL, SEND
15804 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15805 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15807 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
15813 @vindex @LaTeX{}-verbatim-environments
15814 The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
15815 @code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into @LaTeX{} and to put it
15816 into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
15817 fill in the table---feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
15818 the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
15819 this may cause problems with font-lock in @LaTeX{} mode. As shown in the
15820 example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
15821 @code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
15822 expressions. If you are using AUC@TeX{} with the font-latex library, a
15823 much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
15824 variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
15827 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15828 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15830 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
15831 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
15832 |-------+------+---------+---------|
15833 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
15834 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
15835 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
15836 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
15837 % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
15842 When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
15843 table inserted between the two marker lines.
15845 Now let's assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
15846 want to control how columns are aligned, etc@. In this case we make sure
15847 that the table translator skips the first 2 lines of the source
15848 table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e.@: to not produce
15849 header and footer commands of the target table:
15852 \begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
15853 Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
15854 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15855 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15859 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
15860 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
15861 |-------+------+---------+---------|
15862 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
15863 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
15864 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
15865 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
15869 The @LaTeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
15870 Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
15871 and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
15872 interprets the following parameters (see also @pxref{Translator functions}):
15875 @item :splice nil/t
15876 When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
15877 tabular environment. Default is nil.
15880 A format to be used to wrap each field, it should contain @code{%s} for the
15881 original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
15882 you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
15883 column numbers and formats, for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
15884 A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
15885 function must return a formatted string.
15888 Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
15889 have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
15890 @code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
15891 may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
15892 @code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
15893 @code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
15894 applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
15895 supplied instead of strings.
15898 @node Translator functions, Radio lists, A @LaTeX{} example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15899 @subsection Translator functions
15900 @cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
15901 @cindex translator function
15903 Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
15904 (comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
15905 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
15906 Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
15907 code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
15908 translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
15909 itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
15910 @code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
15911 hands processing over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
15915 (defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
15916 "Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
15917 (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
15918 org-table-last-alignment ""))
15921 :tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
15922 :tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
15923 :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
15924 :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
15925 (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
15929 As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
15930 @var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
15931 (variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e.@: the
15932 ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
15933 would like to use the @LaTeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
15934 be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
15935 overrule the default with
15938 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
15941 For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
15942 analogy with the @LaTeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
15943 directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
15944 with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
15945 started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!}, and where the field
15946 separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
15950 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
15951 :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
15955 Please check the documentation string of the function
15956 @code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
15957 that function, and remember that you can pass each of them into
15958 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
15959 using the generic function.
15961 Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
15962 things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
15963 two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
15964 line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
15965 argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
15966 @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
15967 containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
15968 translator, please post it on @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
15969 others can benefit from your work.
15971 @node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15972 @subsection Radio lists
15973 @cindex radio lists
15974 @cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
15976 Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way as sending and
15977 receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}). As for radio tables, you can
15978 insert radio list templates in HTML, @LaTeX{} and Texinfo modes by calling
15979 @code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
15981 Here are the differences with radio tables:
15985 Orgstruct mode must be active.
15987 Use the @code{ORGLST} keyword instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
15989 The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
15992 @kbd{C-c C-c} will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
15995 Here is a @LaTeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
16000 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
16001 % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
16003 #+ORGLST: SEND to-buy org-list-to-latex
16012 Pressing `C-c C-c' on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
16013 @LaTeX{} list between the two marker lines.
16015 @node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
16016 @section Dynamic blocks
16017 @cindex dynamic blocks
16019 Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
16020 specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
16021 A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
16022 command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
16024 Dynamic blocks are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
16025 to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
16026 the content of the block.
16028 @cindex #+BEGIN:dynamic block
16030 #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
16035 Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
16038 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
16039 Update dynamic block at point.
16040 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
16041 Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
16044 Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
16045 END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
16046 writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
16047 to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
16048 extra parameter @code{:content}.
16050 For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
16051 @code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
16052 with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
16053 of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
16057 #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
16063 The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
16066 (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
16067 (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
16068 (insert "Last block update at: "
16069 (format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
16072 If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
16073 you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
16074 example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
16075 written in a way such that it does nothing in buffers that are not in
16078 You can narrow the current buffer to the current dynamic block (like any
16079 other block) with @code{org-narrow-to-block}.
16081 @node Special agenda views, Extracting agenda information, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
16082 @section Special agenda views
16083 @cindex agenda views, user-defined
16085 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16086 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function-global
16087 Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the selection
16088 made by these agenda views: @code{agenda}, @code{todo}, @code{alltodo},
16089 @code{tags}, @code{tags-todo}, @code{tags-tree}. You may specify a function
16090 that is used at each match to verify if the match should indeed be part of
16091 the agenda view, and if not, how much should be skipped. You can specify a
16092 global condition that will be applied to all agenda views, this condition
16093 would be stored in the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-function-global}. More
16094 commonly, such a definition is applied only to specific custom searches,
16095 using @code{org-agenda-skip-function}.
16097 Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
16098 tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
16099 marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
16100 PROJECT. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
16101 PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
16102 the subtree belonging to the project line.
16104 To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
16105 the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
16106 indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
16107 tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
16108 search should continue from there.
16111 (defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
16112 "Skip trees that are not waiting"
16113 (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
16114 (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
16115 nil ; tag found, do not skip
16116 subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
16119 Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
16123 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
16124 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
16125 ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
16126 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
16129 @vindex org-agenda-overriding-header
16130 Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
16131 meaningful header in the agenda view.
16133 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
16134 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16135 A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
16136 entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
16137 your custom search function, simply do a search for
16138 @samp{LEVEL>0}@footnote{Note that, when using @code{org-odd-levels-only}, a
16139 level number corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of
16140 stars.}, and then use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries
16141 you really want to have.
16143 You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
16144 particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
16145 and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
16148 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
16149 Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
16150 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
16151 Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
16152 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
16153 Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
16154 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
16155 Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
16156 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))
16157 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING.
16158 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)
16159 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state.
16160 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)
16161 Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled.
16162 @anchor{x-agenda-skip-entry-regexp}
16163 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'regexp "regular expression")
16164 Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
16165 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notregexp "regular expression")
16166 Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
16167 @item (org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
16168 Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
16171 Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
16172 like this, even without defining a special function:
16175 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
16176 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
16177 ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
16178 'regexp ":waiting:"))
16179 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
16182 @node Extracting agenda information, Using the property API, Special agenda views, Hacking
16183 @section Extracting agenda information
16184 @cindex agenda, pipe
16185 @cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
16187 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
16188 Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
16189 line in Emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
16190 directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
16191 processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
16192 @code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
16193 ASCII text to STDOUT. The command takes a single string as parameter.
16194 If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
16195 you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
16196 key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
16197 current TODO list, you could use
16200 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
16203 If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
16204 tags/TODO match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
16205 (all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
16206 @samp{NewYork}), you could use
16209 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
16210 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
16214 You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
16217 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
16218 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
16219 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
16220 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
16221 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
16226 which will produce a 30-day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
16227 @file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
16229 If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
16230 can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
16231 list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
16232 contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
16236 category @r{The category of the item}
16237 head @r{The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY}
16238 type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
16239 todo @r{selected in TODO match}
16240 tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
16241 diary @r{imported from diary}
16242 deadline @r{a deadline}
16243 scheduled @r{scheduled}
16244 timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
16245 closed @r{entry was closed on date}
16246 upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
16247 past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
16248 block @r{entry has date block including date}
16249 todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
16250 tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
16251 date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
16252 time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
16253 extra @r{String with extra planning info}
16254 priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
16255 priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
16259 Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
16260 led to the selection of the item.
16262 A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post-processing script.
16263 For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
16264 Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
16269 # define the Emacs command to run
16270 $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
16272 # run it and capture the output
16273 $agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
16275 # loop over all lines
16276 foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
16277 # get the individual values
16278 ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
16279 $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
16280 # process and print
16281 print "[ ] $head\n";
16285 @node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Extracting agenda information, Hacking
16286 @section Using the property API
16287 @cindex API, for properties
16288 @cindex properties, API
16290 Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
16293 @defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
16294 Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.@*
16295 This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
16296 scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
16297 entry. The return value is an alist. Keys may occur multiple times
16298 if the property key was used several times.@*
16299 POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used.
16300 If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
16301 `special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
16303 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
16304 @findex org-insert-property-drawer
16305 @defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
16306 Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM. By default,
16307 this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If INHERIT
16308 is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, then also check
16309 higher levels of the hierarchy. If INHERIT is the symbol
16310 @code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
16311 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects PROPERTY for inheritance.
16314 @defun org-entry-delete pom property
16315 Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
16318 @defun org-entry-put pom property value
16319 Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
16322 @defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
16323 Get all property keys in the current buffer.
16326 @defun org-insert-property-drawer
16327 Insert a property drawer for the current entry. Also
16330 @defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
16331 Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES. VALUES should be a list of
16332 strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators.
16335 @defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
16336 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16337 values and return the values as a list of strings.
16340 @defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
16341 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16342 values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
16345 @defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
16346 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16347 values and make sure that VALUE is @emph{not} in this list.
16350 @defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
16351 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16352 values and check if VALUE is in this list.
16355 @defopt org-property-allowed-value-functions
16356 Hook for functions supplying allowed values for a specific property.
16357 The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property, and
16358 return a flat list of allowed values. If @samp{:ETC} is one of
16359 the values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values
16360 to be entered. The functions must return @code{nil} if they are not
16361 responsible for this property.
16364 @node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
16365 @section Using the mapping API
16366 @cindex API, for mapping
16367 @cindex mapping entries, API
16369 Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
16370 certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
16371 views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
16372 functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
16375 @defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
16376 Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
16378 FUNC is a function or a Lisp form. The function will be called without
16379 arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline.
16380 The return values of all calls to the function will be collected and
16381 returned as a list.
16383 The call to FUNC will be wrapped into a save-excursion form, so FUNC
16384 does not need to preserve point. After evaluation, the cursor will be
16385 moved to the end of the line (presumably of the headline of the
16386 processed entry) and search continues from there. Under some
16387 circumstances, this may not produce the wanted results. For example,
16388 if you have removed (e.g.@: archived) the current (sub)tree it could
16389 mean that the next entry will be skipped entirely. In such cases, you
16390 can specify the position from where search should continue by making
16391 FUNC set the variable `org-map-continue-from' to the desired buffer
16394 MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match view.
16395 Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered during
16396 the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all headlines will be
16397 visited by the iteration.
16399 SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
16402 nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
16403 tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
16404 region @r{The entries within the active region, if any}
16405 file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
16407 @r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
16408 agenda @r{all agenda files}
16409 agenda-with-archives
16410 @r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
16412 @r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
16415 The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
16416 the scanner. The following items can be given here:
16418 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16420 archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
16421 comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
16422 function or Lisp form
16423 @r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
16424 @r{so whenever the function returns t, FUNC}
16425 @r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
16426 @r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
16430 The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
16431 It can use the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
16432 information about the entry, or in order to change metadata in the entry.
16433 Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
16435 @defun org-todo &optional arg
16436 Change the TODO state of the entry. See the docstring of the functions for
16437 the many possible values for the argument ARG.
16440 @defun org-priority &optional action
16441 Change the priority of the entry. See the docstring of this function for the
16442 possible values for ACTION.
16445 @defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
16446 Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either @code{on}
16447 or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off.
16451 Promote the current entry.
16455 Demote the current entry.
16458 Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
16459 a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
16460 Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
16464 '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
16465 "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
16468 The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
16469 @code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
16472 (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
16475 @node MobileOrg, History and Acknowledgments, Hacking, Top
16476 @appendix MobileOrg
16480 @i{MobileOrg} is the name of the mobile companion app for Org mode, currently
16481 available for iOS and for Android. @i{MobileOrg} offers offline viewing and
16482 capture support for an Org mode system rooted on a ``real'' computer. It
16483 does also allow you to record changes to existing entries.
16484 The @uref{http://mobileorg.ncogni.to/, iOS implementation} for the
16485 @i{iPhone/iPod Touch/iPad} series of devices, was developed by Richard
16486 Moreland. Android users should check out
16487 @uref{http://wiki.github.com/matburt/mobileorg-android/, MobileOrg Android}
16488 by Matt Jones. The two implementations are not identical but offer similar
16491 This appendix describes the support Org has for creating agenda views in a
16492 format that can be displayed by @i{MobileOrg}, and for integrating notes
16493 captured and changes made by @i{MobileOrg} into the main system.
16495 For changing tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, you should have set up the
16496 customization variables @code{org-todo-keywords} and @code{org-tags-alist} to
16497 cover all important tags and TODO keywords, even if individual files use only
16498 part of these. MobileOrg will also offer you states and tags set up with
16499 in-buffer settings, but it will understand the logistics of TODO state
16500 @i{sets} (@pxref{Per-file keywords}) and @i{mutually exclusive} tags
16501 (@pxref{Setting tags}) only for those set in these variables.
16504 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
16505 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
16506 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
16509 @node Setting up the staging area, Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg, MobileOrg
16510 @section Setting up the staging area
16512 MobileOrg needs to interact with Emacs through a directory on a server. If you
16513 are using a public server, you should consider to encrypt the files that are
16514 uploaded to the server. This can be done with Org mode 7.02 and with
16515 @i{MobileOrg 1.5} (iPhone version), and you need an @file{openssl}
16516 installation on your system. To turn on encryption, set a password in
16517 @i{MobileOrg} and, on the Emacs side, configure the variable
16518 @code{org-mobile-use-encryption}@footnote{If you can safely store the
16519 password in your Emacs setup, you might also want to configure
16520 @code{org-mobile-encryption-password}. Please read the docstring of that
16521 variable. Note that encryption will apply only to the contents of the
16522 @file{.org} files. The file names themselves will remain visible.}.
16524 The easiest way to create that directory is to use a free
16525 @uref{http://dropbox.com,Dropbox.com} account@footnote{If you cannot use
16526 Dropbox, or if your version of MobileOrg does not support it, you can use a
16527 webdav server. For more information, check out the documentation of MobileOrg and also this
16528 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.html#mobileorg_webdav, FAQ entry}.}.
16529 When MobileOrg first connects to your Dropbox, it will create a directory
16530 @i{MobileOrg} inside the Dropbox. After the directory has been created, tell
16534 (setq org-mobile-directory "~/Dropbox/MobileOrg")
16537 Org mode has commands to put files for @i{MobileOrg} into that directory,
16538 and to read captured notes from there.
16540 @node Pushing to MobileOrg, Pulling from MobileOrg, Setting up the staging area, MobileOrg
16541 @section Pushing to MobileOrg
16543 This operation copies all files currently listed in @code{org-mobile-files}
16544 to the directory @code{org-mobile-directory}. By default this list contains
16545 all agenda files (as listed in @code{org-agenda-files}), but additional files
16546 can be included by customizing @code{org-mobile-files}. File names will be
16547 staged with paths relative to @code{org-directory}, so all files should be
16548 inside this directory. The push operation also creates a special Org file
16549 @file{agendas.org} with all custom agenda view defined by the
16550 user@footnote{While creating the agendas, Org mode will force ID properties
16551 on all referenced entries, so that these entries can be uniquely identified
16552 if @i{MobileOrg} flags them for further action. If you do not want to get
16553 these properties in so many entries, you can set the variable
16554 @code{org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items} to @code{nil}. Org mode will then
16555 rely on outline paths, in the hope that these will be unique enough.}.
16556 Finally, Org writes the file @file{index.org}, containing links to all other
16557 files. @i{MobileOrg} first reads this file from the server, and then
16558 downloads all agendas and Org files listed in it. To speed up the download,
16559 MobileOrg will only read files whose checksums@footnote{Checksums are stored
16560 automatically in the file @file{checksums.dat}} have changed.
16562 @node Pulling from MobileOrg, , Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg
16563 @section Pulling from MobileOrg
16565 When @i{MobileOrg} synchronizes with the server, it not only pulls the Org
16566 files for viewing. It also appends captured entries and pointers to flagged
16567 and changed entries to the file @file{mobileorg.org} on the server. Org has
16568 a @emph{pull} operation that integrates this information into an inbox file
16569 and operates on the pointers to flagged entries. Here is how it works:
16573 Org moves all entries found in
16574 @file{mobileorg.org}@footnote{@file{mobileorg.org} will be empty after this
16575 operation.} and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable
16576 @code{org-mobile-inbox-for-pull}. Each captured entry and each editing event
16577 will be a top-level entry in the inbox file.
16579 After moving the entries, Org will attempt to implement the changes made in
16580 @i{MobileOrg}. Some changes are applied directly and without user
16581 interaction. Examples are all changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body
16582 text that can be cleanly applied. Entries that have been flagged for further
16583 action will receive a tag @code{:FLAGGED:}, so that they can be easily found
16584 again. When there is a problem finding an entry or applying the change, the
16585 pointer entry will remain in the inbox and will be marked with an error
16586 message. You need to later resolve these issues by hand.
16588 Org will then generate an agenda view with all flagged entries. The user
16589 should then go through these entries and do whatever actions are necessary.
16590 If a note has been stored while flagging an entry in @i{MobileOrg}, that note
16591 will be displayed in the echo area when the cursor is on the corresponding
16596 Pressing @kbd{?} in that special agenda will display the full flagging note in
16597 another window and also push it onto the kill ring. So you could use @kbd{?
16598 z C-y C-c C-c} to store that flagging note as a normal note in the entry.
16599 Pressing @kbd{?} twice in succession will offer to remove the
16600 @code{:FLAGGED:} tag along with the recorded flagging note (which is stored
16601 in a property). In this way you indicate that the intended processing for
16602 this flagged entry is finished.
16607 If you are not able to process all flagged entries directly, you can always
16608 return to this agenda view@footnote{Note, however, that there is a subtle
16609 difference. The view created automatically by @kbd{M-x org-mobile-pull
16610 @key{RET}} is guaranteed to search all files that have been addressed by the
16611 last pull. This might include a file that is not currently in your list of
16612 agenda files. If you later use @kbd{C-c a ?} to regenerate the view, only
16613 the current agenda files will be searched.} using @kbd{C-c a ?}.
16615 @node History and Acknowledgments, Main Index, MobileOrg, Top
16616 @appendix History and acknowledgments
16617 @cindex acknowledgments
16621 @section From Carsten
16623 Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the Emacs
16624 Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects, and using
16625 Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to remember eleven
16626 different commands with two or three keys per command, only to hide and show
16627 parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely unacceptable to me. Also,
16628 when using outlines to take notes, I constantly wanted to restructure the
16629 tree, organizing it parallel to my thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility
16630 cycling} and @emph{structure editing} were originally implemented in the
16631 package @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
16632 @file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project planning,
16633 the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{timestamps}, and
16634 @emph{table support}. These areas highlighted the two main goals that Org
16635 still has today: to be a new, outline-based, plain text mode with innovative
16636 and intuitive editing features, and to incorporate project planning
16637 functionality directly into a notes file.
16639 Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to
16640 @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
16641 reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
16642 Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
16643 trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
16644 in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
16645 complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
16648 Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order:
16651 @item Bastien Guerry
16652 Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of them
16653 integrated into the core by now), including the @LaTeX{} exporter and the plain
16654 list parser. His support during the early days, when he basically acted as
16655 co-maintainer, was central to the success of this project. Bastien also
16656 invented Worg, helped establishing the Web presence of Org, and sponsored
16657 hosting costs for the orgmode.org website.
16658 @item Eric Schulte and Dan Davison
16659 Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org-babel system, which turns
16660 Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating code and doing literate
16661 programming and reproducible research.
16663 John has contributed a number of great ideas and patches directly to Org,
16664 including the attachment system (@file{org-attach.el}), integration with
16665 Apple Mail (@file{org-mac-message.el}), hierarchical dependencies of TODO
16666 items, habit tracking (@file{org-habits.el}), and encryption
16667 (@file{org-crypt.el}). Also, the capture system is really an extended copy
16668 of his great @file{remember.el}.
16669 @item Sebastian Rose
16670 Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the pitiful work
16671 of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this part of Org onto a much
16672 higher level. He also wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
16673 webpages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with
16674 single-key navigation.
16677 @noindent See below for the full list of contributions! Again, please
16678 let me know what I am missing here!
16680 @section From Bastien
16682 I (Bastien) have been maintaining Org since January 2011. This appendix
16683 would not be complete without adding a few more acknowledgements and thanks
16684 to Carsten's ones above.
16686 I am first grateful to Carsten for his trust while handing me over the
16687 maintainership of Org. His support as been great since day one of this new
16688 adventure, and it helped a lot.
16690 When I took over maintainership, I knew I would have to make Org more
16691 collaborative than ever, as I would have to rely on people that are more
16692 knowledgeable than I am on many parts of the code. Here is a list of the
16693 persons I could rely on, they should really be considered co-maintainers,
16694 either of the code or the community:
16698 Eric is maintaining the Babel parts of Org. His reactivity here kept me away
16699 from worrying about possible bugs here and let me focus on other parts.
16701 @item Nicolas Goaziou
16702 Nicolas is maintaining the consistency of the deepest parts of Org. His work
16703 on @file{org-element.el} and @file{org-export.el} has been outstanding, and
16704 opened the doors for many new ideas and features.
16706 @item Jambunathan K
16707 Jambunathan contributed the ODT exporter, definitly a killer feature of
16708 Org mode. He also contributed the new HTML exporter, which is another core
16709 feature of Org. Here too, I knew I could rely on him to fix bugs in these
16710 areas and to patiently explain the users what was the problems and solutions.
16713 Achim rewrote the building process of Org, turning some @emph{ad hoc} tools
16714 into a flexible and conceptually clean process. He patiently coped with the
16715 many hicups that such a change can create for users.
16718 The Org mode mailing list would not be such a nice place without Nick, who
16719 patiently helped users so many times. It is impossible to overestimate such
16720 a great help, and the list would not be so active without him.
16723 I received support from so many users that it is clearly impossible to be
16724 fair when shortlisting a few of them -- but Org's history would not be
16725 complete if the ones above were not mentioned in this manual.
16727 @section List of contributions
16732 @i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
16734 @i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
16736 @i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
16739 @i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
16741 @i{Jan Böcker} wrote @file{org-docview.el}.
16743 @i{Brad Bozarth} showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org mode files.
16745 @i{Tom Breton} wrote @file{org-choose.el}.
16747 @i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
16748 for Remember, which are now templates for capture.
16750 @i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
16753 @i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for Lisp forms into table
16754 calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
16755 @file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
16757 @i{Sacha Chua} suggested copying some linking code from Planner.
16759 @i{Baoqiu Cui} contributed the DocBook exporter.
16761 @i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
16762 came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
16765 @i{Nick Dokos} tracked down several nasty bugs.
16767 @i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
16768 inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
16769 asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
16771 @i{Thomas S. Dye} contributed documentation on Worg and helped integrating
16772 the Org-Babel documentation into the manual.
16774 @i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format, inspired
16775 the agenda, patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and wrote
16776 @file{org-taskjuggler.el}.
16778 @i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
16781 @i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
16783 @i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
16785 @i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
16786 around a match in a hidden outline tree.
16788 @i{Raimar Finken} wrote @file{org-git-line.el}.
16790 @i{Mikael Fornius} works as a mailing list moderator.
16792 @i{Austin Frank} works as a mailing list moderator.
16794 @i{Eric Fraga} drove the development of BEAMER export with ideas and
16797 @i{Barry Gidden} did proofreading the manual in preparation for the book
16798 publication through Network Theory Ltd.
16800 @i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
16802 @i{Nicolas Goaziou} rewrote much of the plain list code.
16804 @i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
16806 @i{Brian Gough} of Network Theory Ltd publishes the Org mode manual as a
16809 @i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
16810 task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
16811 been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system.
16813 @i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
16816 @i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
16818 @i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
16819 folded entries, and column view for properties.
16821 @i{Matt Jones} wrote @i{MobileOrg Android}.
16823 @i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
16825 @i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded @LaTeX{} and tested it. He also
16826 provided frequent feedback and some patches.
16828 @i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
16829 invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
16831 @i{David Maus} wrote @file{org-atom.el}, maintains the issues file for Org,
16832 and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent replies,
16833 small fixes and patches.
16835 @i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
16837 @i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling.
16839 @i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
16842 @i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
16845 @i{Richard Moreland} wrote @i{MobileOrg} for the iPhone.
16847 @i{Rick Moynihan} proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
16848 and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
16850 @i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
16852 @i{Greg Newman} refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
16854 @i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
16855 file links, and TAGS.
16857 @i{Osamu Okano} wrote @file{orgcard2ref.pl}, a Perl program to create a text
16858 version of the reference card.
16860 @i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
16863 @i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
16865 @i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
16866 links, among other things.
16868 @i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
16869 provided frequent feedback.
16871 @i{Martin Pohlack} provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion
16872 into bundles of 20 for undo.
16874 @i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
16876 @i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
16879 @i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He
16880 also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
16882 @i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
16884 @i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
16885 conflict with @file{allout.el}.
16887 @i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with
16890 @i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
16891 of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
16893 @i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
16896 @i{Paul Sexton} wrote @file{org-ctags.el}.
16898 Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
16899 @file{organizer-mode.el}.
16901 @i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
16902 examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
16904 @i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
16905 now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
16907 @i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
16910 @i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
16912 @i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
16913 tweaks and features.
16915 @i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
16916 extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
16918 @i{Ulf Stegemann} created the table to translate special symbols to HTML,
16919 @LaTeX{}, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII.
16921 @i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
16922 with links transformation to Org syntax.
16924 @i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
16925 chapter about publishing.
16927 @i{Jambunathan K} contributed the ODT exporter.
16929 @i{Sebastien Vauban} reported many issues with @LaTeX{} and BEAMER export and
16930 enabled source code highlighting in Gnus.
16932 @i{Stefan Vollmar} organized a video-recorded talk at the
16933 Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation of a
16934 concept index for HTML export.
16936 @i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
16939 @i{Samuel Wales} has provided important feedback and bug reports.
16941 @i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
16944 @i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
16947 @i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
16950 @i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
16953 @i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
16954 and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
16958 @node Main Index, Key Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
16959 @unnumbered Concept index
16963 @node Key Index, Command and Function Index, Main Index, Top
16964 @unnumbered Key index
16968 @node Command and Function Index, Variable Index, Key Index, Top
16969 @unnumbered Command and function index
16973 @node Variable Index, , Command and Function Index, Top
16974 @unnumbered Variable index
16976 This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are
16977 mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use @kbd{M-x
16978 org-customize @key{RET}} and then click yourself through the tree.
16984 @c Local variables:
16986 @c indent-tabs-mode: nil
16987 @c paragraph-start: "
\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|\f\\|[ ]*$"
16988 @c paragraph-separate: "
\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|[ \f]*$"
16992 @c LocalWords: webdavhost pre